As Filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on April 12, 2011

                              File No. 333-158181

                       SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                             Washington, D. C. 20549

                                    FORM S-1
                       POST-EFFECTIVE AMENDMENT NO. 3 TO
                             REGISTRATION STATEMENT
                                      UNDER
                           THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933

                          LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY
             (Exact name of Registrant as Specified in its Charter)


                                                           
           Nebraska                          6300                            470221457
(State or other jurisdiction of   (Primary Standard Industrial   (I.R.S. Employer incorporation or
          organization)            Classification Code Number)           Identification No.)


                  2940 South 84th St., Lincoln, Nebraska 68506
                                 1-800-525-9287
              (Address of registrant's principal executive offices)

                             JAN FISCHER-WADE, ESQ.
                          LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY
                               2940 South 84th St.
                                LINCOLN, NE 68506
                                 1-800-525-9287
                           (Name of agent for service)

Approximate date of commencement of proposed sale to the Public: As soon as
practicable after the effective date of this registration statement.

If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a
delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of
1933, check the following box. [X]

If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant
to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list
the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective
registration statement for the same offering. [ ]

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under
the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. [ ]

If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under
the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act
registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement
for the same offering. [ ]

Indicate by checkmark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an
accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See
definitions of "large accelerated filer," "accelerated filer" and "smaller
reporting company" in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

Large accelerated filer [ ]   Accelerated filer [ ]




Non-accelerated filer [X] (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

Smaller reporting company [ ]

CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE



                                     Proposed maximum   Proposed maximum
Title of securities   Amount to be    offering price   aggregate offering      Amount of
to be registered     registered (1)      per unit           price (1)      registration fee (2)
-------------------  --------------  ----------------  ------------------  --------------------
                                                               
Deferred annuity           N/A             (1)                  N/A               N/A
interests and
participating
interests therein


(1) The Contract does not provide for a predetermined amount or number of units.
(2) By filing dated March 24, 2009, Lincoln Benefit Life Company registered
    $17,000,000 ($17 million) in market value adjusted annuity contract
    securities and paid a filing fee of $948.60 therefor. In this Registration
    Statement, Registrant continues that offering.

Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date or dates as
may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a
further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement
shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the
Securities Act of 1933 or until the Registration Statement shall become
effective on such date as the Commission, acting pursuant to Section 8(a), may
determine.

Neither the Securities and Exchange Commission nor any State securities
commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the
adequacy or accuracy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a
criminal offense.

Contingent on regulatory approval, ALFS, Inc ("ALFS") is expected to merge into
Allstate Distributors, LLC ("ADLLC"), effective April 29, 2011. At that time,
ALFS will assign its rights and delegate its duties as principal underwriter to
ADLLC. This change will have no effect on Lincoln Benefit's obligations to you
under your Contract.

Contingent on regulatory approval, ADLLC serves as distributor of the securities
registered herein. The securities offered herein are sold on a continuous basis,
and there is no specific end date for the offering. ADLLC, an affiliate of
Lincoln Benefit, is a wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate Life Insurance
Company. ADLLC is a registered broker dealer under the Securities and Exchange
Act of 1934, as amended, and is a member of the Financial Industry Regulatory
Authority. ADLLC is not required to sell any specific number or dollar amount of
securities, but will use its best efforts to sell the securities offered.



                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                         Supplement Dated May 1, 2011
                To the following Prospectuses, as supplemented

CONSULTANT SOLUTIONS (CLASSIC, PLUS, ELITE, SELECT) PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 1, 2011
                   CONSULTANT I PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 1, 2011
                  LBL ADVANTAGE PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 1, 2004
                  CONSULTANT II PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 1, 2004
                 PREMIER PLANNER PROSPECTUS DATED MAY 1, 2004

   The following information supplements the prospectus for your variable
annuity contract issued by Lincoln Benefit Life Company.

                           SUPPLEMENTAL INFORMATION
                      ABOUT LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                                     INDEX



                                                                                        PAGE
                                                                                        ----
                                                                                  
Item 3(c)   Risk Factors...............................................................   1
Item 11(a)  Description of Business....................................................   8
Item 11(b)  Description of Property....................................................  10
Item 11(c)  Legal Proceedings..........................................................  10
Item 11(e)  Financial Statements and Notes to Financial Statements.....................  10
Item 11(f)  Selected Financial Data....................................................  44
Item 11(h)  Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of
              Operations...............................................................  44
Item 11(j)  Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk.................  59
Item 11(k)  Directors, Executive Officers, Promoters and Control Persons...............  59
Item 11(l)  Executive Compensation.....................................................  61
Item 11(m)  Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management.............  87
Item 11(n)  Transactions with Related Persons, Promoters and Certain Control Persons...  89
Other Information......................................................................  91


ITEM 3(C). RISK FACTORS

   This document contains "forward-looking statements" that anticipate results
based on our estimates, assumptions and plans that are subject to uncertainty.
These statements are made subject to the safe-harbor provisions of the Private
Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. We assume no obligation to update any
forward-looking statements as a result of new information or future events or
developments.

   These forward-looking statements do not relate strictly to historical or
current facts and may be identified by their use of words like "plans,"
"seeks," "expects," "will," "should," "anticipates," "estimates," "intends,"
"believes," "likely," "targets" and other words with similar meanings. These
statements may address, among other things, our strategy for growth, product
development, investment results, regulatory approvals, market position,
expenses, financial results, litigation and reserves. We believe that these
statements are based on reasonable estimates, assumptions and plans. However,
if the estimates, assumptions or plans underlying the forward-looking
statements prove inaccurate or if other risks or uncertainties arise, actual
results could differ materially from those communicated in these
forward-looking statements.

   In addition to the normal risks of business, we are subject to significant
risks and uncertainties, including those listed below, which apply to us as an
insurer and a provider of other financial services. These risks



constitute our cautionary statements under the Private Securities Litigation
Reform Act of 1995 and readers should carefully review such cautionary
statements as they identify certain important factors that could cause actual
results to differ materially from those in the forward-looking statements and
historical trends. These cautionary statements are not exclusive and are in
addition to other factors discussed elsewhere in this document, in our filings
with the Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") or in materials
incorporated therein by reference.

CHANGES IN UNDERWRITING AND ACTUAL EXPERIENCE COULD MATERIALLY AFFECT
PROFITABILITY OF BUSINESS CEDED TO ALLSTATE LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY ("ALIC")

   Our product pricing includes long-term assumptions regarding investment
returns, mortality, morbidity, persistency and operating costs and expenses of
the business, which is ceded to ALIC. We establish target returns for each
product based upon these factors and the average amount of capital that we and
ALIC must hold to support in-force contracts taking into account rating
agencies and regulatory requirements. We monitor and manage our pricing and
overall sales mix to achieve target new business returns on a portfolio basis,
which could result in the discontinuation or de-emphasis of products or
distribution relationships and a decline in sales. Profitability from new
business emerges over a period of years depending on the nature and life of the
product and is subject to variability as actual results may differ from pricing
assumptions. Additionally, many of our products have fixed or guaranteed terms
that limit our ability to increase revenues or reduce benefits, including
credited interest, once the product has been issued.

   ALIC's profitability depends on the adequacy of investment spreads, the
management of market and credit risks associated with investments, the
sufficiency of premiums and contract charges to cover mortality and morbidity
benefits, the persistency of policies to ensure recovery of acquisition
expenses, and the management of operating costs and expenses within anticipated
pricing allowances. Legislation and regulation of the insurance marketplace and
products could also affect the profitability of our business ceded to ALIC.

CHANGES IN RESERVE ESTIMATES MAY ADVERSELY AFFECT OUR OPERATING RESULTS CEDED
TO ALIC

   The reserve for life-contingent contract benefits is computed on the basis
of long-term actuarial assumptions of future investment yields, mortality,
morbidity, persistency and expenses. We periodically review the adequacy of
these reserves on an aggregate basis and if future experience differs
significantly from assumptions, adjustments to reserves may be required which
could have a material adverse effect on our operating results ceded to ALIC.

CHANGES IN MARKET INTEREST RATES MAY LEAD TO A SIGNIFICANT DECREASE IN THE
SALES AND PROFITABILITY OF SPREAD-BASED PRODUCTS CEDED TO ALIC

   Our ability to manage our spread-based products, such as fixed annuities, is
dependent upon maintaining profitable spreads between investment yields and
interest crediting rates on business ceded to ALIC. When market interest rates
decrease or remain at relatively low levels, proceeds from investments that
have matured or have been prepaid or sold may be reinvested at lower yields,
reducing investment spread. Lowering interest crediting rates on some products
in such an environment can partially offset decreases in investment yield.
However, these changes could be limited by market conditions, regulatory
minimum rates or contractual minimum rate guarantees on many contracts and may
not match the timing or magnitude of changes in investment yields. Decreases in
the interest crediting rates offered on products could make those products less
attractive, leading to lower sales and/or changes in the level of policy loans,
surrenders and withdrawals. Non-parallel shifts in interest rates, such as
increases in short-term rates without accompanying increases in medium- and
long-term rates, can influence customer demand for fixed annuities, which could
impact the level and profitability of new customer deposits. Increases in
market interest rates can also have negative effects on the business ceded to
ALIC, for example by increasing the attractiveness of other investments to our
customers, which can lead to higher surrenders at a time when our fixed income
investment asset values are lower as a result

                                      2



of the increase in interest rates. This could lead to the sale of fixed income
securities at a loss. For certain products, principally fixed annuity and
interest-sensitive life products, the earned rate on assets could lag behind
rising market yields. We may react to market conditions by increasing crediting
rates, which could narrow spreads and reduce profitability on the business
ceded to ALIC.

A LOSS OF KEY PRODUCT DISTRIBUTION RELATIONSHIPS COULD MATERIALLY AFFECT SALES,
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS AND CASH FLOWS CEDED TO ALIC

   Certain products are distributed under agreements with other members of the
financial services industry that are not affiliated with us. Termination of one
or more of these agreements due to, for example, a change in control of one of
these distributors or market conditions that make it difficult to achieve our
target return on certain products, resulting in relatively uncompetitive
pricing, or a decision by us to discontinue selling products through a
distribution channel, could have a detrimental effect on our sales, results of
operations or cash flows ceded to ALIC if it were to result in an elevated
level of surrenders of in-force contracts sold through terminated distribution
relationships.

CHANGES IN TAX LAWS MAY DECREASE SALES AND PROFITABILITY OF PRODUCTS CEDED TO
ALIC

   Under current federal and state income tax law, certain products we offer,
primarily life insurance and annuities, receive favorable tax treatment. This
favorable treatment may give certain of our products a competitive advantage
over noninsurance products. Congress from time to time considers legislation
that would reduce or eliminate the favorable policyholder tax treatment
currently applicable to life insurance and annuities. Congress also considers
proposals to reduce the taxation of certain products or investments that may
compete with life insurance or annuities. Legislation that increases the
taxation on insurance products or reduces the taxation on competing products
could lessen the advantage or create a disadvantage for certain of our products
making them less competitive. Such proposals, if adopted, could have a material
adverse effect on ALIC's profitability and financial condition or our ability
to sell such products and could result in the surrender of some existing
contracts and policies. In addition, changes in the federal estate tax laws
could negatively affect the demand for the types of life insurance used in
estate planning.

RISKS RELATING TO INVESTMENTS

WE ARE SUBJECT TO MARKET RISK AND DECLINES IN CREDIT QUALITY WHICH MAY
ADVERSELY IMPACT INVESTMENT INCOME, CAUSE ADDITIONAL REALIZED LOSSES, AND CAUSE
INCREASED UNREALIZED LOSSES

   We are subject to the risk that we will incur losses due to adverse changes
in interest rates or credit spreads. We are subject to risks associated with
potential declines in credit quality related to specific issuers or specific
industries and a general weakening in the economy, which are typically
reflected through credit spreads. Credit spread is the additional yield on
fixed income securities above the risk-free rate (typically defined as the
yield on U.S. Treasury securities) that market participants require to
compensate them for assuming credit, liquidity and/or prepayment risks. Credit
spreads vary (i.e. increase or decrease) in response to the market's perception
of risk and liquidity in a specific issuer or specific sector and are
influenced by the credit ratings, and the reliability of those ratings,
published by external rating agencies.

   A decline in market interest rates or credit spreads could have an adverse
effect on our investment income as we invest cash in new investments that may
earn less than the portfolio's average yield. In a declining interest rate
environment, borrowers may prepay or redeem securities more quickly than
expected as they seek to refinance at lower rates. An increase in market
interest rates or credit spreads could have an adverse effect on the value of
our investment portfolio by decreasing the fair values of the fixed income
securities that comprise a substantial majority of our investment portfolio. A
decline in the quality of our investment portfolio as a result of adverse
economic conditions or otherwise could cause additional realized losses on
securities.

                                      3



DETERIORATING FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE IMPACTING SECURITIES COLLATERALIZED BY
RESIDENTIAL AND COMMERCIAL MORTGAGE LOANS MAY LEAD TO WRITE-DOWNS AND IMPACT
OUR RESULTS OF OPERATIONS AND FINANCIAL CONDITION

   Changes in residential or commercial mortgage delinquencies, loss severities
or recovery rates, declining residential or commercial real estate prices and
the quality of service provided by service providers on securities in our
portfolio could lead us to determine that write-downs are necessary in the
future.

CONCENTRATION OF OUR INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO IN ANY PARTICULAR SEGMENT OF THE
ECONOMY MAY HAVE ADVERSE EFFECTS ON OUR OPERATING RESULTS AND FINANCIAL
CONDITION

   The concentration of our investment portfolio in any particular industry,
collateral types, group of related industries or geographic sector could have
an adverse effect on our investment portfolio and consequently on our results
of operations and financial condition. Events or developments that have a
negative impact on any particular industry, group of related industries or
geographic region may have a greater adverse effect on the investment portfolio
to the extent that the portfolio is concentrated rather than diversified.

THE DETERMINATION OF THE AMOUNT OF REALIZED CAPITAL LOSSES RECORDED FOR
IMPAIRMENTS OF OUR INVESTMENTS IS HIGHLY SUBJECTIVE AND COULD MATERIALLY IMPACT
OUR OPERATING RESULTS AND FINANCIAL CONDITION

   The determination of the amount of realized capital losses recorded for
impairments vary by investment type and is based upon our periodic evaluation
and assessment of known and inherent risks associated with the respective asset
class. Such evaluations and assessments are revised as conditions change and
new information becomes available. We update our evaluations regularly and
reflect changes in other-than-temporary impairments in our results of
operations. The assessment of whether other-than-temporary impairments have
occurred is based on our case-by-case evaluation of the underlying reasons for
the decline in fair value. There can be no assurance that we have accurately
assessed the level of or amounts recorded for other-than-temporary impairments
taken in our financial statements. Furthermore, historical trends may not be
indicative of future impairments and additional impairments may need to be
recorded in the future.

THE DETERMINATION OF THE FAIR VALUE OF OUR FIXED INCOME SECURITIES IS HIGHLY
SUBJECTIVE AND COULD MATERIALLY IMPACT OUR OPERATING RESULTS AND FINANCIAL
CONDITION

   In determining fair values we generally utilize market transaction data for
the same or similar instruments. The degree of management judgment involved in
determining fair values is inversely related to the availability of market
observable information. The fair value of assets may differ from the actual
amount received upon sale of an asset in an orderly transaction between market
participants at the measurement date. Moreover, the use of different valuation
assumptions may have a material effect on the assets' fair values. The
difference between amortized cost and fair value, net of deferred income taxes,
is reflected as a component of accumulated other comprehensive income in
shareholder's equity. Changing market conditions could materially effect the
determination of the fair value of securities and unrealized net capital gains
and losses could vary significantly. Determining fair value is highly
subjective and could materially impact our operating results and financial
condition.

RISKS RELATING TO THE INSURANCE INDUSTRY

OUR FUTURE RESULTS ARE DEPENDENT IN PART ON OUR ABILITY TO SUCCESSFULLY OPERATE
IN AN INSURANCE INDUSTRY THAT IS HIGHLY COMPETITIVE

   The insurance industry is highly competitive. Our competitors include other
insurers and, because many of our products include a savings or investment
component, securities firms, investment advisers, mutual funds, banks and other
financial institutions. Many of our competitors have well-established national
reputations and market similar products. Because of the competitive nature of
the insurance industry, including competition for producers such as exclusive
and independent agents, there can be no assurance that we will continue to

                                      4



effectively compete with our industry rivals, or that competitive pressures
will not have a material adverse effect on our business or operating results
ceded to ALIC. Furthermore, certain competitors operate using a mutual
insurance company structure and therefore may have dissimilar profitability and
return targets. Our ability to successfully operate may also be impaired if we
are not effective in filling critical leadership positions, in developing the
talent and skills of our human resources, in assimilating new executive talent
into our organization, or in deploying human resource talent consistently with
our business goals.

DIFFICULT CONDITIONS IN THE ECONOMY GENERALLY COULD ADVERSELY AFFECT OUR
BUSINESS AND OPERATING RESULTS

   As with most businesses, we believe difficult conditions in the economy,
such as significant negative macroeconomic trends, including relatively high
and sustained unemployment, reduced consumer spending, lower home prices, and
substantial increases in delinquencies on consumer debt, including defaults on
home mortgages, and the relatively low availability of credit could have an
adverse effect on our business and operating results.

   General economic conditions could adversely affect us in the form of
consumer behavior and pressure investment results. Consumer behavior changes
could include decreased demand for our products. In addition, holders of some
of our interest-sensitive life insurance and annuity products may engage in an
elevated level of discretionary withdrawals of contractholder funds. Our
investment results could be adversely affected as deteriorating financial and
business conditions affect the issuers of the securities in our investment
portfolio.

THERE CAN BE NO ASSURANCE THAT ACTIONS OF THE U.S. FEDERAL GOVERNMENT, FEDERAL
RESERVE AND OTHER GOVERNMENTAL AND REGULATORY BODIES FOR THE PURPOSE OF
STABILIZING THE FINANCIAL MARKETS AND STIMULATING THE ECONOMY WILL ACHIEVE THE
INTENDED EFFECT

   In response to the financial crises affecting the banking system, the
financial markets and the broader economy in recent years, the U.S. federal
government, the Federal Reserve and other governmental and regulatory bodies
have taken actions such as purchasing mortgage-backed and other securities from
financial institutions, investing directly in banks, thrifts and bank and
savings and loan holding companies and increasing federal spending to stimulate
the economy. There can be no assurance as to the long term impact such actions
will have on the financial markets or on economic conditions, including
potential inflationary affects. Continued volatility and any further economic
deterioration could materially and adversely affect our business, financial
condition and results of operations.

LOSSES FROM LITIGATION MAY BE MATERIAL TO OUR OPERATING RESULTS OR CASH FLOWS
CEDED TO ALIC

   As is typical for a large company, our ultimate parent The Allstate
Corporation and its subsidiaries are involved in various legal actions,
including class action litigation challenging a range of company practices and
coverage provided by our insurance products. In the event of an unfavorable
outcome in one or more of these matters, the ultimate liability may be in
excess of amounts currently reserved and may be material to our operating
results or cash flows ceded to ALIC for a particular annual period.

WE ARE SUBJECT TO EXTENSIVE REGULATION AND POTENTIAL FURTHER RESTRICTIVE
REGULATION MAY INCREASE OUR OPERATING COSTS AND LIMIT OUR GROWTH

   As an insurance company with separate accounts that are regulated as
investment companies, we are subject to extensive laws and regulations. These
laws and regulations are complex and subject to change. Moreover, they are
administered and enforced by a number of different governmental authorities,
including state insurance regulators, state securities administrators, the SEC,
the FINRA, the U.S. Department of Justice, and state attorneys general, each of
which exercises a degree of interpretive latitude. Consequently, we are subject
to the risk that compliance with any particular regulator's or enforcement
authority's interpretation of a legal issue may not result in compliance with
another's interpretation of the same issue, particularly when compliance is
judged in hindsight. In addition, there is risk that any particular regulator's
or enforcement authority's interpretation of a

                                      5



legal issue may change over time to our detriment, or that changes in the
overall legal environment may, even absent any particular regulator's or
enforcement authority's interpretation of a legal issue changing, cause us to
change our views regarding the actions we need to take from a legal risk
management perspective, thus necessitating changes to our practices that may,
in some cases, limit our ability to grow and improve the profitability of our
business ceded to ALIC. Furthermore, in some cases, these laws and regulations
are designed to protect or benefit the interests of a specific constituency
rather than a range of constituencies. For example, state insurance laws and
regulations are generally intended to protect or benefit purchasers or users of
insurance products. In many respects, these laws and regulations limit our
ability to grow and improve the profitability of our business ceded to ALIC.

   In recent years, the state insurance regulatory framework has come under
public scrutiny and members of Congress have discussed proposals to provide for
federal chartering of insurance companies. We can make no assurances regarding
the potential impact of state or federal measures that may change the nature or
scope of insurance regulation.

REGULATORY REFORMS, AND THE MORE STRINGENT APPLICATION OF EXISTING REGULATIONS,
MAY MAKE IT MORE EXPENSIVE FOR US TO CONDUCT OUR BUSINESS

   The federal government has enacted comprehensive regulatory reforms for
financial services entities. As part of a larger effort to strengthen the
regulation of the financial services market, certain reforms are applicable to
the insurance industry, including the establishment of a Federal Insurance
Office within the Department of Treasury.

   These regulatory reforms and any additional legislation or regulatory
requirements imposed upon us in connection with the federal government's
regulatory reform of the financial services industry and any more stringent
enforcement of existing regulations by federal authorities, may make it more
expensive for us to conduct our business.

REINSURANCE MAY BE UNAVAILABLE AT CURRENT LEVELS AND PRICES, WHICH MAY LIMIT
OUR ABILITY TO WRITE NEW BUSINESS

   Market conditions beyond our control impact the availability and cost of the
reinsurance we purchase. No assurances can be made that reinsurance will remain
continuously available to us to the same extent and on the same terms and rates
as is currently available. If we were unable to maintain our current level of
reinsurance or purchase new reinsurance protection in amounts that we consider
sufficient and at prices that we consider acceptable, either ALIC would have to
accept an increase in exposure risk, or we would have to reduce our insurance
writings, or develop or seek other alternatives.

REINSURANCE SUBJECTS US TO THE CREDIT RISK OF OUR REINSURERS AND MAY NOT BE
ADEQUATE TO PROTECT US AGAINST LOSSES ARISING FROM CEDED INSURANCE, WHICH COULD
HAVE A MATERIAL ADVERSE EFFECT ON OUR OPERATING RESULTS CEDED TO ALIC

   The collectability of reinsurance recoverables is subject to uncertainty
arising from a number of factors, including changes in market conditions,
whether insured losses meet the qualifying conditions of the reinsurance
contract and whether reinsurers, or their affiliates, have the financial
capacity and willingness to make payments under the terms of a reinsurance
treaty or contract. Our inability to collect a material recovery from a
reinsurer could have a material adverse effect on operating results ceded to
ALIC.

A LARGE SCALE PANDEMIC, THE CONTINUED THREAT OF TERRORISM OR ONGOING MILITARY
ACTIONS MAY HAVE AN ADVERSE EFFECT ON THE LEVEL OF CLAIM LOSSES WE INCUR AND
CEDE TO ALIC, THE VALUE OF OUR INVESTMENT PORTFOLIO, OUR COMPETITIVE POSITION,
MARKETABILITY OF PRODUCT OFFERINGS, LIQUIDITY AND OPERATING RESULTS

   A large scale pandemic, the continued threat of terrorism, within the United
States and abroad, or ongoing military and other actions and heightened
security measures in response to these types of threats, may cause

                                      6



significant volatility and losses in our investment portfolio from declines in
the equity markets and from interest rate changes in the United States, Europe
and elsewhere, and result in loss of life, disruptions to commerce and reduced
economic activity. Some of the assets in our investment portfolio may be
adversely affected by reduced economic activity caused by a large scale
pandemic or the continued threat of terrorism. Additionally, a large scale
pandemic or terrorist act could have a material adverse effect on the sales,
profitability, competitiveness, marketability of product offerings, liquidity,
and operating results.

A DOWNGRADE IN ALIC'S FINANCIAL STRENGTH RATINGS MAY HAVE AN ADVERSE EFFECT ON
OUR COMPETITIVE POSITION, THE MARKETABILITY OF OUR PRODUCT OFFERINGS, AND OUR
LIQUIDITY, OPERATING RESULTS CEDED TO ALIC AND FINANCIAL CONDITION

   Financial strength ratings are important factors in establishing the
competitive position of insurance companies and generally have an effect on an
insurance company's business. On an ongoing basis, rating agencies review the
financial performance and condition of insurers and could downgrade or change
the outlook on an insurer's ratings due to, for example, a change in an
insurer's statutory capital; a change in a rating agency's determination of the
amount of risk-adjusted capital required to maintain a particular rating; an
increase in the perceived risk of an insurer's investment portfolio; a reduced
confidence in management or a host of other considerations that may or may not
be under the insurer's control. The insurance financial strength ratings of
ALIC from A.M. Best, Standard & Poor's and Moody's are subject to continuous
review, and the retention of current ratings cannot be assured. A downgrade in
any of these ratings could have a material adverse effect on our sales, our
competitiveness, the marketability of our product offerings, and our liquidity
and operating results ceded to ALIC.

CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING STANDARDS ISSUED BY THE FINANCIAL ACCOUNTING STANDARDS
BOARD ("FASB") OR OTHER STANDARD-SETTING BODIES MAY ADVERSELY AFFECT OUR
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS AND FINANCIAL CONDITION

   Our financial statements are subject to the application of generally
accepted accounting principles, which are periodically revised, interpreted
and/or expanded. Accordingly, we are required to adopt new guidance or
interpretations, or could be subject to existing guidance as we enter into new
transactions, which may have a material adverse effect on our results of
operations and financial condition that is either unexpected or has a greater
impact than expected. For a description of changes in accounting standards that
are currently pending and, if known, our estimates of their expected impact,
see Note 2 of the financial statements.

THE CHANGE IN OUR UNRECOGNIZED TAX BENEFIT DURING THE NEXT 12 MONTHS IS SUBJECT
TO UNCERTAINTY

   We have disclosed our estimate of net unrecognized tax benefits and the
reasonably possible increase or decrease in its balance during the next 12
months in Note 10 of the financial statements. However, actual results may
differ from our estimate for reasons such as changes in our position on
specific issues, developments with respect to the governments' interpretations
of income tax laws or changes in judgment resulting from new information
obtained in audits or the appeals process.

THE OCCURRENCE OF EVENTS UNANTICIPATED IN OUR DISASTER RECOVERY SYSTEMS AND
MANAGEMENT CONTINUITY PLANNING OR A SUPPORT FAILURE FROM EXTERNAL PROVIDERS
DURING A DISASTER COULD IMPAIR OUR ABILITY TO CONDUCT BUSINESS EFFECTIVELY

   The occurrence of a disaster such as a natural catastrophe, an industrial
accident, a terrorist attack or war, events unanticipated in our disaster
recovery systems or a support failure from external providers, could have an
adverse effect on our ability to conduct business and on our results of
operations ceded to ALIC and financial condition, particularly if those events
affect our computer-based data processing, transmission, storage, and retrieval
systems. In the event that a significant number of our managers could be
unavailable in the event of a disaster, our ability to effectively conduct our
business could be severely compromised.

                                      7



ITEM 11(A).DESCRIPTION OF BUSINESS

   Lincoln Benefit Life Company ("Lincoln Benefit") was incorporated under the
laws of the State of Nebraska in 1938. Lincoln Benefit is a wholly owned
subsidiary of Allstate Life Insurance Company ("ALIC"), a stock life insurance
company incorporated under the laws of the State of Illinois. ALIC is a wholly
owned subsidiary of Allstate Insurance Company ("AIC"), a stock
property-liability insurance company organized under the laws of the State of
Illinois. All of the outstanding capital stock of Allstate Insurance Company is
owned by Allstate Insurance Holdings, LLC, which is wholly owned by The
Allstate Corporation (the "Corporation" or "Allstate"), a publicly owned
holding company incorporated under the laws of the State of Delaware. The
Allstate Corporation is the largest publicly held personal lines insurer in the
United States. Widely known through the "You're In Good Hands With Allstate(R)"
slogan, Allstate is reinventing protection and retirement to help individuals
in approximately 16 million households protect what they have today and better
prepare for tomorrow. Customers can access Allstate products and services such
as auto insurance and homeowners insurance through more than 13,000 exclusive
Allstate agencies and financial representatives in the United States and
Canada. Allstate is the 2/nd/ largest personal property and casualty insurer in
the United States on the basis of 2009 statutory direct premiums earned. In
addition, according to A.M. Best, it is the nation's 16/th/ largest issuer of
life insurance business on the basis of 2009 ordinary life insurance in force
and 21/st/ largest on the basis of 2009 statutory admitted assets.

                                      8



   In our reports, we occasionally refer to statutory financial information.
All domestic United States insurance companies are required to prepare
statutory-basis financial statements. As a result, industry data is available
that enables comparisons between insurance companies, including competitors
that are not subject to the requirement to prepare financial statements in
conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States
of America ("GAAP"). We frequently use industry publications containing
statutory financial information to assess our competitive position.

   We provide life insurance, retirement and investment products. Our principal
products are interest-sensitive, traditional and variable life insurance, and
fixed annuities including deferred and immediate. We sell products through
multiple intermediary distribution channels, including Allstate exclusive
agencies and exclusive financial specialists and independent agents (including
master brokerage agencies). Through March 31, 2010, we also sold products
through broker-dealers. Although we continue to service in force contracts sold
through this distribution channel, we no longer solicit new sales through
direct relationships with broker-dealers.

   We compete on a wide variety of factors, including the scope of our
distribution systems, the type of our product offerings, the recognition of our
brands, our financial strength and ratings, our differentiated product features
and prices, and the level of customer service that we provide.

   The market for life insurance, retirement and investment products continues
to be highly fragmented and competitive. As of December 31, 2010, there were
approximately 470 groups of life insurance companies in the United States, most
of which offered one or more similar products. In addition, because many of
these products include a savings or investment component, our competition
includes domestic and foreign securities firms, investment advisors, mutual
funds, banks and other financial institutions. Competitive pressure continues
to grow due to several factors, including cross marketing alliances between
unaffiliated businesses, as well as consolidation activity in the financial
services industry.

   We have reinsurance agreements whereby all premiums, contract charges,
interest credited to contractholder funds, contract benefits and substantially
all expenses are ceded to ALIC and non-affiliated reinsurers. Assets that
support general account product liabilities are owned and managed by ALIC under
the terms of the reinsurance agreements.

   Lincoln Benefit is subject to extensive regulation, primarily at the state
level. The method, extent and substance of such regulation varies by state but
generally has its source in statutes that establish standards and requirements
for conducting the business of insurance and that delegate regulatory authority
to a state regulatory agency. In general, such regulation is intended for the
protection of those who purchase or use insurance products. These rules have a
substantial effect on our business and relate to a wide variety of matters,
including insurance company licensing and examination, agent licensing, price
setting, trade practices, policy forms, statutory accounting methods, corporate
governance, the nature and amount of investments, claims practices,
participation in guaranty funds, reserve adequacy, insurer solvency,
transactions with affiliates, the payment of dividends, and underwriting
standards. For a discussion of statutory financial information, see Note 11 of
the financial statements. For a discussion of regulatory contingencies, see
Note 9 of the financial statements. Notes 9 and 11 are incorporated in this
Item 11(a) by reference.

   In recent years, the state insurance regulatory framework has come under
increased federal scrutiny. Legislation that would provide for increased
federal regulation of insurance, including the federal chartering of insurance
companies, has been proposed. Moreover, as part of an effort to strengthen the
regulation of the financial services market, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform
and Consumer Protection Act was enacted. Hundreds of regulations must be
promulgated and implemented pursuant to this new law, and we cannot predict
what the final regulations will require but do not expect a material impact on
Lincoln Benefit's operations. The new law also creates the Federal Office of
Insurance ("FIO") within the Treasury Department. The FIO will monitor the
insurance industry, provide advice to the new Financial Stability Oversight
Council, represent the U.S. on international insurance matters and study the
current regulatory system and submit a report to Congress

                                      9



in 2012. In addition, state legislators and insurance regulators continue to
examine the appropriate nature and scope of state insurance regulation. We
cannot predict whether any specific state or federal measures will be adopted
to change the nature or scope of the regulation of insurance business or what
effect any such measures would have on Lincoln Benefit.

ITEM 11(B).DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTY

   Lincoln Benefit occupies office space in Lincoln, Nebraska and Northbrook,
Illinois that is owned by Allstate Insurance Company. Expenses associated with
these facilities are allocated to us on a direct basis.

ITEM 11(C).LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

   Information required for Item 11(c) is incorporated by reference to the
discussion under the heading "Regulation and Compliance" and under the heading
"Legal and regulatory proceedings and inquiries" in Note 9 of the financial
statements.

ITEM 11(E).FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

               STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS AND COMPREHENSIVE INCOME



                                                     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                     -----------------------
                                                      2010    2009     2008
  ($ IN THOUSANDS)                                   ------- ------- -------
                                                            
  REVENUES
  Net investment income............................. $12,067 $11,783 $13,940
  Realized capital gains and losses.................     694   1,480   5,952
                                                     ------- ------- -------
  INCOME FROM OPERATIONS BEFORE INCOME TAX EXPENSE..  12,761  13,263  19,892
  Income tax expense................................   4,451   4,634   6,918
                                                     ------- ------- -------
  NET INCOME........................................   8,310   8,629  12,974
                                                     ------- ------- -------
  OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS), AFTER-TAX
  Change in unrealized net capital gains and losses.   4,584   5,783  (4,351)
                                                     ------- ------- -------
  COMPREHENSIVE INCOME.............................. $12,894 $14,412 $ 8,623
                                                     ======= ======= =======




                      See notes to financial statements.

                                      10



                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                       STATEMENTS OF FINANCIAL POSITION



                                                                                      DECEMBER 31,
                                                                                 -----------------------
                                                                                    2010        2009
($ IN THOUSANDS, EXCEPT PAR VALUE DATA)                                          ----------- -----------
                                                                                       
ASSETS
Investments
   Fixed income securities, at fair value (amortized cost $304,848 and
     $299,787).................................................................. $   320,456 $   308,343
   Short-term, at fair value (amortized cost $11,593 and $8,557)................      11,593       8,557
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
       Total investments........................................................     332,049     316,900
Cash............................................................................       3,550      10,063
Reinsurance recoverable from Allstate Life Insurance Company....................  18,365,058  18,689,074
Reinsurance recoverable from non-affiliates.....................................   1,906,574   1,766,824
Other assets....................................................................     105,159     110,400
Separate accounts...............................................................   2,017,185   2,039,647
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
       TOTAL ASSETS............................................................. $22,729,575 $22,932,908
                                                                                 =========== ===========
LIABILITIES
Contractholder funds............................................................ $17,247,071 $17,633,027
Reserve for life-contingent contract benefits...................................   3,011,317   2,805,387
Unearned premiums...............................................................      19,478      21,656
Deferred income taxes...........................................................       5,833       3,300
Payable to affiliates, net......................................................       4,931      14,749
Current income taxes payable....................................................       4,386       4,656
Other liabilities and accrued expenses..........................................      93,507      97,513
Separate accounts...............................................................   2,017,185   2,039,647
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
       TOTAL LIABILITIES........................................................  22,403,708  22,619,935
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES (NOTE 9)

SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY
Common stock, $100 par value, 30 thousand shares authorized, 25 thousand shares
  issued and outstanding........................................................       2,500       2,500
Additional capital paid-in......................................................     180,000     180,000
Retained income.................................................................     133,222     124,912
Accumulated other comprehensive income:
   Unrealized net capital gains and losses......................................      10,145       5,561
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
       Total accumulated other comprehensive income.............................      10,145       5,561
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
       TOTAL SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY...............................................     325,867     312,973
                                                                                 ----------- -----------
       TOTAL LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY............................... $22,729,575 $22,932,908
                                                                                 =========== ===========


                      See notes to financial statements.

                                      11



                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                      STATEMENTS OF SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY



                                                     YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                   ---------------------------
                                                     2010     2009      2008
($ IN THOUSANDS)                                   -------- --------  --------
                                                             
COMMON STOCK...................................... $  2,500 $  2,500  $  2,500
                                                   -------- --------  --------
ADDITIONAL CAPITAL PAID-IN........................  180,000  180,000   180,000
                                                   -------- --------  --------
RETAINED INCOME
Balance, beginning of year........................  124,912  116,283   103,309
Net income........................................    8,310    8,629    12,974
                                                   -------- --------  --------
Balance, end of year..............................  133,222  124,912   116,283
                                                   -------- --------  --------
ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME
Balance, beginning of year........................    5,561     (222)    4,129
Change in unrealized net capital gains and losses.    4,584    5,783    (4,351)
                                                   -------- --------  --------
Balance, end of year..............................   10,145    5,561      (222)
                                                   -------- --------  --------
TOTAL SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY........................ $325,867 $312,973  $298,561
                                                   ======== ========  ========



                      See notes to financial statements.

                                      12



                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                           STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS



                                                                          YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
                                                                       -----------------------------
                                                                         2010       2009      2008
($ IN THOUSANDS)                                                       --------  ---------  --------
                                                                                   
CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES
Net income............................................................ $  8,310  $   8,629  $ 12,974
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by (used in)
  operating activities:
   Amortization and other non-cash items..............................    1,241        932       143
   Realized capital gains and losses..................................     (694)    (1,480)   (5,952)
   Changes in:
       Policy benefit and other insurance reserves....................    4,240     19,349    (5,052)
       Income taxes...................................................     (205)    (2,174)    2,065
       Receivable/payable to affiliates, net..........................   (9,818)   (21,280)   14,117
       Other operating assets and liabilities.........................     (943)       369   (24,195)
                                                                       --------  ---------  --------
          Net cash provided by (used in) operating activities.........    2,131      4,345    (5,900)
                                                                       --------  ---------  --------
CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES
Proceeds from sales of fixed income securities........................   27,166     46,330   101,584
Collections on fixed income securities................................   38,691     35,334     7,693
Purchases of fixed income securities..................................  (71,478)  (151,234)  (64,497)
Change in short-term investments, net.................................   (3,023)    72,143   (54,347)
                                                                       --------  ---------  --------
          Net cash (used in) provided by investing activities.........   (8,644)     2,573    (9,567)
                                                                       --------  ---------  --------
NET (DECREASE) INCREASE IN CASH.......................................   (6,513)     6,918   (15,467)
CASH AT BEGINNING OF YEAR.............................................   10,063      3,145    18,612
                                                                       --------  ---------  --------
CASH AT END OF YEAR................................................... $  3,550  $  10,063  $  3,145
                                                                       ========  =========  ========



                      See notes to financial statements.

                                      13



                         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. GENERAL

BASIS OF PRESENTATION

   The accompanying financial statements include the accounts of Lincoln
Benefit Life Company (the "Company"), a wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate
Life Insurance Company ("ALIC"), which is wholly owned by Allstate Insurance
Company ("AIC"). All of the outstanding common stock of AIC is owned by
Allstate Insurance Holdings, LLC, a wholly owned subsidiary of The Allstate
Corporation (the "Corporation"). These financial statements have been prepared
in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United
States of America ("GAAP").

   To conform to the current year presentation, certain amounts in the prior
years' financial statements and notes have been reclassified.

   The preparation of financial statements in conformity with GAAP requires
management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the amounts reported
in the financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ
from those estimates.

NATURE OF OPERATIONS

   The Company sells life insurance, retirement and investment products. The
principal products are interest-sensitive, traditional and variable life
insurance and fixed annuities including deferred and immediate.

   The Company is authorized to sell life insurance and retirement products in
all states except New York, as well as in the District of Columbia, the U.S.
Virgin Islands and Guam. For 2010, the top geographic locations for statutory
premiums and annuity considerations were California, Florida and Texas. No
other jurisdiction accounted for more than 5% of statutory premiums and annuity
considerations. All statutory premiums and annuity considerations are ceded
under reinsurance agreements. The Company distributes its products through
multiple distribution channels, including Allstate exclusive agencies, which
include exclusive financial specialists, and independent agents (including
master brokerage agencies).

   The Company has exposure to market risk as a result of its investment
portfolio. Market risk is the risk that the Company will incur realized and
unrealized net capital losses due to adverse changes in interest rates and
credit spreads. The Company also has certain exposures to changes in equity
prices in its equity-indexed annuities and separate accounts liabilities, which
are transferred to ALIC in accordance with reinsurance agreements. Interest
rate risk is the risk that the Company will incur a loss due to adverse changes
in interest rates relative to the interest rate characteristics of its interest
bearing assets. This risk arises from the Company's investment in
interest-sensitive assets. Interest rate risk includes risks related to changes
in U.S. Treasury yields and other key risk-free reference yields. Credit spread
risk is the risk that the Company will incur a loss due to adverse changes in
credit spreads. This risk arises from many of the Company's primary activities,
as the Company invests substantial funds in spread-sensitive fixed income
assets.

   The Company monitors economic and regulatory developments that have the
potential to impact its business. The ability of banks to affiliate with
insurers may have a material adverse effect on all of the Company's product
lines by substantially increasing the number, size and financial strength of
potential competitors. Furthermore, federal and state laws and regulations
affect the taxation of insurance companies and life insurance and annuity
products. Congress from time to time considers legislation that would reduce or
eliminate the favorable policyholder tax treatment currently applicable to life
insurance and annuities. Congress also considers proposals to reduce the
taxation of certain products or investments that may compete with life
insurance or annuities. Legislation that increases the taxation on insurance
products or reduces the taxation on competing products could lessen the
advantage or create a disadvantage for certain of the Company's products

                                      14



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

making them less competitive. Such proposals, if adopted, could have an adverse
effect on the Company's and ALIC's financial position or ability to sell such
products and could result in the surrender of some existing contracts and
policies. In addition, changes in the federal estate tax laws could negatively
affect the demand for the types of life insurance used in estate planning.

2. SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

INVESTMENTS

   Fixed income securities include bonds, residential mortgage-backed
securities ("RMBS"), commercial mortgage-backed securities ("CMBS") and
asset-backed securities ("ABS"). Fixed income securities, which may be sold
prior to their contractual maturity, are designated as available for sale and
are carried at fair value. The difference between amortized cost and fair
value, net of deferred income taxes, is reflected as a component of accumulated
other comprehensive income. Cash received from calls, principal payments and
make-whole payments is reflected as a component of proceeds from sales and cash
received from maturities and pay-downs is reflected as a component of
investment collections within the Statements of Cash Flows.

   Short-term investments, including money market funds and other short-term
investments, are carried at fair value.

   Investment income consists primarily of interest and is recognized on an
accrual basis using the effective yield method. Interest income for certain
RMBS, CMBS and ABS is determined considering estimated principal repayments
obtained from third party data sources and internal estimates. Actual
prepayment experience is periodically reviewed and effective yields are
recalculated on a retrospective basis when differences arise between the
prepayments originally anticipated and the actual prepayments received and
currently anticipated. For other-than-temporarily impaired fixed income
securities, the effective yield method utilizes the difference between the
amortized cost basis at impairment and the cash flows expected to be collected.
Accrual of income is suspended for other-than-temporarily impaired fixed income
securities when the timing and amount of cash flows expected to be received is
not reasonably estimable.

   Realized capital gains and losses include gains and losses on investment
sales and write-downs in value due to other-than-temporary declines in fair
value. Realized capital gains and losses on investment sales include calls and
prepayments and are determined on a specific identification basis.

   The Company recognizes other-than-temporary impairment losses on fixed
income securities in earnings when a security's fair value is less than its
amortized cost and the Company has made the decision to sell or it is more
likely than not the Company will be required to sell the fixed income security
before recovery of its amortized cost basis. Additionally, if the Company does
not expect to receive cash flows sufficient to recover the entire amortized
cost basis of a fixed income security, the credit loss component of the
impairment is recorded in earnings, with the remaining amount of the unrealized
loss related to other factors recognized in other comprehensive income ("OCI").

RECOGNITION OF PREMIUM REVENUES AND CONTRACT CHARGES, AND RELATED BENEFITS AND
INTEREST CREDITED

   The Company has reinsurance agreements whereby all premiums, contract
charges, interest credited to contractholder funds, contract benefits and
substantially all expenses are ceded to ALIC and non-affiliated reinsurers (see
Notes 3 and 8). Amounts reflected in the Statements of Operations and
Comprehensive Income are presented net of reinsurance.

   Traditional life insurance products consist principally of products with
fixed and guaranteed premiums and benefits, primarily term and whole life
insurance products. Premiums from these products are recognized as

                                      15



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

revenue when due from policyholders. Benefits are reflected in contract
benefits and recognized in relation to premiums, so that profits are recognized
over the life of the policy.

   Immediate annuities with life contingencies provide insurance protection
over a period that extends beyond the period during which premiums are
collected. Premiums from these products are recognized as revenue when received
at the inception of the contract. Benefits and expenses are recognized in
relation to premiums. Profits from these policies come from investment income,
which is recognized over the life of the contract.

   Interest-sensitive life contracts, such as universal life and single premium
life, are insurance contracts whose terms are not fixed and guaranteed. The
terms that may be changed include premiums paid by the contractholder, interest
credited to the contractholder account balance and contract charges assessed
against the contractholder account balance. Premiums from these contracts are
reported as contractholder fund deposits. Contract charges consist of fees
assessed against the contractholder account balance for the cost of insurance
(mortality risk), contract administration and surrender of the contract prior
to contractually specified dates. These contract charges are recognized as
revenue when assessed against the contractholder account balance. Contract
benefits include life-contingent benefit payments in excess of the
contractholder account balance.

   Contracts that do not subject the Company to significant risk arising from
mortality or morbidity are referred to as investment contracts. Fixed
annuities, including market value adjusted annuities, equity-indexed annuities
and immediate annuities without life contingencies, are considered investment
contracts. Consideration received for such contracts is reported as
contractholder fund deposits. Contract charges for investment contracts consist
of fees assessed against the contractholder account balance for maintenance,
administration and surrender of the contract prior to contractually specified
dates, and are recognized when assessed against the contractholder account
balance.

   Interest credited to contractholder funds represents interest accrued or
paid on interest-sensitive life contracts and investment contracts. Crediting
rates for certain fixed annuities and interest-sensitive life contracts are
adjusted periodically by the Company to reflect current market conditions
subject to contractually guaranteed minimum rates. Crediting rates for indexed
annuities are generally based on an equity index, such as the Standard & Poor's
("S&P") 500 Index.

   Contract charges for variable life and variable annuity products consist of
fees assessed against the contractholder account balances for contract
maintenance, administration, mortality, expense and surrender of the contract
prior to the contractually specified dates. Contract benefits incurred for
variable annuity products include guaranteed minimum death, income, withdrawal
and accumulation benefits.

REINSURANCE

   The Company has reinsurance agreements whereby all premiums, contract
charges, interest credited to contractholder funds, contract benefits and
substantially all expenses are ceded to ALIC and non-affiliated reinsurers (see
Notes 3 and 8). Reinsurance recoverables and the related reserve for
life-contingent contract benefits and contractholder funds are reported
separately in the Statements of Financial Position. Reinsurance does not
extinguish the Company's primary liability under the policies written.
Therefore, the Company regularly evaluates the financial condition of its
reinsurers and establishes allowances for uncollectible reinsurance as
appropriate.

   Investment income earned on the assets that support contractholder funds and
the reserve for life-contingent contract benefits is not included in the
Company's financial statements as those assets are owned and managed by ALIC
under the terms of the reinsurance agreements.

                                      16



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


INCOME TAXES

   The income tax provision is calculated under the liability method. Deferred
tax assets and liabilities are recorded based on the difference between the
financial statement and tax bases of assets and liabilities at the enacted tax
rates. The principal assets and liabilities giving rise to such differences are
unrealized capital gains and losses on investments. A deferred tax asset
valuation allowance is established when there is uncertainty that such assets
will be realized.

RESERVE FOR LIFE-CONTINGENT CONTRACT BENEFITS

   The reserve for life-contingent contract benefits payable under insurance
policies, including traditional life insurance and life-contingent immediate
annuities, is computed on the basis of long-term actuarial assumptions of
future investment yields, mortality, morbidity, policy terminations and
expenses (see Note 7). These assumptions, which for traditional life insurance
are applied using the net level premium method, include provisions for adverse
deviation and generally vary by characteristics such as type of coverage, year
of issue and policy duration.

CONTRACTHOLDER FUNDS

   Contractholder funds represent interest-bearing liabilities arising from the
sale of products such as interest-sensitive life and fixed annuities.
Contractholder funds are comprised primarily of deposits received and interest
credited to the benefit of the contractholder less surrenders and withdrawals,
mortality charges and administrative expenses (see Note 7). Contractholder
funds also include reserves for secondary guarantees on interest-sensitive life
insurance and certain fixed annuity contracts and reserves for certain
guarantees on variable annuity contracts.

SEPARATE ACCOUNTS

   Separate accounts assets are carried at fair value. The assets of the
separate accounts are legally segregated and available only to settle separate
account contract obligations. Separate accounts liabilities represent the
contractholders' claims to the related assets and are carried at an amount
equal to the separate accounts assets. Investment income and realized capital
gains and losses of the separate accounts accrue directly to the
contractholders and therefore, are not included in the Company's Statements of
Operations and Comprehensive Income. Deposits to and surrenders and withdrawals
from the separate accounts are reflected in separate accounts liabilities and
are not included in cash flows.

   Absent any contract provision wherein the Company provides a guarantee,
variable annuity and variable life insurance contractholders bear the
investment risk that the separate accounts' funds may not meet their stated
investment objectives. The risk and associated cost of these contract
guarantees are ceded to ALIC in accordance with the reinsurance agreements.

ADOPTED ACCOUNTING STANDARD

DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE MEASUREMENTS

   In January 2010, the Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB") issued
new accounting guidance which expands disclosure requirements relating to fair
value measurements. The guidance adds requirements for disclosing amounts of
and reasons for significant transfers into and out of Levels 1 and 2 and
requires gross rather than net disclosures about purchases, sales, issuances
and settlements relating to Level 3 measurements. The guidance also provides
clarification that fair value measurement disclosures are required for each
class of assets and liabilities. Disclosures about the valuation techniques and
inputs used to measure fair value for

                                      17



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

measurements that fall in either Level 2 or Level 3 are also required. The
Company adopted the provisions of the new guidance as of December 31, 2010,
except for disclosures about purchases, sales, issuances and settlements in the
roll forward of activity in Level 3 fair value measurements, which are required
for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010. Disclosures are not
required for earlier periods presented for comparative purposes. The new
guidance affects disclosures only; and therefore, the adoption had no impact on
the Company's results of operations or financial position.

PENDING ACCOUNTING STANDARD

CONSOLIDATION ANALYSIS CONSIDERING INVESTMENTS HELD THROUGH SEPARATE ACCOUNTS

   In April 2010, the FASB issued guidance clarifying that an insurer is not
required to combine interests in investments held in a qualifying separate
account with its interests in the same investments held in the general account
when performing a consolidation evaluation. The guidance is effective for
fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2010 with early adoption permitted.
The adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the
Company's results of operations or financial position.

3. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

BUSINESS OPERATIONS

   The Company uses services performed by its affiliates, AIC, ALIC and
Allstate Investments LLC, and business facilities owned or leased and operated
by AIC in conducting its business activities. In addition, the Company shares
the services of employees with AIC. The Company reimburses its affiliates for
the operating expenses incurred on behalf of the Company. The Company is
charged for the cost of these operating expenses based on the level of services
provided. Operating expenses, including compensation, retirement and other
benefit programs, allocated to the Company were $204.8 million, $202.9 million
and $227.0 million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Of these costs, the
Company retains investment related expenses on the invested assets of the
Company. All other costs are ceded to ALIC under the reinsurance agreements.

BROKER-DEALER AGREEMENTS

   The Company has a service agreement with Allstate Distributors, LLC
("ADLLC"), a broker-dealer company owned by ALIC, whereby ADLLC promotes and
markets products sold by the Company. In return for these services, the Company
recorded expense of $6.9 million, $4.6 million and $5.1 million in 2010, 2009
and 2008, respectively, that was ceded to ALIC under the terms of the
reinsurance agreements.

   The Company receives distribution services from Allstate Financial Services,
LLC ("AFS"), an affiliated broker-dealer company, for certain variable life
insurance contracts sold by Allstate exclusive agencies. For these services,
the Company incurred commission and other distribution expenses of $8.5
million, $9.1 million and $18.4 million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively,
that were ceded to ALIC.

REINSURANCE

   The following table summarizes amounts that were ceded to ALIC and reported
net in the Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income under the
reinsurance agreements:



                                                 2010       2009       2008
  ($ IN THOUSANDS)                            ---------- ---------- ----------
                                                           
  Premiums and contract charges.............. $  782,113 $  734,369 $  691,267
  Interest credited to contractholder funds,
    contract benefits and expenses...........  1,683,487  1,621,011  1,468,505


                                      18



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   Reinsurance recoverables due from ALIC totaled $18.37 billion and $18.69
billion as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

INCOME TAXES

   The Company is a party to a federal income tax allocation agreement with the
Corporation (see Note 10).

INTERCOMPANY LOAN AGREEMENT

   The Company has an intercompany loan agreement with the Corporation. The
amount of intercompany loans available to the Company is at the discretion of
the Corporation. The maximum amount of loans the Corporation will have
outstanding to all its eligible subsidiaries at any given point in time is
limited to $1 billion. The Corporation may use commercial paper borrowings,
bank lines of credit and repurchase agreements to fund intercompany borrowings.
The Company had no amounts outstanding under the intercompany loan agreement as
of December 31, 2010 and 2009.

4. INVESTMENTS

FAIR VALUES

   The amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses and fair value for
fixed income securities are as follows:



                                                 GROSS UNREALIZED
                                       AMORTIZED ---------------   FAIR
                                         COST     GAINS   LOSSES   VALUE
     ($ IN THOUSANDS)                  --------- ------- -------  --------
                                                      
     DECEMBER 31, 2010
     U.S. government and agencies..... $ 70,426  $ 3,513 $  (383) $ 73,556
     Municipal........................    2,999      177      --     3,176
     Corporate........................  154,261    9,345     (19)  163,587
     Foreign government...............    4,998       92      --     5,090
     RMBS.............................   55,376    2,429      (3)   57,802
     CMBS.............................    8,523      427     (87)    8,863
     ABS..............................    8,265      117      --     8,382
                                       --------  ------- -------  --------
        Total fixed income securities. $304,848  $16,100 $  (492) $320,456
                                       ========  ======= =======  ========
     DECEMBER 31, 2009
     U.S. government and agencies..... $ 79,982  $ 1,852 $  (283) $ 81,551
     Municipal........................    2,999       96      --     3,095
     Corporate........................  131,466    6,192     (85)  137,573
     RMBS.............................   66,326    1,733     (84)   67,975
     CMBS.............................   10,520       57    (873)    9,704
     ABS..............................    8,494       --     (49)    8,445
                                       --------  ------- -------  --------
        Total fixed income securities. $299,787  $ 9,930 $(1,374) $308,343
                                       ========  ======= =======  ========


                                      19



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


SCHEDULED MATURITIES

   The scheduled maturities for fixed income securities are as follows as of
December 31, 2010:



                                                   AMORTIZED  FAIR
                                                     COST     VALUE
           ($ IN THOUSANDS)                        --------- --------
                                                       
           Due in one year or less................ $  4,501  $  4,585
           Due after one year through five years..  151,933   159,481
           Due after five years through ten years.   76,126    81,207
           Due after ten years....................    8,647     8,999
                                                   --------  --------
                                                    241,207   254,272
           RMBS and ABS...........................   63,641    66,184
                                                   --------  --------
              Total............................... $304,848  $320,456
                                                   ========  ========


   Actual maturities may differ from those scheduled as a result of prepayments
by the issuers. Because of the potential for prepayment on RMBS and ABS, they
are not categorized by contractual maturity. CMBS are categorized by
contractual maturity because they generally are not subject to prepayment risk.

NET INVESTMENT INCOME

   Net investment income for the years ended December 31 is as follows:



                                                2010     2009     2008
        ($ IN THOUSANDS)                      -------  -------  -------
                                                       
        Fixed income securities.............. $12,480  $12,098  $13,302
        Short-term and other investments.....      21      107      992
                                              -------  -------  -------
           Investment income, before expense.  12,501   12,205   14,294
           Investment expense................    (434)    (422)    (354)
                                              -------  -------  -------
               Net investment income......... $12,067  $11,783  $13,940
                                              =======  =======  =======


REALIZED CAPITAL GAINS AND LOSSES

   The Company recognized net realized capital gains of $694 thousand, $1.5
million and $6.0 million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Realized capital
gains and losses in 2010 and 2009 did not include any other-than-temporary
impairment losses and therefore, none were included in other comprehensive
income. No other-than-temporary impairment losses were included in accumulated
other comprehensive income as of December 31, 2010 and 2009.

   Gross gains of $652 thousand, $1.5 million and $8.2 million were realized on
sales of fixed income securities during 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.
There were no gross losses realized on sales of fixed income securities in 2010
and 2008. Gross losses of $3 thousand were realized on sales of fixed income
securities during 2009.

                                      20



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


UNREALIZED NET CAPITAL GAINS AND LOSSES

   Unrealized net capital gains and losses included in accumulated other
comprehensive income are as follows:



                                                                GROSS UNREALIZED
                                                        FAIR    ---------------  UNREALIZED NET
                                                        VALUE    GAINS   LOSSES  GAINS (LOSSES)
($ IN THOUSANDS)                                       -------- ------- -------  --------------
                                                                     
DECEMBER 31, 2010
Fixed income securities............................... $320,456 $16,100 $  (492)    $15,608
Short-term investments................................   11,593      --      --          --
                                                                                    -------
   Unrealized net capital gains and losses, pre-tax...                               15,608
   Deferred income taxes..............................                               (5,463)
                                                                                    -------
   Unrealized net capital gains and losses, after-tax.                              $10,145
                                                                                    =======

                                                                GROSS UNREALIZED
                                                        FAIR    ---------------  UNREALIZED NET
                                                        VALUE    GAINS   LOSSES  GAINS (LOSSES)
                                                       -------- ------- -------  --------------
DECEMBER 31, 2009
Fixed income securities............................... $308,343 $ 9,930 $(1,374)    $ 8,556
Short-term investments................................    8,557      --      --          --
                                                                                    -------
   Unrealized net capital gains and losses, pre-tax...                                8,556
   Deferred income taxes..............................                               (2,995)
                                                                                    -------
   Unrealized net capital gains and losses, after-tax.                              $ 5,561
                                                                                    =======


CHANGE IN UNREALIZED NET CAPITAL GAINS AND LOSSES

   The change in unrealized net capital gains and losses for the years ended
December 31 is as follows:



                                                           2010     2009     2008
($ IN THOUSANDS)                                         -------  -------  -------
                                                                  
Fixed income securities................................. $ 7,052  $ 8,895  $(6,691)
Short-term investments..................................      --        2       (2)
                                                         -------  -------  -------
   Total................................................   7,052    8,897   (6,693)
Deferred income taxes...................................  (2,468)  (3,114)   2,342
                                                         -------  -------  -------
Increase (decrease) in unrealized net capital gains and
  losses................................................ $ 4,584  $ 5,783  $(4,351)
                                                         =======  =======  =======


PORTFOLIO MONITORING

   The Company has a comprehensive portfolio monitoring process to identify and
evaluate each fixed income security whose carrying value may be
other-than-temporarily impaired.

   For each fixed income security in an unrealized loss position, the Company
assesses whether management with the appropriate authority has made the
decision to sell or whether it is more likely than not the Company will be
required to sell the security before recovery of the amortized cost basis for
reasons such as liquidity, contractual or regulatory purposes. If a security
meets either of these criteria, the security's decline in fair value is
considered other than temporary and is recorded in earnings.

   If the Company has not made the decision to sell the fixed income security
and it is not more likely than not the Company will be required to sell the
fixed income security before recovery of its amortized cost basis, the

                                      21



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

Company evaluates whether it expects to receive cash flows sufficient to
recover the entire amortized cost basis of the security. The Company calculates
the estimated recovery value by discounting the best estimate of future cash
flows at the security's original or current effective rate, as appropriate, and
compares this to the amortized cost of the security. If the Company does not
expect to receive cash flows sufficient to recover the entire amortized cost
basis of the fixed income security, the credit loss component of the impairment
is recorded in earnings, with the remaining amount of the unrealized loss
related to other factors recognized in other comprehensive income.

   The Company's portfolio monitoring process includes a quarterly review of
all securities to identify instances where the fair value of a security
compared to its amortized cost is below established thresholds. The process
also includes the monitoring of other impairment indicators such as ratings,
ratings downgrades and payment defaults. The securities identified, in addition
to other securities for which the Company may have a concern, are evaluated for
potential other-than-temporary impairment using all reasonably available
information relevant to the collectability or recovery of the security.
Inherent in the Company's evaluation of other-than-temporary impairment for
these fixed income securities are assumptions and estimates about the financial
condition and future earnings potential of the issue or issuer. Some of the
factors considered in evaluating whether a decline in fair value is other than
temporary are: 1) the financial condition, near-term and long-term prospects of
the issue or issuer, including relevant industry specific market conditions and
trends, geographic location and implications of rating agency actions and
offering prices; 2) the specific reasons that a security is in an unrealized
loss position, including overall market conditions which could affect
liquidity; and 3) the length of time and extent to which the fair value has
been less than amortized cost.

   The following table summarizes the gross unrealized losses and fair value of
fixed income securities by the length of time that individual securities have
been in a continuous unrealized loss position.



                                  LESS THAN 12 MONTHS           12 MONTHS OR MORE
                              ---------------------------  --------------------------    TOTAL
                               NUMBER    FAIR   UNREALIZED  NUMBER   FAIR   UNREALIZED UNREALIZED
                              OF ISSUES  VALUE    LOSSES   OF ISSUES VALUE    LOSSES     LOSSES
($ IN THOUSANDS)              --------- ------- ---------- --------- ------ ---------- ----------
                                                                  
DECEMBER 31, 2010
U.S. government and agencies.     1     $ 9,546   $(383)      --     $   --   $  --     $  (383)
Corporate....................     1       4,968     (19)      --         --      --         (19)
RMBS.........................     3         385      (3)      --         --      --          (3)
CMBS.........................    --          --      --        1      1,916     (87)        (87)
                                 --     -------   -----       --     ------   -----     -------
   Total.....................     5     $14,899   $(405)       1     $1,916   $ (87)    $  (492)
                                 ==     =======   =====       ==     ======   =====     =======
DECEMBER 31, 2009
U.S. government and agencies.     2     $41,469   $(283)      --     $   --   $  --     $  (283)
Corporate....................     5      11,269     (71)       1      3,485     (14)        (85)
RMBS.........................     1       4,543     (84)      --         --      --         (84)
CMBS.........................     2       3,475     (27)       1      1,158    (846)       (873)
ABS..........................     1       8,445     (49)      --         --      --         (49)
                                 --     -------   -----       --     ------   -----     -------
   Total.....................    11     $69,201   $(514)       2     $4,643   $(860)    $(1,374)
                                 ==     =======   =====       ==     ======   =====     =======


   As of December 31, 2010, all of the unrealized losses are related to fixed
income securities with an unrealized loss position less than 20% of amortized
cost, the degree of which suggests that these securities do not pose a high
risk of being other-than-temporarily impaired. All of the unrealized losses are
related to investment grade fixed income securities. Investment grade is
defined as a security having a rating of Aaa, Aa, A or Baa from Moody's, a
rating of AAA, AA, A or BBB from S&P, Fitch, Dominion or Realpoint, a rating of
aaa, aa, a or bbb from A.M. Best, or a comparable internal rating if an
externally provided rating is not available.

                                      22



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

Unrealized losses on investment grade securities are principally related to
widening credit spreads or rising interest rates since the time of initial
purchase.

   As of December 31, 2010, the Company has not made the decision to sell and
it is not more likely than not the Company will be required to sell fixed
income securities with unrealized losses before recovery of the amortized cost
basis.

MUNICIPAL BONDS

   The principal geographic distribution of municipal bond issuers represented
in the Company's municipal bond portfolio included 84% and 16% in Washington
and Puerto Rico, respectively, as of December 31, 2010 and 83% and 17% in
Washington and Puerto Rico, respectively, as of December 31, 2009.

CONCENTRATION OF CREDIT RISK

   As of December 31, 2010, the Company is not exposed to any credit
concentration risk of a single issuer and its affiliates greater than 10% of
the Company's shareholder's equity.

OTHER INVESTMENT INFORMATION

   As of December 31, 2010, fixed income securities and short-term investments
with a carrying value of $10.0 million were on deposit with regulatory
authorities as required by law.

5. FAIR VALUE OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

   Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset
or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market
participants at the measurement date. The hierarchy for inputs used in
determining fair value maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the
use of unobservable inputs by requiring that observable inputs be used when
available. Assets and liabilities recorded on the Statements of Financial
Position at fair value are categorized in the fair value hierarchy based on the
observability of inputs to the valuation techniques as follows:

LEVEL 1:Assets and liabilities whose values are based on unadjusted quoted
        prices for identical assets or liabilities in an active market that the
        Company can access.

LEVEL 2:Assets and liabilities whose values are based on the following:

       (a)Quoted prices for similar assets or liabilities in active markets;
       (b)Quoted prices for identical or similar assets or liabilities in
          markets that are not active; or
       (c)Valuation models whose inputs are observable, directly or indirectly,
          for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.

LEVEL 3:Assets and liabilities whose values are based on prices or valuation
        techniques that require inputs that are both unobservable and
        significant to the overall fair value measurement. Unobservable inputs
        reflect the Company's estimates of the assumptions that market
        participants would use in valuing the assets and liabilities.

   The availability of observable inputs varies by instrument. In situations
where fair value is based on internally developed pricing models or inputs that
are unobservable in the market, the determination of fair value requires more
judgment. The degree of judgment exercised by the Company in determining fair
value is typically greatest for instruments categorized in Level 3. In many
instances, valuation inputs used to measure fair value fall into
different levels of the fair value hierarchy. The category level in the fair
value hierarchy is determined

                                      23



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

based on the lowest level input that is significant to the fair value
measurement in its entirety. The Company uses prices and inputs that are
current as of the measurement date, including during periods of market
disruption. In periods of market disruption, the ability to observe prices and
inputs may be reduced for many instruments.

   The Company has two types of situations where investments are classified as
Level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. The first is where quotes continue to be
received from independent third-party valuation service providers and all
significant inputs are market observable; however, there has been a significant
decrease in the volume and level of activity for the asset when compared to
normal market activity such that the degree of market observability has
declined to a point where categorization as a Level 3 measurement is considered
appropriate. The indicators considered in determining whether a significant
decrease in the volume and level of activity for a specific asset has occurred
include the level of new issuances in the primary market, trading volume in the
secondary market, the level of credit spreads over historical levels,
applicable bid-ask spreads, and price consensus among market participants and
other pricing sources.

   The second situation where the Company classifies securities in Level 3 is
where specific inputs significant to the fair value estimation models are not
market observable. This relates to the Company's use of broker quotes.

   In determining fair value, the Company principally uses the market approach
which generally utilizes market transaction data for the same or similar
instruments. To a lesser extent, the Company uses the income approach which
involves determining fair values from discounted cash flow methodologies. For
the majority of Level 2 and Level 3 valuations, a combination of the market and
income approaches is used.

SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT VALUATION TECHNIQUES FOR ASSETS AND LIABILITIES MEASURED
AT FAIR VALUE ON A RECURRING BASIS

LEVEL 1 MEASUREMENTS

    .  FIXED INCOME SECURITIES: Comprise U.S. Treasuries. Valuation is based on
       unadjusted quoted prices for identical assets in active markets that the
       Company can access.

    .  SHORT-TERM: Comprise actively traded money market funds that have daily
       quoted net asset values for identical assets that the Company can access.

    .  SEPARATE ACCOUNT ASSETS: Comprise actively traded mutual funds that have
       daily quoted net asset values for identical assets that the Company can
       access. Net asset values for the actively traded mutual funds in which
       the separate account assets are invested are obtained daily from the
       fund managers.

LEVEL 2 MEASUREMENTS

    .  FIXED INCOME SECURITIES:

       U.S. GOVERNMENT AND AGENCIES: The primary inputs to the valuation
       include quoted prices for identical or similar assets in markets that
       are not active, contractual cash flows, benchmark yields and credit
       spreads.

       MUNICIPAL: The primary inputs to the valuation include quoted prices for
       identical or similar assets in markets that are not active, contractual
       cash flows, benchmark yields and credit spreads.

       CORPORATE, INCLUDING PRIVATELY PLACED: The primary inputs to the
       valuation include quoted prices for identical or similar assets in
       markets that are not active, contractual cash flows, benchmark yields
       and credit spreads. Also included are privately placed securities valued
       using a discounted cash flow model that is widely accepted in the
       financial services industry and uses market observable inputs and inputs
       derived principally from, or corroborated by, observable market data.
       The primary inputs to the

                                      24



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

       discounted cash flow model include an interest rate yield curve, as well
       as published credit spreads for similar assets in markets that are not
       active that incorporate the credit quality and industry sector of the
       issuer.

       FOREIGN GOVERNMENT: The primary inputs to the valuation include quoted
       prices for identical or similar assets in markets that are not active,
       contractual cash flows, benchmark yields and credit spreads.

       RMBS--U.S. GOVERNMENT SPONSORED ENTITIES ("U.S. AGENCY"), PRIME
       RESIDENTIAL MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES ("PRIME") AND ALT-A RESIDENTIAL
       MORTGAGE-BACKED SECURITIES ("ALT-A"); ABS: The primary inputs to the
       valuation include quoted prices for identical or similar assets in
       markets that are not active, contractual cash flows, benchmark yields,
       prepayment speeds, collateral performance and credit spreads.

       CMBS: The primary inputs to the valuation include quoted prices for
       identical or similar assets in markets that are not active, contractual
       cash flows, benchmark yields, collateral performance and credit spreads.

    .  SHORT-TERM: The primary inputs to the valuation include quoted prices
       for identical or similar assets in markets that are not active,
       contractual cash flows, benchmark yields and credit spreads. For certain
       short-term investments, amortized cost is used as the best estimate of
       fair value.

LEVEL 3 MEASUREMENTS

    .  FIXED INCOME SECURITIES:

       CORPORATE: Valued based on models that are widely accepted in the
       financial services industry with certain inputs to the valuation model
       that are significant to the valuation, but are not market observable.

       RMBS--PRIME AND ALT-A: Valued based on non-binding broker quotes.

       CMBS: The primary inputs to the valuation include quoted prices for
       identical or similar assets in markets that exhibit less liquidity
       relative to those markets supporting Level 2 fair value measurements,
       contractual cash flows, benchmark yields, collateral performance and
       credit spreads. Due to the reduced availability of actual market prices
       or relevant observable inputs as a result of the decrease in liquidity
       that has been experienced in the market for these securities, certain
       CMBS are categorized as Level 3.

       CONTRACTHOLDER FUNDS: Derivatives embedded in certain life and annuity
       contracts are valued internally using models widely accepted in the
       financial services industry that determine a single best estimate of
       fair value for the embedded derivatives within a block of contractholder
       liabilities. The models primarily use stochastically determined cash
       flows based on the contractual elements of embedded derivatives,
       projected option cost and applicable market data, such as interest rate
       yield curves and equity index volatility assumptions. These are
       categorized as Level 3 as a result of the significance of non-market
       observable inputs.

                                      25



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table summarizes the Company's assets and liabilities measured
at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2010:



                                               QUOTED PRICES   SIGNIFICANT
                                                 IN ACTIVE        OTHER    SIGNIFICANT
                                                MARKETS FOR    OBSERVABLE  UNOBSERVABLE BALANCE AS OF
                                              IDENTICAL ASSETS   INPUTS       INPUTS    DECEMBER 31,
                                                 (LEVEL 1)      (LEVEL 2)   (LEVEL 3)       2010
($ IN THOUSANDS)                              ---------------- ----------- ------------ -------------
                                                                            
ASSETS:
Fixed income securities:
   U.S. government and agencies..............    $   31,007     $ 42,549    $      --    $   73,556
   Municipal.................................            --        3,176           --         3,176
   Corporate.................................            --      162,735          852       163,587
   Foreign government........................            --        5,090           --         5,090
   RMBS......................................            --       50,922        6,880        57,802
   CMBS......................................            --        6,947        1,916         8,863
   ABS.......................................            --        8,382           --         8,382
                                                 ----------     --------    ---------    ----------
       Total fixed income securities.........        31,007      279,801        9,648       320,456
Short-term investments.......................        11,543           50           --        11,593
Separate account assets......................     2,017,185           --           --     2,017,185
                                                 ----------     --------    ---------    ----------
       TOTAL RECURRING BASIS ASSETS..........     2,059,735      279,851        9,648     2,349,234
                                                 ----------     --------    ---------    ----------
TOTAL ASSETS AT FAIR VALUE...................    $2,059,735     $279,851    $   9,648    $2,349,234
                                                 ==========     ========    =========    ==========
% of total assets at fair value..............          87.7%        11.9%         0.4%        100.0%

LIABILITIES:
Contractholder funds:
   Derivatives embedded in life and annuity
     contracts...............................    $       --     $     --    $(494,149)   $ (494,149)
                                                 ----------     --------    ---------    ----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AT FAIR VALUE..............    $       --     $     --    $(494,149)   $ (494,149)
                                                 ==========     ========    =========    ==========
% of total liabilities at fair value.........           -- %         -- %       100.0%        100.0%


                                      26



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table summarizes the Company's assets and liabilities measured
at fair value on a recurring and non-recurring basis as of December 31, 2009:



                                               QUOTED PRICES   SIGNIFICANT
                                                 IN ACTIVE        OTHER    SIGNIFICANT
                                                MARKETS FOR    OBSERVABLE  UNOBSERVABLE BALANCE AS OF
                                              IDENTICAL ASSETS   INPUTS       INPUTS    DECEMBER 31,
                                                 (LEVEL 1)      (LEVEL 2)   (LEVEL 3)       2009
($ IN THOUSANDS)                              ---------------- ----------- ------------ -------------
                                                                            
ASSETS:
Fixed income securities:
   U.S. government and agencies..............    $   29,273     $  52,278    $     --    $   81,551
   Municipal.................................            --         3,095          --         3,095
   Corporate.................................            --       136,484       1,089       137,573
   RMBS......................................            --        67,975          --        67,975
   CMBS......................................            --         8,546       1,158         9,704
   ABS.......................................            --         8,445          --         8,445
                                                 ----------     ---------    --------    ----------
       Total fixed income securities.........        29,273       276,823       2,247       308,343
Short-term investments.......................         8,507            50          --         8,557
Separate account assets......................     2,039,647            --          --     2,039,647
                                                 ----------     ---------    --------    ----------
       TOTAL RECURRING BASIS ASSETS..........     2,077,427       276,873       2,247     2,356,547
                                                 ----------     ---------    --------    ----------
TOTAL ASSETS AT FAIR VALUE...................    $2,077,427     $ 276,873    $  2,247    $2,356,547
                                                 ==========     =========    ========    ==========
% of total assets at fair value..............          88.2%         11.7%        0.1%        100.0%

LIABILITIES:
Contractholder funds:
   Derivatives embedded in life and annuity
     contracts...............................    $       --     $(199,765)   $(15,526)   $ (215,291)
                                                 ----------     ---------    --------    ----------
TOTAL LIABILITIES AT FAIR VALUE..............    $       --     $(199,765)   $(15,526)   $ (215,291)
                                                 ==========     =========    ========    ==========
% of total liabilities at fair value.........           -- %         92.8%        7.2%        100.0%


                                      27



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table presents the rollforward of Level 3 assets and
liabilities held at fair value on a recurring basis during the year ended
December 31, 2010.



                                          TOTAL REALIZED AND UNREALIZED
                                          GAINS (LOSSES) INCLUDED IN:
                                          -----------------------------   PURCHASES,
                                                            OCI ON          SALES,
                            BALANCE AS OF                STATEMENT OF    ISSUANCES AND TRANSFERS  TRANSFERS BALANCE AS OF
                            DECEMBER 31,     NET          FINANCIAL      SETTLEMENTS,    INTO      OUT OF   DECEMBER 31,
                                2009      INCOME/(1)/      POSITION           NET       LEVEL 3    LEVEL 3      2010
($ IN THOUSANDS)            ------------- ----------     ------------    ------------- ---------  --------- -------------
                                                                                       
ASSETS
Fixed income securities:
  Corporate................   $  1,089     $    (1)          $ --           $ 7,740    $      --  $ (7,976)   $     852
  RMBS.....................         --         (17)           131             9,459           --    (2,693)       6,880
  CMBS.....................      1,158          --            758                --           --        --        1,916
                              --------     -------           ----           -------    ---------  --------    ---------
   TOTAL RECURRING
    LEVEL 3 ASSETS.........   $  2,247     $   (18)          $889           $17,199    $      --  $(10,669)   $   9,648
                              ========     =======           ====           =======    =========  ========    =========
LIABILITIES
Contractholder funds:
  Derivatives embedded in
   life and annuity
   contracts...............   $(15,526)    $(4,877)          $ --           $    --    $(473,746) $     --    $(494,149)
                              --------     -------           ----           -------    ---------  --------    ---------
   TOTAL RECURRING
    LEVEL 3 LIABILITIES....   $(15,526)    $(4,877)          $ --           $    --    $(473,476) $     --    $(494,149)
                              ========     =======           ====           =======    =========  ========    =========

--------
/(1)/The amount above attributable to fixed income securities is reported in
     the Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income as net investment
     income. The amount above attributable to derivatives embedded in life and
     annuity contracts is reported as a component of contract benefits and is
     ceded in accordance with the Company's reinsurance agreements.

   Transfers between level categorizations may occur due to changes in the
availability of market observable inputs, which generally are caused by changes
in market conditions such as liquidity, trading volume or bid-ask spreads.
Transfers between level categorizations may also occur due to changes in the
valuation source. For example, in situations where a fair value quote is not
provided by the Company's independent third-party valuation service provider
and as a result the price is stale or has been replaced with a broker quote,
the security is transferred into Level 3. Transfers in and out of level
categorizations are reported as having occurred at the beginning of the quarter
in which the transfer occurred. Therefore, for all transfers into Level 3, all
realized and changes in unrealized gains and losses in the quarter of transfer
are reflected in the Level 3 rollforward table.

   There were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 during 2010.

   Transfers out of Level 3 during 2010, including those related to Corporate
fixed income securities and RMBS, included situations where a broker quote was
used in a prior period and a fair value quote became available from the
Company's independent third-party valuation service provider in the current
period. A quote utilizing the new pricing source was not available as of the
prior period, and any gains or losses related to the change in valuation source
for individual securities were not significant.

   Transfers into Level 3 during 2010 also included derivatives embedded in
equity-indexed life and annuity contracts due to refinements in the valuation
modeling resulting in an increase in significance of non-market observable
inputs.

                                      28



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table provides the total gains and (losses) included in net
income during 2010 for Level 3 assets still held as of December 31, 2010.



        ($ IN THOUSANDS)
                                                            
        ASSETS
        Fixed income securities:
           Corporate.......................................... $    (2)
           RMBS...............................................     (11)
           CMBS...............................................      (1)
                                                               -------
               TOTAL RECURRING LEVEL 3 ASSETS................. $   (14)
                                                               =======
        LIABILITIES
        Contractholder funds:
           Derivatives embedded in life and annuity contracts. $(4,877)
                                                               -------
               TOTAL RECURRING LEVEL 3 LIABILITIES............ $(4,877)
                                                               =======


   The amounts in the table above represent losses included in net income
during 2010 for the period of time that the asset was determined to be in Level
3. The amounts attributable to fixed income securities are reported in the
Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income in net investment income. The
amount attributable to derivatives embedded in life and annuity contracts is
reported as a component of contract benefits and is ceded in accordance with
the Company's reinsurance agreements.

   The following table presents the rollforward of Level 3 assets and
liabilities held at fair value on a recurring basis during the year ended
December 31, 2009.



                                                                                                               TOTAL GAINS
                                            TOTAL REALIZED AND                                                   (LOSSES)
                                             UNREALIZED GAINS                                                  INCLUDED IN
                                           (LOSSES) INCLUDED IN:                                                NET INCOME
-                                         ----------------------    PURCHASES,                                FOR FINANCIAL
                                                         OCI ON       SALES,     NET TRANSFERS                 INSTRUMENTS
                            BALANCE AS OF             STATEMENT OF ISSUANCES AND    IN AND/    BALANCE AS OF STILL HELD AS OF
                            DECEMBER 31,     NET       FINANCIAL   SETTLEMENTS,    OR (OUT)    DECEMBER 31,    DECEMBER 31,
                                2008      INCOME/(1)/   POSITION        NET       OF LEVEL 3       2009         2009/(2)/
($ IN THOUSANDS)            ------------- ----------  ------------ ------------- ------------- ------------- ----------------
                                                                                        
ASSETS
Fixed income securities:
  Corporate................   $  1,307     $    (2)       $ 96        $  (216)       $(96)       $  1,089        $    (2)
  CMBS.....................         --          --         535             --         623           1,158             --
  ABS......................      6,002         288         (19)        (6,271)         --              --             --
                              --------     -------        ----        -------        ----        --------        -------
   TOTAL RECURRING
    LEVEL 3 ASSETS.........   $  7,309     $   286        $612        $(6,487)       $527        $  2,247        $    (2)
                              ========     =======        ====        =======        ====        ========        =======
LIABILITIES
Contractholder funds:
  Derivatives embedded in
   life and annuity
   contracts...............   $(36,544)    $19,984        $ --        $ 1,034        $ --        $(15,526)       $19,984
                              --------     -------        ----        -------        ----        --------        -------
   TOTAL RECURRING
    LEVEL 3 LIABILITIES....   $(36,544)    $19,984        $ --        $ 1,034        $ --        $(15,526)       $19,984
                              ========     =======        ====        =======        ====        ========        =======

--------
/(1)/The amount above attributable to fixed income securities is reported in
     the Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income as follows: $288
     thousand in realized capital gains and losses and $(2) thousand in net
     investment income. The amount above attributable to derivatives embedded
     in life and annuity contracts is reported as a component of contract
     benefits and is ceded in accordance with the Company's reinsurance
     agreements.
/(2)/The amount above attributable to fixed income securities is reported as a
     component of net investment income in the Statements of Operations and
     Comprehensive Income. The amount above attributable to derivatives
     embedded in life and annuity contracts is reported as a component of
     contract benefits and is ceded in accordance with the Company's
     reinsurance agreements.

                                      29



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table presents the rollforward of Level 3 assets and
liabilities held at fair value on a recurring basis during the year ended
December 31, 2008.



                                                                                                            TOTAL GAINS
                                                     TOTAL REALIZED AND                                       (LOSSES)
                                                   UNREALIZED GAINS (LOSSES)                                INCLUDED IN
                                                        INCLUDED IN:                                         NET INCOME
                                                   ------------------------    PURCHASES,                  FOR FINANCIAL
                                                                   OCI ON        SALES,                     INSTRUMENTS
                                     BALANCE AS OF              STATEMENT OF  ISSUANCES AND BALANCE AS OF STILL HELD AS OF
                                      JANUARY 1,      NET        FINANCIAL    SETTLEMENTS,  DECEMBER 31,    DECEMBER 31,
                                         2008      INCOME/(1)/    POSITION         NET          2008         2008/(2)/
($ IN THOUSANDS)                     ------------- ----------   ------------  ------------- ------------- ----------------
                                                                                        
ASSETS
Fixed income securities:
  Corporate.........................    $ 1,500     $     (1)      $  --         $  (192)     $  1,307        $     (2)
  ABS...............................     10,484          181        (434)         (4,229)        6,002              (1)
                                        -------     --------       -----         -------      --------        --------
   TOTAL RECURRING LEVEL 3 ASSETS...    $11,984     $    180       $(434)        $(4,421)     $  7,309        $     (3)
                                        =======     ========       =====         =======      ========        ========
LIABILITIES
Contractholder funds:
  Derivatives embedded in life and
   annuity contracts................    $  (256)    $(36,498)      $  --         $   210      $(36,544)       $(36,498)
                                        -------     --------       -----         -------      --------        --------
   TOTAL RECURRING LEVEL 3
    LIABILITIES.....................    $  (256)    $(36,498)      $  --         $   210      $(36,544)       $(36,498)
                                        =======     ========       =====         =======      ========        ========

--------
/(1)/The amount above attributable to fixed income securities is reported in
     the Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income as follows: $185
     thousand in realized capital gains and losses and $(5) thousand in net
     investment income. The amount above attributable to derivatives embedded
     in life and annuity contracts is reported as a component of contract
     benefits and is ceded in accordance with the Company's reinsurance
     agreements.
/(2)/The amount above attributable to fixed income securities is reported as a
     component of net investment income in the Statements of Operations and
     Comprehensive Income. The amount above attributable to derivatives
     embedded in life and annuity contracts is reported as a component of
     contract benefits and is ceded in accordance with the Company's
     reinsurance agreements.

   As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, financial instruments not carried at fair
value included contractholder funds on investment contracts. The carrying value
and fair value of contractholder funds on investment contracts were $12.69
billion and $11.66 billion, respectively, as of December 31, 2010 and were
$13.64 billion and $12.64 billion, respectively, as of December 31, 2009.

   The fair value of contractholder funds on investment contracts is based on
the terms of the underlying contracts utilizing prevailing market rates for
similar contracts adjusted for the Company's own credit risk. Deferred
annuities included in contractholder funds are valued using discounted cash
flow models which incorporate market value margins, which are based on the cost
of holding economic capital, and the Company's own credit risk. Immediate
annuities without life contingencies are valued at the present value of future
benefits using market implied interest rates which include the Company's own
credit risk.

6. DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

   The Company has derivatives embedded in non-derivative host contracts that
are required to be separated from the host contracts and accounted for at fair
value. The Company does not use derivatives for trading purposes. The Company's
embedded derivatives are equity options in life and annuity product contracts,
which provide equity returns to contractholders; and guaranteed minimum
accumulation and withdrawal benefits in variable annuity contracts.

                                      30



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table provides a summary of the volume and fair value
positions of embedded derivative financial instruments as well as their
reporting location in the Statement of Financial Position as of December 31,
2010. None of these derivatives are designated as accounting hedging
instruments.



                                                                    VOLUME -     FAIR
                                                                    NOTIONAL    VALUE,   GROSS   GROSS
                                           BALANCE SHEET LOCATION    AMOUNT      NET     ASSET LIABILITY
($ IN THOUSANDS)                           ----------------------  ---------- ---------  ----- ---------
                                                                                
Equity index and forward starting options
  in life and annuity product contracts... Contractholder funds    $4,351,559 $(473,746)  $--  $(473,746)
Guaranteed accumulation benefits.......... Contractholder funds       228,195   (18,422)   --    (18,422)
Guaranteed withdrawal benefits............ Contractholder funds        32,473    (1,981)   --     (1,981)
                                                                   ---------- ---------   ---  ---------
TOTAL DERIVATIVES.........................                         $4,612,227 $(494,149)  $--  $(494,149)
                                                                   ========== =========   ===  =========


   The following table provides a summary of the volume and fair value
positions of embedded derivative financial instruments as well as their
reporting location in the Statement of Financial Position as of December 31,
2009. None of these derivatives are designated as accounting hedging
instruments.



                                                                    VOLUME -     FAIR
                                                                    NOTIONAL    VALUE,   GROSS   GROSS
                                           BALANCE SHEET LOCATION    AMOUNT      NET     ASSET LIABILITY
($ IN THOUSANDS)                           ----------------------  ---------- ---------  ----- ---------
                                                                                
Equity index and forward starting options
  in life and annuity product contracts... Contractholder funds    $4,018,238 $(199,765)  $--  $(199,765)
Guaranteed accumulation benefits.......... Contractholder funds       237,005   (13,690)   --    (13,690)
Guaranteed withdrawal benefits............ Contractholder funds        37,835    (1,836)   --     (1,836)
                                                                   ---------- ---------   ---  ---------
TOTAL DERIVATIVES.........................                         $4,293,078 $(215,291)  $--  $(215,291)
                                                                   ========== =========   ===  =========


   For the year ended December 31, 2010 gains and losses from valuation and
settlements on embedded derivative financial instruments recorded in interest
credited to contractholder funds and contract benefits were $31.0 million and
$(4.9) million, respectively, which in turn were ceded to ALIC. For the year
ended December 31, 2009 gains and losses from valuation and settlements on
embedded derivative financial instruments recorded in interest credited to
contractholder funds and contract benefits were $(166.3) million and $21.0
million, respectively, which in turn were ceded to ALIC.

OFF-BALANCE-SHEET FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

   There were no off-balance-sheet financial instruments as of December 31,
2010 or 2009.

7. RESERVE FOR LIFE-CONTINGENT CONTRACT BENEFITS AND CONTRACTHOLDER FUNDS

   As of December 31, the reserve for life-contingent contract benefits
consists of the following:



                                                        2010       2009
     ($ IN THOUSANDS)                                ---------- ----------
                                                          
     Traditional life insurance..................... $1,363,098 $1,280,461
     Immediate fixed annuities......................    680,467    686,057
     Accident and health insurance..................    961,030    831,211
     Other..........................................      6,722      7,658
                                                     ---------- ----------
        Total reserve for life-contingent contract
          benefits.................................. $3,011,317 $2,805,387
                                                     ========== ==========


                                      31



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table highlights the key assumptions generally used in
calculating the reserve for life-contingent contract benefits:



        PRODUCT                    MORTALITY               INTEREST RATE           ESTIMATION METHOD
-------------------------   ------------------------  ------------------------  ------------------------
                                                                       
Traditional life            Actual company            Interest rate             Net level premium
insurance                   experience plus loading   assumptions range from    reserve method using the
                                                      4.0% to 8.0%              Company's withdrawal
                                                                                experience rates

Immediate fixed annuities   1983 individual annuity   Interest rate             Present value of
                            mortality table with      assumptions range from    expected future benefits
                            internal modifications;   1.2% to 8.8%              based on historical
                            1983 individual annuity                             experience
                            mortality table; Annuity
                            2000 mortality table
                            with internal
                            modifications

Accident and health         Actual company                                      Unearned premium;
insurance                   experience plus loading                             additional contract
                                                                                reserves for mortality
                                                                                risk

Other:

   Variable annuity         100% of Annuity 2000      Interest rate             Projected benefit ratio
   guaranteed minimum       mortality table           assumptions range from    applied to cumulative
   death benefits                                     4.2% to 5.2%              assessments


   As of December 31, contractholder funds consist of the following:



                                                   2010        2009
         ($ IN THOUSANDS)                       ----------- -----------
                                                      
         Interest-sensitive life insurance..... $ 4,314,502 $ 3,844,319
         Investment contracts:
            Fixed annuities....................  12,728,648  13,675,700
            Other investment contracts.........     203,921     113,008
                                                ----------- -----------
                Total contractholder funds..... $17,247,071 $17,633,027
                                                =========== ===========


                                      32



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The following table highlights the key contract provisions relating to
contractholder funds:



               PRODUCT                               INTEREST RATE                WITHDRAWAL/SURRENDER CHARGES
-------------------------------------    -------------------------------------  ----------------------------------
                                                                          
Interest-sensitive life insurance        Interest rates credited range from 0%  Either a percentage of account
                                         to 11.5% for equity-indexed life       balance or dollar amount
                                         (whose returns are indexed to the S&P  grading off generally over 20
                                         500) and 2.7% to 6.0% for all other    years
                                         products

Fixed annuities                          Interest rates credited range from 0%  Either a declining or a level
                                         to 8.8% for immediate annuities; 0%    percentage charge generally
                                         to 14.0% for equity-indexed annuities  over nine years or less.
                                         (whose returns are indexed to the S&P  Additionally, approximately
                                         500); and 1.0% to 8.5% for all other   19.0% of fixed annuities are
                                         products                               subject to market value
                                                                                adjustment for discretionary
                                                                                withdrawals.

Other investment contracts:

   Guaranteed minimum income,            Interest rates used in establishing    Withdrawal and surrender
   accumulation and withdrawal           reserves range from 1.8% to 10.3%      charges are based on the terms
   benefits on variable annuities and                                           of the related interest-sensitive
   secondary guarantees on                                                      life insurance or fixed annuity
   interest-sensitive life insurance                                            contract.
   and fixed annuities


   Contractholder funds activity for the years ended December 31 is as follows:



                                                  2010         2009
        ($ IN THOUSANDS)                      -----------  -----------
                                                     
        Balance, beginning of year........... $17,633,027  $17,787,376
        Deposits.............................   1,521,086    1,751,516
        Interest credited....................     743,075      821,046
        Benefits.............................    (504,789)    (523,905)
        Surrenders and partial withdrawals...  (1,811,355)  (1,826,122)
        Contract charges.....................    (471,729)    (417,398)
        Net transfers from separate accounts.      18,788       14,400
        Other adjustments....................     118,968       26,114
                                              -----------  -----------
        Balance, end of year................. $17,247,071  $17,633,027
                                              ===========  ===========


                                      33



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The table below presents information regarding the Company's variable
annuity contracts with guarantees. The Company's variable annuity contracts may
offer more than one type of guarantee in each contract; therefore, the sum of
amounts listed exceeds the total account balances of variable annuity
contracts' separate accounts with guarantees.



                                                              DECEMBER 31,
                                                           -------------------
                                                             2010      2009
  ($ IN MILLIONS)                                          --------- ---------
                                                               
  IN THE EVENT OF DEATH
     Separate account value............................... $ 1,318.1 $ 1,405.4
     Net amount at risk/(1)/.............................. $   126.3 $   213.1
     Average attained age of contractholders..............  57 years  57 years

  AT ANNUITIZATION (INCLUDES INCOME BENEFIT GUARANTEES)
     Separate account value............................... $   252.8 $   263.7
     Net amount at risk/(2)/.............................. $    40.9 $    75.9
     Weighted average waiting period until annuitization
       options available..................................   3 years   3 years

  FOR CUMULATIVE PERIODIC WITHDRAWALS
     Separate account value............................... $    33.1 $    37.8
     Net amount at risk/(3)/.............................. $     0.3 $     0.6

  ACCUMULATION AT SPECIFIED DATES
     Separate account value............................... $   233.7 $   236.8
     Net amount at risk/(4)/.............................. $    18.9 $    26.9
     Weighted average waiting period until guarantee
       date...............................................   9 years  10 years

--------
/(1)/Defined as the estimated current guaranteed minimum death benefit in
     excess of the current account balance as of the balance sheet date.
/(2)/Defined as the estimated present value of the guaranteed minimum annuity
     payments in excess of the current account balance.
/(3)/Defined as the estimated current guaranteed minimum withdrawal balance
     (initial deposit) in excess of the current account balance as of the
     balance sheet date.
/(4)/Defined as the estimated present value of the guaranteed minimum
     accumulation balance in excess of the current account balance.

   As of December 31, 2010, liabilities for guarantees included reserves for
variable annuity death benefits of $6.7 million, variable annuity income
benefits of $19.8 million, variable annuity accumulation benefits of $18.4
million, variable annuity withdrawal benefits of $2.0 million and
interest-sensitive life and fixed annuity guarantees of $163.7 million. As of
December 31, 2009, liabilities for guarantees included reserves for variable
annuity death benefits of $7.7 million, variable annuity income benefits of
$24.7 million, variable annuity accumulation benefits of $13.7 million,
variable annuity withdrawal benefits of $1.8 million and interest-sensitive
life and fixed annuity guarantees of $72.8 million.

8. REINSURANCE

   The Company has reinsurance agreements under which it reinsures all of its
business to ALIC or other non-affiliated reinsurers. Under the agreements,
premiums, contract charges, interest credited to contractholder funds, contract
benefits and substantially all expenses are reinsured. The Company purchases
reinsurance to limit aggregate and single losses on large risks. The Company
cedes a portion of the mortality risk on certain life policies under
coinsurance agreements to a pool of twelve non-affiliated reinsurers.

                                      34



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   As of December 31, 2010, 90.6% of the total reinsurance recoverables were
related to ALIC and 9.4% were related to non-affiliated reinsurers. At both
December 31, 2010 and 2009, 97% of the Company's non-affiliated reinsurance
recoverables are due from companies rated A or better by S&P.

   The effects of reinsurance on premiums and contract charges for the years
ended December 31 are as follows:



                                             2010        2009        2008
   ($ IN THOUSANDS)                       ----------  ----------  ----------
                                                         
   PREMIUMS AND CONTRACT CHARGES
   Direct................................ $1,228,272  $1,194,526  $1,138,747
   Assumed...............................      7,465       7,849       8,576
   Ceded:
      Affiliate..........................   (782,113)   (734,369)   (691,267)
      Non-affiliate......................   (453,624)   (468,006)   (456,056)
                                          ----------  ----------  ----------
   Premiums and contract charges, net of
     reinsurance......................... $       --  $       --  $       --
                                          ==========  ==========  ==========


   The effects of reinsurance on interest credited to contractholder funds,
contract benefits and expenses for the years ended December 31 are as follows:



                                                2010         2009         2008
($ IN THOUSANDS)                            -----------  -----------  -----------
                                                             
INTEREST CREDITED TO CONTRACTHOLDER FUNDS,
  CONTRACT BENEFITS AND EXPENSES
Direct..................................... $ 2,186,031  $ 2,159,262  $ 2,065,299
Assumed....................................       8,153       11,101        8,922
Ceded:
   Affiliate...............................  (1,683,487)  (1,621,011)  (1,468,505)
   Non-affiliate...........................    (510,697)    (549,352)    (605,716)
                                            -----------  -----------  -----------
Interest credited to contractholder funds,
  contract benefits and expenses, net of
  reinsurance.............................. $        --  $        --  $        --
                                            ===========  ===========  ===========


9. GUARANTEES AND CONTINGENT LIABILITIES

GUARANTEES

   In the normal course of business, the Company provides standard
indemnifications to contractual counterparties in connection with numerous
transactions, including acquisitions and divestitures. The types of
indemnifications typically provided include indemnifications for breaches of
representations and warranties, taxes and certain other liabilities, such as
third party lawsuits. The indemnification clauses are often standard
contractual terms and are entered into in the normal course of business based
on an assessment that the risk of loss would be remote. The terms of the
indemnifications vary in duration and nature. In many cases, the maximum
obligation is not explicitly stated and the contingencies triggering the
obligation to indemnify have not occurred and are not expected to occur.
Consequently, the maximum amount of the obligation under such indemnifications
is not determinable. Historically, the Company has not made any material
payments pursuant to these obligations.

   The aggregate liability balance related to all guarantees was not material
as of December 31, 2010.

                                      35



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


REGULATION AND COMPLIANCE

   The Company is subject to changing social, economic and regulatory
conditions. From time to time, regulatory authorities or legislative bodies
seek to impose additional regulations regarding agent and broker compensation,
regulate the nature of and amount of investments, and otherwise expand overall
regulation of insurance products and the insurance industry. The Company has
established procedures and policies to facilitate compliance with laws and
regulations, to foster prudent business operations, and to support financial
reporting. The Company routinely reviews its practices to validate compliance
with laws and regulations and with internal procedures and policies. As a
result of these reviews, from time to time the Company may decide to modify
some of its procedures and policies. Such modifications, and the reviews that
led to them, may be accompanied by payments being made and costs being
incurred. The ultimate changes and eventual effects of these actions on the
Company's business, if any, are uncertain.

LEGAL AND REGULATORY PROCEEDINGS AND INQUIRIES

BACKGROUND

   The Company and certain affiliates are involved in a number of lawsuits,
regulatory inquiries, and other legal proceedings arising out of various
aspects of its business. As background to the "Proceedings" subsection below,
please note the following:

    .  These matters raise difficult and complicated factual and legal issues
       and are subject to many uncertainties and complexities, including the
       underlying facts of each matter; novel legal issues; variations between
       jurisdictions in which matters are being litigated, heard, or
       investigated; differences in applicable laws and judicial
       interpretations; the length of time before many of these matters might
       be resolved by settlement, through litigation, or otherwise; the fact
       that some of the lawsuits are putative class actions in which a class
       has not been certified and in which the purported class may not be
       clearly defined; the fact that some of the lawsuits involve multi-state
       class actions in which the applicable law(s) for the claims at issue is
       in dispute and therefore unclear; and the current challenging legal
       environment faced by large corporations and insurance companies.

    .  The outcome of these matters may be affected by decisions, verdicts, and
       settlements, and the timing of such decisions, verdicts, and
       settlements, in other individual and class action lawsuits that involve
       the Company, other insurers, or other entities and by other legal,
       governmental, and regulatory actions that involve the Company, other
       insurers, or other entities. The outcome may also be affected by future
       state or federal legislation, the timing or substance of which cannot be
       predicted.

    .  In the lawsuits, plaintiffs seek a variety of remedies which may include
       equitable relief in the form of injunctive and other remedies and
       monetary relief in the form of contractual and extra-contractual
       damages. In some cases, the monetary damages sought may include punitive
       or treble damages. Often specific information about the relief sought,
       such as the amount of damages, is not available because plaintiffs have
       not requested specific relief in their pleadings. When specific monetary
       demands are made, they are often set just below a state court
       jurisdictional limit in order to seek the maximum amount available in
       state court, regardless of the specifics of the case, while still
       avoiding the risk of removal to federal court. In the Company's
       experience, monetary demands in pleadings bear little relation to the
       ultimate loss, if any, to the Company.

    .  In connection with regulatory examinations and proceedings, government
       authorities may seek various forms of relief, including penalties,
       restitution and changes in business practices. The Company may not be
       advised of the nature and extent of relief sought until the final stages
       of the examination or proceeding.

                                      36



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


    .  For the reasons specified above, it is not possible to make meaningful
       estimates of the amount or range of loss that could result from the
       matters described below in the "Proceedings" subsection. The Company
       reviews these matters on an ongoing basis and follows appropriate
       accounting guidance when making accrual and disclosure decisions. When
       assessing reasonably possible and probable outcomes, the Company bases
       its decisions on its assessment of the ultimate outcome following all
       appeals.

    .  Due to the complexity and scope of the matters disclosed in the
       "Proceedings" subsection below and the many uncertainties that exist,
       the ultimate outcome of these matters cannot be reasonably predicted. In
       the event of an unfavorable outcome in one or more of these matters, the
       ultimate liability may be in excess of amounts currently reserved, if
       any, and may be material to the Company's operating results or cash
       flows for a particular quarterly or annual period. However, based on
       information currently known to it, management believes that the ultimate
       outcome of all matters described below, as they are resolved over time,
       is not likely to have a material adverse effect on the financial
       position of the Company.

PROCEEDINGS

   Legal proceedings involving Allstate agencies and AIC may impact the
Company, even when the Company is not directly involved, because the Company
sells its products through a variety of distribution channels including
Allstate agencies. Consequently, information about the more significant of
these proceedings is provided in the following paragraph.

   AIC is defending certain matters relating to its agency program
reorganization announced in 1999. These matters are in various stages of
development.

    .  These matters include a lawsuit filed in 2001 by the U.S. Equal
       Employment Opportunity Commission ("EEOC") alleging retaliation under
       federal civil rights laws (the "EEOC I" suit) and a class action filed
       in 2001 by former employee agents alleging retaliation and age
       discrimination under the Age Discrimination in Employment Act ("ADEA"),
       breach of contract and ERISA violations (the "Romero I" suit). In 2004,
       in the consolidated EEOC I and Romero I litigation, the trial court
       issued a memorandum and order that, among other things, certified
       classes of agents, including a mandatory class of agents who had signed
       a release, for purposes of effecting the court's declaratory judgment
       that the release is voidable at the option of the release signer. The
       court also ordered that an agent who voids the release must return to
       AIC "any and all benefits received by the [agent] in exchange for
       signing the release." The court also stated that, "on the undisputed
       facts of record, there is no basis for claims of age discrimination."
       The EEOC and plaintiffs asked the court to clarify and/or reconsider its
       memorandum and order and in January 2007, the judge denied their
       request. In June 2007, the court granted AIC's motions for summary
       judgment. Following plaintiffs' filing of a notice of appeal, the U.S.
       Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit ("Third Circuit") issued an order
       in December 2007 stating that the notice of appeal was not taken from a
       final order within the meaning of the federal law and thus not
       appealable at this time. In March 2008, the Third Circuit decided that
       the appeal should not summarily be dismissed and that the question of
       whether the matter is appealable at this time will be addressed by the
       Third Circuit along with the merits of the appeal. In July 2009, the
       Third Circuit vacated the decision which granted AIC's summary judgment
       motions, remanded the cases to the trial court for additional discovery,
       and directed that the cases be reassigned to another trial court judge.
       In January 2010, the cases were assigned to a new judge for further
       proceedings in the trial court.

    .  A putative nationwide class action has also been filed by former
       employee agents alleging various violations of ERISA, including a worker
       classification issue. These plaintiffs are challenging certain
       amendments to the Agents Pension Plan and are seeking to have exclusive
       agent independent

                                      37



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)

      contractors treated as employees for benefit purposes. This matter was
       dismissed with prejudice by the trial court, was the subject of further
       proceedings on appeal, and was reversed and remanded to the trial court
       in 2005. In June 2007, the court granted AIC's motion to dismiss the
       case. Following plaintiffs' filing of a notice of appeal, the Third
       Circuit issued an order in December 2007 stating that the notice of
       appeal was not taken from a final order within the meaning of the
       federal law and thus not appealable at this time. In March 2008, the
       Third Circuit decided that the appeal should not summarily be dismissed
       and that the question of whether the matter is appealable at this time
       will be addressed by the Third Circuit along with the merits of the
       appeal. In July 2009, the Third Circuit vacated the decision which
       granted AIC's motion to dismiss the case, remanded the case to the trial
       court for additional discovery, and directed that the case be reassigned
       to another trial court judge. In January 2010, the case was assigned to
       a new judge for further proceedings in the trial court.

   In these agency program reorganization matters, plaintiffs seek compensatory
and punitive damages, and equitable relief. AIC has been vigorously defending
these lawsuits and other matters related to its agency program reorganization.

OTHER MATTERS

   Various other legal, governmental, and regulatory actions, including state
market conduct exams, and other governmental and regulatory inquiries are
pending from time to time that involve the Company and specific aspects of its
conduct of business. Like other members of the insurance industry, the Company
is the target of a number of lawsuits and proceedings, some of which involve
claims for substantial or indeterminate amounts. These actions are based on a
variety of issues and target a range of the Company's practices. The outcome of
these disputes is currently unpredictable. However, based on information
currently known to it and the existence of the reinsurance agreements with
ALIC, management believes that the ultimate outcome of all matters described in
this "Other Matters" subsection, in excess of amounts currently reserved, if
any, as they are resolved over time, is not likely to have a material effect on
the operating results, cash flows or financial position of the Company.

10. INCOME TAXES

   The Company joins the Corporation and its other domestic subsidiaries (the
"Allstate Group") in the filing of a consolidated federal income tax return and
is party to a federal income tax allocation agreement (the "Allstate Tax
Sharing Agreement"). Under the Allstate Tax Sharing Agreement, the Company pays
to or receives from the Corporation the amount, if any, by which the Allstate
Group's federal income tax liability is affected by virtue of inclusion of the
Company in the consolidated federal income tax return. The Company also has a
supplemental tax sharing agreement with respect to reinsurance ceded to ALIC to
allocate the tax benefits and costs related to such reinsurance. Effectively,
these agreements result in the Company's annual income tax provision being
computed, with adjustments, as if the Company filed a separate return, adjusted
for the reinsurance ceded to ALIC.

   The Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") is currently examining the Allstate
Group's 2007 and 2008 federal income tax returns. The IRS has completed its
examination of the Allstate Group's federal income tax returns through 2006 and
the statute of limitations has expired on years prior to 2005. Any adjustments
that may result from IRS examinations of tax returns are not expected to have a
material effect on the results of operations, cash flows or financial position
of the Company.

   The Company had no liability for unrecognized tax benefits as of
December 31, 2010 or 2009, and believes it is reasonably possible that the
liability balance will not significantly increase within the next twelve
months. No amounts have been accrued for interest or penalties.

                                      38



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   The components of the deferred income tax assets and liabilities as of
December 31 are as follows:



                                                       2010     2009
          ($ IN THOUSANDS)                           -------  -------
                                                        
          DEFERRED ASSETS
          Tax credit carryforward................... $     7  $    --
                                                     -------  -------
             Total deferred assets..................       7       --
                                                     -------  -------
          DEFERRED LIABILITIES
             Unrealized net capital gains...........  (5,463)  (2,995)
             Other liabilities......................    (377)    (305)
                                                     -------  -------
                 Total deferred liabilities.........  (5,840)  (3,300)
                                                     -------  -------
                    Net deferred liabilities........ $(5,833) $(3,300)
                                                     =======  =======


   Although realization is not assured, management believes it is more likely
than not that the deferred tax assets will be realized based on the Company's
assessment that the deductions ultimately recognized for tax purposes will be
fully utilized.

   The components of income tax expense for the years ended December 31 are as
follows:



                                             2010   2009   2008
               ($ IN THOUSANDS)             ------ ------ ------
                                                 
               Current..................... $4,386 $4,447 $7,054
               Deferred....................     65    187   (136)
                                            ------ ------ ------
                  Total income tax expense. $4,451 $4,634 $6,918
                                            ====== ====== ======


   As of December 31, 2010, the Company has tax credit carryforwards of $7
thousand which will be available to offset future tax liabilities. These
carryforwards will expire at the end of 2029 and 2030.

   The Company paid income taxes of $4.7 million, $6.8 million and $4.9 million
in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively.

   A reconciliation of the statutory federal income tax rate to the effective
income tax rate on income from operations for the years ended December 31 is as
follows:



                                                 2010  2009  2008
                                                 ----  ----  ----
                                                    
              Statutory federal income tax rate. 35.0% 35.0% 35.0%
              Other............................. (0.1) (0.1) (0.2)
                                                 ----  ----  ----
              Effective income tax rate......... 34.9% 34.9% 34.8%
                                                 ====  ====  ====


11. STATUTORY FINANCIAL INFORMATION

   The Company prepares its statutory-basis financial statements in conformity
with accounting practices prescribed or permitted by the State of Nebraska.
Prescribed statutory accounting practices include a variety of publications of
the National Association of Insurance Commissioners ("NAIC"), as well as state
laws, regulations and general administrative rules. Permitted statutory
accounting practices encompass all accounting practices not so prescribed. The
State of Nebraska requires insurance companies domiciled in its state to
prepare statutory-basis financial statements in conformity with the NAIC
Accounting Practices and Procedures Manual, subject to any deviations
prescribed or permitted by the State of Nebraska Insurance Commissioner.

                                      39



                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS--(CONTINUED)


   Statutory accounting practices differ from GAAP primarily since they require
charging policy acquisition and certain sales inducement costs to expense as
incurred, establishing life insurance reserves based on different actuarial
assumptions, and valuing certain investments and establishing deferred taxes on
a different basis.

   Statutory net income for 2010, 2009, and 2008 was $8.7 million, $8.5 million
and $7.8 million, respectively. Statutory capital and surplus was $310.8
million and $306.0 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

DIVIDENDS

   The ability of the Company to pay dividends is dependent on business
conditions, income, cash requirements of the Company and other relevant
factors. The payment of shareholder dividends by the Company without the prior
approval of the state insurance regulator is limited to formula amounts based
on net income and capital and surplus, determined in conformity with statutory
accounting practices, as well as the timing and amount of dividends paid in the
preceding twelve months. The maximum amount of dividends that the Company can
pay during 2011 without prior approval of the Nebraska Department of Insurance
is $31.1 million. The Company did not pay any dividends in 2010.

12. OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

   The components of other comprehensive income (loss) on a pre-tax and
after-tax basis for the years ended December 31 are as follows:



                                                                                   2010
                                                                        --------------------------
                                                                        PRE-TAX    TAX    AFTER-TAX
($ IN THOUSANDS)                                                        -------  -------  ---------
                                                                                 
Unrealized net holding gains arising during the period................. $ 7,746  $(2,711)  $ 5,035
Less: reclassification adjustment of realized capital gains and losses.     694     (243)      451
                                                                        -------  -------   -------
Unrealized net capital gains and losses................................   7,052   (2,468)    4,584
                                                                        -------  -------   -------
Other comprehensive income............................................. $ 7,052  $(2,468)  $ 4,584
                                                                        =======  =======   =======

                                                                                   2009
                                                                        --------------------------
                                                                        PRE-TAX    TAX    AFTER-TAX
                                                                        -------  -------  ---------
Unrealized net holding gains arising during the period................. $10,135  $(3,547)  $ 6,588
Less: reclassification adjustment of realized capital gains and losses.   1,238     (433)      805
                                                                        -------  -------   -------
Unrealized net capital gains and losses................................   8,897   (3,114)    5,783
                                                                        -------  -------   -------
Other comprehensive income............................................. $ 8,897  $(3,114)  $ 5,783
                                                                        =======  =======   =======

                                                                                   2008
                                                                        --------------------------
                                                                        PRE-TAX    TAX    AFTER-TAX
                                                                        -------  -------  ---------
Unrealized net holding losses arising during the period................ $(3,078) $ 1,077   $(2,001)
Less: reclassification adjustment of realized capital gains and losses.   3,615   (1,265)    2,350
                                                                        -------  -------   -------
Unrealized net capital gains and losses................................  (6,693)   2,342    (4,351)
                                                                        -------  -------   -------
Other comprehensive loss............................................... $(6,693) $ 2,342   $(4,351)
                                                                        =======  =======   =======


                                      40



                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                      SCHEDULE I--SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS
                   OTHER THAN INVESTMENTS IN RELATED PARTIES
                               DECEMBER 31, 2010



                                                                                              AMOUNT AT
                                                                                                WHICH
                                                                                              SHOWN IN
                                                                          AMORTIZED  FAIR    THE BALANCE
                                                                            COST     VALUE      SHEET
($ IN THOUSANDS)                                                          --------- -------- -----------
                                                                                    
TYPE OF INVESTMENT
Fixed maturities:
   Bonds:
       United States government, government agencies and authorities..... $ 70,426  $ 73,556  $ 73,556
       States, municipalities and political subdivisions.................    2,999     3,176     3,176
       Foreign governments...............................................    4,998     5,090     5,090
       Public utilities..................................................   14,013    15,063    15,063
       All other corporate bonds.........................................  140,248   148,524   148,524
   Asset-backed securities...............................................    8,265     8,382     8,382
   Residential mortgage-backed securities................................   55,376    57,802    57,802
   Commercial mortgage-backed securities.................................    8,523     8,863     8,863
                                                                          --------  --------  --------
       Total fixed maturities............................................  304,848   320,456   320,456
Short-term investments...................................................   11,593    11,593    11,593
                                                                          --------  --------  --------
       Total investments................................................. $316,441  $332,049  $332,049
                                                                          ========  ========  ========


                                      41



                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                           SCHEDULE IV--REINSURANCE



                                                                                PERCENTAGE
                                                 CEDED TO      ASSUMED          OF AMOUNT
                                     GROSS         OTHER      FROM OTHER  NET    ASSUMED
                                     AMOUNT    COMPANIES/(1)/ COMPANIES  AMOUNT   TO NET
($ IN THOUSANDS)                  ------------ -------------  ---------- ------ ----------
                                                                 
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2010
Life insurance in force.......... $358,242,997 $364,544,022   $6,301,025  $--      -- %
                                  ============ ============   ==========  ===
Premiums and contract charges:
   Life and annuities............ $  1,111,971 $  1,119,436   $    7,465  $--      -- %
   Accident and health insurance.      116,301      116,301           --   --      -- %
                                  ------------ ------------   ----------  ---
                                  $  1,228,272 $  1,235,737   $    7,465  $--      -- %
                                  ============ ============   ==========  ===
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2009
Life insurance in force.......... $349,952,260 $356,581,252   $6,628,992  $--      -- %
                                  ============ ============   ==========  ===
Premiums and contract charges:
   Life and annuities............ $  1,072,840 $  1,080,689   $    7,849  $--      -- %
   Accident and health insurance.      121,686      121,686           --   --      -- %
                                  ------------ ------------   ----------  ---
                                  $  1,194,526 $  1,202,375   $    7,849  $--      -- %
                                  ============ ============   ==========  ===
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 2008
Life insurance in force.......... $337,177,898 $344,250,029   $7,072,131  $--      -- %
                                  ============ ============   ==========  ===
Premiums and contract charges:
   Life and annuities............ $  1,017,339 $  1,025,915   $    8,576  $--      -- %
   Accident and health insurance.      121,408      121,408           --   --      -- %
                                  ------------ ------------   ----------  ---
                                  $  1,138,747 $  1,147,323   $    8,576  $--      -- %
                                  ============ ============   ==========  ===

--------
/(1)/No reinsurance or coinsurance income was netted against premiums ceded in
     2010, 2009 and 2008.

                                      42



            REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Shareholder of
Lincoln Benefit Life Company
Lincoln, NE

We have audited the accompanying Statements of Financial Position of Lincoln
Benefit Life Company (the "Company"), an affiliate of The Allstate Corporation,
as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the related Statements of Operations and
Comprehensive Income, Shareholder's Equity, and Cash Flows for each of the
three years in the period ended December 31, 2010. Our audits also included
Schedule I--Summary of Investments--Other than Investments in Related Parties
and Schedule IV--Reinsurance. These financial statements and financial
statement schedules are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and
financial statement schedules based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company
Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we
plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the
financial statements are free of material misstatement. The Company is not
required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal
control over financial reporting. Our audits included consideration of internal
control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that
are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an
opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial
reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes
examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in
the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a
reasonable basis for our opinion.

In our opinion, such financial statements present fairly, in all material
respects, the financial position of Lincoln Benefit Life Company as of
December 31, 2010 and 2009, and the results of its operations and its cash
flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2010, in
conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States
of America. Also, in our opinion, Schedule I--Summary of Investments--Other
than Investments in Related Parties and Schedule IV--Reinsurance, when
considered in relation to the basic financial statements taken as a whole,
present fairly in all material respects the information set forth therein.

/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

Chicago, Illinois
March 11, 2011

                                      43



ITEM 11(F).SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

                         LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                   5-YEAR SUMMARY OF SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA



                                         2010        2009        2008         2007         2006
($ IN THOUSANDS)                      ----------- ----------- ----------- -----------  -----------
                                                                        
OPERATING RESULTS
Net investment income................ $    12,067 $    11,783 $    13,940 $    14,257  $    13,948
Realized capital gains and losses....         694       1,480       5,952        (417)      (1,255)
Total revenues.......................      12,761      13,263      19,892      13,840       12,693
Net income...........................       8,310       8,629      12,974       9,005        8,260

FINANCIAL POSITION
Investments.......................... $   332,049 $   316,900 $   310,031 $   301,201  $   276,322
Total assets.........................  22,729,575  22,932,908  22,655,371  23,700,007   23,862,919
Reserve for life-contingent contract
  benefits and contractholder
  funds..............................  20,258,388  20,438,414  20,368,562  20,169,001   20,322,077
Shareholder's equity.................     325,867     312,973     298,561     289,938      276,626


ITEM 11(H).MANAGEMENT'S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
           RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

OVERVIEW

   The following discussion highlights significant factors influencing the
financial position and results of operations of Lincoln Benefit Life Company
(referred to in this document as "we", "Lincoln Benefit", "our", "us" or the
"Company"). It should be read in conjunction with the financial statements and
related notes found under Item 11(e) contained herein. We operate as a single
segment entity, based on the manner in which we use financial information to
evaluate business performance and to determine the allocation of resources.

   The most important factors we monitor to evaluate the financial condition
and performance of our company include:

    .  For operations: premiums and contract charges ceded to ALIC, and
       invested assets;

    .  For investments: credit quality/experience, realized capital gains and
       losses, investment income, unrealized capital gains and losses,
       stability of long-term returns, cash flows and asset duration; and

    .  For financial condition: financial strength ratings and capital
       positions.

APPLICATION OF CRITICAL ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES

   The preparation of financial statements in conformity with accounting
principles generally accepted in the United States of America ("GAAP") requires
management to adopt accounting policies and make estimates and assumptions that
affect amounts reported in the financial statements. The most critical
estimates include those used in determining:

    .  Fair value of financial assets

    .  Impairment of fixed income securities

   In making these determinations, management makes subjective and complex
judgments that frequently require estimates about matters that are inherently
uncertain. Many of these policies, estimates and related judgments are common
in the insurance and financial services industries; others are specific to our
businesses and operations. It is reasonably likely that changes in these
estimates could occur from period to period and result in a material impact on
our financial statements.

                                      44



   A brief summary of each of these critical accounting estimates follows. For
a more detailed discussion of the effect of these estimates on our financial
statements, and the judgments and assumptions related to these estimates, see
the referenced sections of this document. For a complete summary of our
significant accounting policies, see Note 2 of the financial statements.

   FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL ASSETS Fair value is defined as the price that would
be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly
transaction between market participants at the measurement date. We categorize
our financial assets measured at fair value into a three-level hierarchy based
on the observability of inputs to the valuation techniques as follows:

LEVEL 1:Financial asset values are based on unadjusted quoted prices for
        identical assets in an active market that we can access.

LEVEL 2:Financial asset values are based on the following:

       (a)Quoted prices for similar assets in active markets;

       (b)Quoted prices for identical or similar assets in markets that are not
          active; or

       (c)Valuation models whose inputs are observable, directly or indirectly,
          for substantially the full term of the asset.

LEVEL 3:Financial asset values are based on prices or valuation techniques that
        require inputs that are both unobservable and significant to the
        overall fair value measurement. Unobservable inputs reflect our
        estimates of the assumptions that market participants would use in
        valuing the financial assets.

   Observable inputs are inputs that reflect the assumptions market
participants would use in valuing financial assets that are developed based on
market data obtained from independent sources. In the absence of sufficient
observable inputs, unobservable inputs reflect our estimates of the assumptions
market participants would use in valuing financial assets and are developed
based on the best information available in the circumstances. The degree of
management judgment involved in determining fair values is inversely related to
the availability of market observable information.

   We are responsible for the determination of fair value of financial assets
and the supporting assumptions and methodologies. We gain assurance on the
overall reasonableness and consistent application of valuation input
assumptions, valuation methodologies and compliance with accounting standards
for fair value determination through the execution of various processes and
controls designed to ensure that our financial assets are appropriately valued.
We monitor fair values received from third parties and those derived internally
on an ongoing basis.

   We employ independent third-party valuation service providers, broker quotes
and internal pricing methods to determine fair values. We obtain or calculate
only one single quote or price for each financial instrument.

   Valuation service providers typically obtain data about market transactions
and other key valuation model inputs from multiple sources and, through the use
of proprietary models, produce valuation information in the form of a single
fair value for individual securities for which a fair value has been requested
under the terms of our agreements. For certain security types, fair values are
derived from the valuation service providers' proprietary valuation models. The
inputs used by the valuation service providers include, but are not limited to,
market prices from recently completed transactions and transactions of
comparable securities, interest rate yield curves, credit spreads, liquidity
spreads, currency rates, and other information, as applicable. Credit and
liquidity spreads are typically implied from completed transactions and
transactions of comparable securities. Valuation service providers also use
proprietary discounted cash flow models that are widely accepted in the
financial services industry and similar to those used by other market
participants to value the same financial instruments. The valuation models take
into account, among other things, market observable information as of the
measurement date, as described above, as well as the specific attributes of the
security being valued including its

                                      45



term, interest rate, credit rating, industry sector, and where applicable,
collateral quality and other issue or issuer specific information. Executing
valuation models effectively requires seasoned professional judgment and
experience. In cases where market transactions or other market observable data
is limited, the extent to which judgment is applied varies inversely with the
availability of market observable information.

   For certain of our financial assets measured at fair value, where our
valuation service providers cannot provide fair value determinations, we obtain
a single non-binding price quote from a broker familiar with the security who,
similar to our valuation service providers, may consider transactions or
activity in similar securities among other information. The brokers providing
price quotes are generally from the brokerage divisions of leading financial
institutions with market making, underwriting and distribution expertise
regarding the security subject to valuation.

   The fair value of certain financial assets, including privately placed
corporate fixed income securities, for which our valuation service providers or
brokers do not provide fair value determinations, is determined using valuation
methods and models widely accepted in the financial services industry.
Internally developed valuation models, which include inputs that may not be
market observable and as such involve some degree of judgment, are considered
appropriate for each class of security to which they are applied.

   Our internal pricing methods are primarily based on models using discounted
cash flow methodologies that develop a single best estimate of fair value. Our
models generally incorporate inputs that we believe are representative of
inputs other market participants would use to determine fair value of the same
instruments, including yield curves, quoted market prices of comparable
securities, published credit spreads, and other applicable market data.
Additional inputs that are used include internally-derived assumptions such as
liquidity premium and credit ratings, as well as instrument-specific
characteristics that include, but are not limited to, coupon rate, expected
cash flows, sector of the issuer, and call provisions. Our internally assigned
credit ratings are developed at a more detailed level than externally published
ratings and allow for a more precise match of these ratings to other market
observable valuation inputs, such as credit and sector spreads, when performing
these valuations. Due to the existence of non-market observable inputs, such as
liquidity premiums, judgment is required in developing these fair values. As a
result, the fair value of these financial assets may differ from the amount
actually received to sell an asset in an orderly transaction between market
participants at the measurement date. Moreover, the use of different valuation
assumptions may have a material effect on the financial assets' fair values.

   For the majority of our financial assets measured at fair value, all
significant inputs are based on market observable data and significant
management judgment does not affect the periodic determination of fair value.
The determination of fair value using discounted cash flow models involves
management judgment when significant model inputs are not based on market
observable data. However, where market observable data is available, it takes
precedence, and as a result, no range of reasonably likely inputs exists from
which the basis of a sensitivity analysis could be constructed.

   We believe our most significant exposure to changes in fair value is due to
market risk. Our exposure to changes in market conditions is discussed fully in
the Market Risk section of the MD&A.

   We employ specific control processes to determine the reasonableness of the
fair values of our financial assets. Our processes are designed to ensure that
the values received or internally estimated are accurately recorded and that
the data inputs and the valuation techniques utilized are appropriate,
consistently applied, and that the assumptions are reasonable and consistent
with the objective of determining fair value. For example, on a continuing
basis, we assess the reasonableness of individual security values received from
valuation service providers and those derived from internal models that exceed
certain thresholds as compared to previous values received from those valuation
service providers or derived from internal models. In addition, we may validate
the reasonableness of fair value by comparing information obtained from our
valuation service providers to other third party valuation sources for selected
securities. We perform ongoing price validation procedures such as

                                      46



back-testing of actual sales, which corroborate the various inputs used in
internal pricing models to market observable data. When fair value
determinations are expected to be more variable, we validate them through
reviews by members of management who have relevant expertise and who are
independent of those charged with executing investment transactions.

   We also perform an analysis to determine whether there has been a
significant decrease in the volume and level of activity for the asset when
compared to normal market activity, and if so, whether transactions may not be
orderly. Among the indicators we consider in determining whether a significant
decrease in the volume and level of market activity for a specific asset has
occurred include the level of new issuances in the primary market, trading
volume in the secondary market, level of credit spreads over historical levels,
bid-ask spread, and price consensuses among market participants and sources. If
evidence indicates that prices are based on transactions that are not orderly,
we place little, if any, weight on the transaction price and will estimate fair
value using an internal pricing model. As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, we did
not alter fair values provided by our valuation service providers or brokers or
substitute them with an internal pricing model.

   The following table identifies fixed income and short-term investments as of
December 31, 2010 by source of value determination:



                                                       FAIR    PERCENT
                                                       VALUE   TO TOTAL
        ($ IN THOUSANDS)                              -------- --------
                                                         
        Fair value based on internal sources......... $ 12,444    3.7%
        Fair value based on external sources/(1)/....  319,605   96.3
                                                      --------  -----
        Total........................................ $332,049  100.0%
                                                      ========  =====

--------
/(1)/Includes $6.9 million that are valued using broker quotes.

   For more detailed information on our accounting policy for the fair value of
financial assets and the financial assets by level in the fair value hierarchy,
see Notes 2 and 5 of the financial statements.

   IMPAIRMENT OF FIXED INCOME SECURITIES For fixed income securities classified
as available for sale, the difference between fair value and amortized cost,
net of deferred income taxes, is reported as a component of accumulated other
comprehensive income on the Statements of Financial Position and is not
reflected in the operating results of any period until reclassified to net
income upon the consummation of a transaction with an unrelated third party or
when a write-down is recorded due to an other-than-temporary decline in fair
value. We have a comprehensive portfolio monitoring process to identify and
evaluate each fixed income security whose carrying value may be
other-than-temporarily impaired.

   For each fixed income security in an unrealized loss position, we assess
whether management with the appropriate authority has made the decision to sell
or whether it is more likely than not we will be required to sell the security
before recovery of the amortized cost basis for reasons such as liquidity,
contractual or regulatory purposes. If a security meets either of these
criteria, the security's decline in fair value is considered other than
temporary and is recorded in earnings.

   If we have not made the decision to sell the fixed income security and it is
not more likely than not we will be required to sell the fixed income security
before recovery of its amortized cost basis, we evaluate whether we expect to
receive cash flows sufficient to recover the entire amortized cost basis of the
security. We use our best estimate of future cash flows expected to be
collected from the fixed income security discounted at the security's original
or current effective rate, as appropriate, to calculate a recovery value and
determine whether a credit loss exists. The determination of cash flow
estimates is inherently subjective and methodologies may vary depending on
facts and circumstances specific to the security. All reasonably available
information relevant to the collectability of the security, including past
events, current conditions, and reasonable and supportable

                                      47



assumptions and forecasts, are considered when developing the estimate of cash
flows expected to be collected. That information generally includes, but is not
limited to, the remaining payment terms of the security, prepayment speeds,
foreign exchange rates, the financial condition and future earnings potential
of the issue or issuer, expected defaults, expected recoveries, the value of
underlying collateral, vintage, geographic concentration, available reserves or
escrows, current subordination levels, third party guarantees and other credit
enhancements. Other information, such as industry analyst reports and
forecasts, sector credit ratings, financial condition of the bond insurer for
insured fixed income securities, and other market data relevant to the
realizability of contractual cash flows, may also be considered. The estimated
fair value of collateral will be used to estimate recovery value if we
determine that the security is dependent on the liquidation of collateral for
ultimate settlement. If the estimated recovery value is less than the amortized
cost of the security, a credit loss exists and an other-than-temporary
impairment for the difference between the estimated recovery value and
amortized cost is recorded in earnings. The portion of the unrealized loss
related to factors other than credit remains classified in accumulated other
comprehensive income. If we determine that the fixed income security does not
have sufficient cash flow or other information to estimate a recovery value for
the security, we may conclude that the entire decline in fair value is deemed
to be credit related and the loss is recorded in earnings.

   Once assumptions and estimates are made, any number of changes in facts and
circumstances could cause us to subsequently determine that a fixed income
security is other-than-temporarily impaired, including: 1) general economic
conditions that are worse than previously forecasted or that have a greater
adverse effect on a particular issuer or industry sector than originally
estimated; 2) changes in the facts and circumstances related to a particular
issue or issuer's ability to meet all of its contractual obligations; and 3)
changes in facts and circumstances that result in changes to management's
intent to sell or result in our assessment that it is more likely than not we
will be required to sell before recovery of the amortized cost basis. Changes
in assumptions, facts and circumstances could result in additional charges to
earnings in future periods to the extent that losses are realized. The charge
to earnings, while potentially significant to net income, would not have a
significant effect on shareholder's equity, since our securities are designated
as available for sale and carried at fair value and as a result, any related
unrealized loss, net of deferred income taxes, would already be reflected as a
component of accumulated other comprehensive income in shareholder's equity.

   The determination of the amount of other-than-temporary impairment is an
inherently subjective process based on periodic evaluation of the factors
described above. Such evaluations and assessments are revised as conditions
change and new information becomes available. We update our evaluations
regularly and reflect changes in other-than-temporary impairments in results of
operations as such evaluations are revised. The use of different methodologies
and assumptions in the determination of the amount of other-than-temporary
impairments may have a material effect on the amounts presented within the
financial statements.

   For additional detail on investment impairments, see Note 4 of the financial
statements.

OPERATIONS

   OVERVIEW AND STRATEGY We are a wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate Life
Insurance Company ("ALIC"), which is a wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate
Insurance Company ("AIC"), a wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate Insurance
Holdings, LLC, which is wholly owned by The Allstate Corporation (the
"Corporation"). We provide life insurance, retirement and investment products.
Our products include interest-sensitive, traditional and variable life
insurance and fixed annuities such as deferred and immediate annuities. Our
products are sold through multiple distribution channels including Allstate
exclusive agencies, which include exclusive financial specialists, and
independent agents (including master brokerage agencies).

                                      48



   NET INCOME Net income for the years ended December 31 is presented in the
following table:



                                              2010     2009     2008
         ($ IN THOUSANDS)                   -------  -------  -------
                                                     
         Net investment income............. $12,067  $11,783  $13,940
         Realized capital gains and losses.     694    1,480    5,952
         Income tax expense................  (4,451)  (4,634)  (6,918)
                                            -------  -------  -------
         Net income........................ $ 8,310  $ 8,629  $12,974
                                            =======  =======  =======


   We have reinsurance agreements whereby all premiums, contract charges,
interest credited to contractholder funds, contract benefits and substantially
all expenses are ceded to ALIC and other non-affiliated reinsurers, and are
reflected net of such reinsurance in the Statements of Operations and
Comprehensive Income. Our results of operations include net investment income
and realized capital gains and losses recognized in connection with the assets
that are not transferred under the reinsurance agreements.

   NET INCOME decreased 3.7% in 2010 compared to 2009 and 33.5% in 2009
compared to 2008. The decrease in 2010 was due to lower net realized capital
gains. The decrease in 2009 was due to lower net realized capital gains and
lower net investment income.

   INCOME TAX EXPENSE decreased 3.9% in 2010 compared to 2009 and 33.0% in 2009
compared to 2008. These changes were due to the proportional change in the
income on which the income tax expense was determined.

   FINANCIAL POSITION The financial position for the years ended December 31 is
presented in the following table:



                                                       2010        2009
     ($ IN THOUSANDS)                               ----------- -----------
                                                          
     Fixed income securities/(1)/.................. $   320,456 $   308,343
     Short-term/(2)/...............................      11,593       8,557
                                                    ----------- -----------
        Total investments.......................... $   332,049 $   316,900
                                                    =========== ===========
     Cash.......................................... $     3,550 $    10,063
     Reinsurance recoverable from ALIC.............  18,365,058  18,689,074
     Reinsurance recoverable from non-affiliates...   1,906,574   1,766,824
     Contractholder funds..........................  17,247,071  17,633,027
     Reserve for life-contingent contract benefits.   3,011,317   2,805,387
     Separate accounts assets and liabilities......   2,017,185   2,039,647

--------
/(1)/Fixed income securities are carried at fair value. Amortized cost basis
     for these securities was $304.8 million and $299.8 million as of
     December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.
/(2)/Short-term investments are carried at fair value. Amortized cost basis for
     these securities was $11.6 million and $8.6 million as of December 31,
     2010 and 2009, respectively.

   Total investments increased to $332.0 million as of December 31, 2010 from
$316.9 million as of December 31, 2009 primarily due to purchases of fixed
income securities and increased net unrealized capital gains on fixed income
securities.

                                      49



   FIXED INCOME SECURITIES by type are listed in the table below.



                                                          PERCENT TO                    PERCENT TO
                                        FAIR VALUE AS OF     TOTAL    FAIR VALUE AS OF     TOTAL
                                        DECEMBER 31, 2010 INVESTMENTS DECEMBER 31, 2009 INVESTMENTS
($ IN THOUSANDS)                        ----------------- ----------- ----------------- -----------
                                                                            
U.S. government and agencies...........     $ 73,556         22.1%        $ 81,551         25.7%
Municipal..............................        3,176          1.0            3,095          1.0
Corporate..............................      163,587         49.3          137,573         43.4
Foreign government.....................        5,090          1.5               --           --
Residential mortgage-backed securities
  ("RMBS").............................       57,802         17.4           67,975         21.4
Commercial mortgage-backed securities
  ("CMBS").............................        8,863          2.7            9,704          3.1
Asset-backed securities ("ABS")........        8,382          2.5            8,445          2.7
                                            --------         ----         --------         ----
Total fixed income securities..........     $320,456         96.5%        $308,343         97.3%
                                            ========         ====         ========         ====


   As of December 31, 2010, all of the fixed income securities portfolio was
rated investment grade, which is defined as a security having a rating of Aaa,
Aa, A or Baa from Moody's, a rating of AAA, AA, A or BBB from Standard & Poor's
("S&P"), Fitch, Dominion, or Realpoint, a rating of aaa, aa, a, or bbb from
A.M. Best, or a comparable internal rating if an externally provided rating is
not available.

   The following table summarizes the fair value and unrealized net capital
gains and losses for fixed income securities by credit rating as of
December 31, 2010.



                                                AAA                  AA                   A
                                        -------------------- ------------------  --------------------
                                         FAIR    UNREALIZED   FAIR   UNREALIZED   FAIR    UNREALIZED
                                         VALUE   GAIN/(LOSS)  VALUE  GAIN/(LOSS)  VALUE   GAIN/(LOSS)
($ IN THOUSANDS)                        -------- ----------- ------- ----------- -------- -----------
                                                                        
U.S. government and agencies........... $ 73,556   $3,130    $    --   $   --    $     --   $   --

Municipal
   Tax exempt..........................       --       --        509        9          --       --
   Taxable.............................       --       --      2,667      168          --       --

Corporate
   Public..............................    3,094       99     32,761    1,740     102,130    6,641
   Privately placed....................    5,079       79     15,824      639          --       --

Foreign government.....................       --       --      5,090       92          --       --

RMBS
   U.S. government sponsored entities
     ("U.S. Agency")...................   48,133    2,292         --       --          --       --
   Prime residential mortgage-backed
     securities ("Prime")..............    2,789        5         --       --       4,180       77
   Alt-A residential mortgage-backed...
   securities ("Alt-A")................       --       --         --       --       2,700       52

CMBS...................................    6,947      427      1,916      (87)         --       --

ABS....................................       --       --      8,382      117          --       --
                                        --------   ------    -------   ------    --------   ------
Total fixed income securities.......... $139,598   $6,032    $67,149   $2,678    $109,010   $6,770
                                        ========   ======    =======   ======    ========   ======


                                      50





                                           BAA                TOTAL
                                    ------------------ --------------------
                                    FAIR   UNREALIZED   FAIR    UNREALIZED
                                    VALUE  GAIN/(LOSS)  VALUE   GAIN/(LOSS)
                                    ------ ----------- -------- -----------
                                                    
     U.S. government and agencies.. $   --    $ --     $ 73,556   $ 3,130

     Municipal
        Tax exempt.................     --      --          509         9
        Taxable....................     --      --        2,667       168

     Corporate
        Public.....................  4,699     128      142,684     8,608
        Privately placed...........     --      --       20,903       718

     Foreign government............     --      --        5,090        92

     RMBS
        U.S. Agency................     --      --       48,133     2,292
        Prime......................     --      --        6,969        82
        Alt-A......................     --      --        2,700        52

     CMBS..........................     --      --        8,863       340

     ABS...........................     --      --        8,382       117
                                    ------    ----     --------   -------
     Total fixed income securities. $4,699    $128     $320,456   $15,608
                                    ======    ====     ========   =======


   RMBS, CMBS AND ABS are structured securities that are primarily
collateralized by residential and commercial real estate loans and other
consumer or corporate borrowings. The cash flows from the underlying collateral
paid to the securitization trust are generally applied in a pre-determined
order and are designed so that each security issued by the trust, typically
referred to as a "class", qualifies for a specific original rating. For
example, the "senior" portion or "top" of the capital structure, or rating
class, which would originally qualify for a rating of Aaa typically has
priority in receiving principal repayments on the underlying collateral and
retains this priority until the class is paid in full. In a sequential
structure, underlying collateral principal repayments are directed to the most
senior rated Aaa class in the structure until paid in full, after which
principal repayments are directed to the next most senior Aaa class in the
structure until it is paid in full. Senior Aaa classes generally share any
losses from the underlying collateral on a pro-rata basis after losses are
absorbed by classes with lower original ratings. The payment priority and class
subordination included in these securities serves as credit enhancement for
holders of the senior or top portions of the structures. These securities
continue to retain the payment priority features that existed at the
origination of the securitization trust. Other forms of credit enhancement may
include structural features embedded in the securitization trust, such as
overcollateralization, excess spread and bond insurance. The underlying
collateral can have fixed interest rates, variable interest rates (such as
adjustable rate mortgages ("ARM")) or may contain features of both fixed and
variable rate mortgages.

   RMBS, including U.S. Agency, Prime and Alt-A, totaled $57.8 million, with
100% rated investment grade, as of December 31, 2010. The RMBS portfolio is
subject to interest rate risk, but unlike other fixed income securities, is
additionally subject to significant prepayment risk from the underlying
residential mortgage loans. The credit risk associated with our RMBS portfolio
is mitigated due to the fact that 83.3% of the portfolio consists of securities
that were issued by or have underlying collateral guaranteed by U.S. government
agencies.

   CMBS totaled $8.9 million, with 100% rated investment grade, as of
December 31, 2010. The CMBS portfolio is subject to credit risk, but unlike
certain other structured securities, is generally not subject to prepayment
risk due to protections within the underlying commercial mortgage loans. All of
the CMBS investments are traditional conduit transactions collateralized by
commercial mortgage loans, broadly diversified across property types and
geographical area.

                                      51



   ABS totaled $8.4 million, with 100% rated investment grade, as of
December 31, 2010. Credit risk is managed by monitoring the performance of the
underlying collateral. Many of the securities in the ABS portfolio have credit
enhancement with features such as overcollateralization, subordinated
structures, reserve funds, guarantees and/or insurance.

   SHORT-TERM INVESTMENTS Our short-term investment portfolio was $11.6 million
and $8.6 million as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

   UNREALIZED NET CAPITAL GAINS totaled $15.6 million as of December 31, 2010
compared to $8.6 million as of December 31, 2009. The improvement since
December 31, 2009 was primarily a result of declining risk-free interest rates
and tightening of credit spreads in certain sectors. The following table
presents unrealized net capital gains and losses, pre-tax and after-tax as of
December 31.



                                                           2010     2009
     ($ IN THOUSANDS)                                    -------  -------
                                                            
     U.S. government and agencies....................... $ 3,130  $ 1,569
     Municipal..........................................     177       96
     Corporate..........................................   9,326    6,107
     Foreign government.................................      92       --
     RMBS...............................................   2,426    1,649
     CMBS...............................................     340     (816)
     ABS................................................     117      (49)
                                                         -------  -------
     Unrealized net capital gains and losses, pre-tax...  15,608    8,556
     Deferred income taxes..............................  (5,463)  (2,995)
                                                         -------  -------
     Unrealized net capital gains and losses, after-tax. $10,145  $ 5,561
                                                         =======  =======


   The unrealized net capital gain for the fixed income portfolio totaled $15.6
million and comprised $16.1 million of gross unrealized gains and $492 thousand
of gross unrealized losses as of December 31, 2010. This is compared to
unrealized net capital gain for the fixed income portfolio totaling $8.6
million, comprised of $9.93 million of gross unrealized gains and $1.37 million
of gross unrealized losses as of December 31, 2009.

                                      52



   Gross unrealized gains and losses as of December 31, 2010 on fixed income
securities by type and sector are provided in the table below.



                                                                            AMORTIZED
                                                  GROSS UNREALIZED          COST AS A    FAIR VALUE
                                 PAR    AMORTIZED ---------------   FAIR    PERCENT OF AS A PERCENT OF
                                VALUE     COST     GAINS   LOSSES   VALUE   PAR VALUE     PAR VALUE
($ IN THOUSANDS)               -------- --------- -------  ------  -------- ---------- ---------------
                                                                  
Corporate:
   Consumer goods (cyclical
     and non-cyclical)........ $ 56,050 $ 56,363  $ 3,573  $ (19)  $ 59,917   100.6%        106.9%
   Financial services.........   19,000   19,000      872     --     19,872   100.0         104.6
   Banking....................   17,000   16,994    1,103     --     18,097   100.0         106.5
   Energy.....................   16,000   16,098      719     --     16,817   100.6         105.1
   Utilities..................   14,000   14,013    1,050     --     15,063   100.1         107.6
   Capital goods..............   11,000   11,110    1,046     --     12,156   101.0         110.5
   Transportation.............    7,350    7,565      374     --      7,939   102.9         108.0
   Basic industry.............    7,000    7,123      372     --      7,495   101.8         107.1
   Technology.................    6,000    5,995      236     --      6,231    99.9         103.9
                               -------- --------  -------  -----   --------
Total corporate fixed income
  portfolio...................  153,400  154,261    9,345    (19)   163,587   100.6         106.6
                               -------- --------  -------  -----   --------
U.S. government and
  agencies....................   67,320   70,426    3,513   (383)    73,556   104.6         109.3
Municipal.....................    3,000    2,999      177     --      3,176   100.0         105.9
Foreign government............    5,000    4,998       92     --      5,090   100.0         101.8
RMBS..........................   55,362   55,376    2,429     (3)    57,802   100.0         104.4
CMBS..........................    8,500    8,523      427    (87)     8,863   100.3         104.3
ABS...........................    8,070    8,265      117     --      8,382   102.4         103.9
                               -------- --------  -------  -----   --------
Total fixed income securities. $300,652 $304,848  $16,100  $(492)  $320,456   101.4         106.6
                               ======== ========  =======  =====   ========


   The consumer goods sector had the only gross unrealized losses in our
corporate fixed income securities portfolio as of December 31, 2010. In
general, credit spreads remain wider than at initial purchase for most of the
securities with gross unrealized losses.

   We have a comprehensive portfolio monitoring process to identify and
evaluate each fixed income security that may be other-than-temporarily
impaired. The process includes a quarterly review of all securities to identify
instances where the fair value of a security compared to its amortized cost is
below established thresholds. The process also includes the monitoring of other
impairment indicators such as ratings, ratings downgrades and payment defaults.
The securities identified, in addition to other securities for which we may
have a concern, are evaluated based on facts and circumstances for inclusion on
our watch-list. All investments in an unrealized loss position as of
December 31, 2010 were included in our portfolio monitoring process for
determining whether declines in value were other than temporary.

   The extent and duration of a decline in fair value for fixed income
securities have become less indicative of actual credit deterioration with
respect to an issue or issuer. While we continue to use declines in fair value
and the length of time a security is in an unrealized loss position as
indicators of potential credit deterioration, our determination of whether a
security's decline in fair value is other than temporary has placed greater
emphasis on our analysis of the underlying credit and collateral and related
estimates of future cash flows.

   As of December 31, 2010, all of the $492 thousand of unrealized losses are
related to fixed income securities with an unrealized loss position less than
20% of amortized cost, the degree of which suggests that these securities do
not pose a high risk of being other-than-temporarily impaired. As of
December 31, 2010, we

                                      53



do not have the intent to sell and it is not more likely than not we will be
required to sell these securities before the recovery of their amortized cost
basis.

   We also monitor the quality of our fixed income portfolio by categorizing
certain investments as "problem," "restructured," or "potential problem."
Problem fixed income securities are in default with respect to principal or
interest and/or are investments issued by companies that have gone into
bankruptcy subsequent to our acquisition. Fixed income securities are
categorized as restructured when the debtor is experiencing financial
difficulty and we grant a concession. Potential problem fixed income securities
are current with respect to contractual principal and/or interest, but because
of other facts and circumstances, we have concerns regarding the borrower's
ability to pay future principal and interest according to the original terms,
which causes us to believe these investments may be classified as problem or
restructured in the future.

   As of December 31, 2010 and 2009, we did not have any fixed income
securities categorized as problem, restructured or potential problem.

   NET INVESTMENT INCOME The following table presents net investment income for
the years ended December 31.



                                              2010     2009     2008
         ($ IN THOUSANDS)                   -------  -------  -------
                                                     
         Fixed income securities........... $12,480  $12,098  $13,302
         Short-term and other investments..      21      107      992
                                            -------  -------  -------
         Investment income, before expense.  12,501   12,205   14,294
         Investment expense................    (434)    (422)    (354)
                                            -------  -------  -------
         Net investment income............. $12,067  $11,783  $13,940
                                            =======  =======  =======


   Net investment income increased 2.4% or $284 thousand in 2010 compared to
2009, after decreasing 15.5% or $2.2 million in 2009 compared to 2008. The 2010
increase was primarily due to higher average investment balances. The 2009
decrease was primarily due to lower yields.

   REALIZED CAPITAL GAINS AND LOSSES The following table presents realized
capital gains and losses and the related tax effect for the years ended
December 31.



                                                    2010   2009     2008
     ($ IN THOUSANDS)                              -----  ------  -------
                                                         
     Realized capital gains and losses, pre-tax... $ 694  $1,480  $ 5,952
     Income tax expense...........................  (243)   (518)  (2,083)
                                                   -----  ------  -------
     Realized capital gains and losses, after-tax. $ 451  $  962  $ 3,869
                                                   =====  ======  =======


   Net realized capital gains in 2010 comprised entirely of gross gains of $694
thousand. Net realized capital gains of $1.5 million in 2009 comprised gross
gains of $1.5 million and gross losses of $8 thousand. The net realized capital
gains in 2010, 2009 and 2008 were related to sales of investments.

   CASH As of December 31, 2010, our cash balance was $3.6 million compared to
$10.1 million as of December 31, 2009. Fluctuations in our cash flows generally
result from differences in the timing of reinsurance payments to and from ALIC
and changes in short-term investments.

   REINSURANCE RECOVERABLE, CONTRACTHOLDER FUNDS AND RESERVE FOR
LIFE-CONTINGENT CONTRACT BENEFITS Under GAAP, when reinsurance contracts do not
relieve the ceding company of legal liability to contractholders, the ceding
company is required to report reinsurance recoverables arising from these
contracts separately as assets. The liabilities for the contracts are reported
as contractholder funds, reserve for life-contingent contract benefits, or
separate accounts liabilities depending on the characteristics of the
contracts. We reinsure all reserve liabilities

                                      54



with ALIC or other non-affiliated reinsurers. Reinsurance recoverables and the
related reserve for life-contingent contract benefits and contractholder funds
are reported separately in the Statements of Financial Position, while the
assets which support the separate accounts liabilities are reflected as
separate accounts assets.

   As of December 31, 2010, contractholder funds decreased to $17.25 billion
from $17.63 billion as of December 31, 2009 as a result of new and additional
deposits on fixed annuities and interest-sensitive life policies and interest
credited to contractholder funds being more than offset by surrenders,
withdrawals, benefit payments and related contract charges. The reserve for
life-contingent contract benefits increased to $3.01 billion as of December 31,
2010 from $2.81 billion as of December 31, 2009 due primarily to the aging of
the in-force block of certain business and sales of traditional life insurance,
partially offset by benefits paid and policy lapses. Reinsurance recoverables
from ALIC decreased by $324.0 million and reinsurance recoverables from
non-affiliates increased $139.8 million.

   We purchase reinsurance after evaluating the financial condition of the
reinsurer, as well as the terms and price of coverage. As of December 31, 2010,
97% of reinsurance recoverables due from non-affiliated companies were
reinsured under uncollateralized reinsurance agreements with companies that had
a financial strength rating of A or above, as measured by S&P. In certain
cases, these ratings refer to the financial strength of the affiliated group or
parent company of the reinsurer. We continuously monitor the creditworthiness
of reinsurers in order to determine our risk of recoverability on an individual
and aggregate basis, and a provision for uncollectible reinsurance is recorded
if needed. No amounts have been deemed unrecoverable in the three years ended
December 31, 2010.

MARKET RISK

   Market risk is the risk that we will incur losses due to adverse changes in
interest rates and credit spreads. We also have certain exposures to changes in
equity prices in our equity-indexed annuities and separate accounts
liabilities, which are transferred to ALIC in accordance with our reinsurance
agreements.

   OVERVIEW In formulating and implementing guidelines for investing funds, we
seek to earn returns that contribute to attractive and stable profits and
long-term capital growth.

   We manage our exposure to market risk through the use of asset allocation,
duration, and as appropriate, through the use of stress tests. We have asset
allocation limits that place restrictions on the total funds that may be
invested within an asset class. We have duration limits on our investment
portfolio and, as appropriate, on individual components of the portfolio. These
duration limits place restrictions on the amount of interest rate risk that may
be taken. Comprehensive day-to-day management of market risk within defined
tolerance ranges occurs as portfolio managers buy and sell within their
respective markets based upon the acceptable boundaries established by
investment policies.

   INTEREST RATE RISK is the risk that we will incur a loss due to adverse
changes in interest rates relative to the interest rate characteristics of our
interest bearing assets. This risk arises from our investment in
interest-sensitive assets. Interest rate risk includes risks related to changes
in U.S. Treasury yields and other key risk-free reference yields.

   One of the measures used to quantify interest rate exposure is duration.
Duration measures the price sensitivity of assets to changes in interest rates.
For example, if interest rates increase 100 basis points, the fair value of an
asset with a duration of 5 is expected to decrease in value by 5%. Our asset
duration was 3.4 and 3.7 as of December 31, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

   To calculate duration, we project asset cash flows and calculate their net
present value using a risk-free market interest rate adjusted for credit
quality, sector attributes, liquidity and other specific risks. Duration is
calculated by revaluing these cash flows at alternative interest rates and
determining the percentage change in

                                      55



aggregate fair value. The projections include assumptions (based upon
historical market experience and our experience) that reflect the effect of
changing interest rates on the prepayment, lapse, leverage and/or option
features of instruments, where applicable. The preceding assumptions relate
primarily to mortgage-backed securities, and municipal and corporate
obligations.

   Based upon the information and assumptions used in the duration calculation,
and interest rates in effect as of December 31, 2010, we estimate that a 100
basis point immediate, parallel increase in interest rates ("rate shock") would
decrease the net fair value of the assets by $11.3 million, which is the same
amount as December 31, 2009. The selection of a 100 basis point immediate
parallel change in interest rates should not be construed as our prediction of
future market events, but only as an illustration of the potential effect of
such an event.

   To the extent that conditions differ from the assumptions we used in these
calculations, duration and rate shock measures could be significantly impacted.
Additionally, our calculations assume that the current relationship between
short-term and long-term interest rates (the term structure of interest rates)
will remain constant over time. As a result, these calculations may not fully
capture the effect of non-parallel changes in the term structure of interest
rates and/or large changes in interest rates.

   CREDIT SPREAD RISK is the risk that we will incur a loss due to adverse
changes in credit spreads ("spreads"). This risk arises from many of our
primary activities, as we invest funds in spread-sensitive fixed income assets.

   We manage the spread risk in our assets. One of the measures used to
quantify this exposure is spread duration. Spread duration measures the price
sensitivity of the assets to changes in spreads. For example, if spreads
increase 100 basis points, the fair value of an asset exhibiting a spread
duration of 5 is expected to decrease in value by 5%.

   Spread duration is calculated similarly to interest rate duration. As of
December 31, 2010, the spread duration of assets was 3.5, compared to 3.6 as of
December 31, 2009. Based upon the information and assumptions we use in this
spread duration calculation, and spreads in effect as of December 31, 2010, we
estimate that a 100 basis point immediate, parallel increase in spreads across
all asset classes, industry sectors and credit ratings ("spread shock") would
decrease the net fair value of the assets by $10.1 million, compared to $8.4
million as of December 31, 2009. The selection of a 100 basis point immediate
parallel change in spreads should not be construed as our prediction of future
market events, but only as an illustration of the potential effect of such an
event.

   EQUITY PRICE RISK is the risk that we will incur losses due to adverse
changes in the general levels of the equity markets. As of December 31, 2010
and 2009, we had separate accounts assets related to variable annuity and
variable life contracts with account values totaling $2.02 billion and $2.04
billion, respectively. Equity risk exists for contract charges based on
separate account balances and guarantees for death and/or income benefits
provided by our variable products. All variable life and annuity contract
charges and fees, liabilities and benefits, including guarantees for death
and/or income are ceded to ALIC in accordance with the reinsurance agreements,
thereby limiting our equity risk exposure. In 2006, ALIC disposed of
substantially all of its variable annuity business through reinsurance
agreements with The Prudential Insurance Company of America, a subsidiary of
Prudential Financial Inc. and therefore mitigated this aspect of ALIC's risk.
The Company was not a direct participant of this agreement and its reinsurance
agreements with ALIC remain unchanged.

   As of December 31, 2010 and 2009 we had $4.38 billion and $4.16 billion,
respectively, in equity-indexed annuity liabilities that provide customers with
interest crediting rates based on the performance of the S&P 500. All contract
charges and fees, and liabilities and benefits related to equity-indexed
annuity liabilities are ceded to ALIC in accordance with the reinsurance
agreements, thereby limiting our equity risk exposure.

                                      56



CAPITAL RESOURCES AND LIQUIDITY

   CAPITAL RESOURCES consist of shareholder's equity. The following table
summarizes our capital resources as of December 31.



                                                    2010     2009     2008
   ($ IN THOUSANDS)                               -------- -------- --------
                                                           
   Common stock, retained income and additional
     capital paid-in............................. $315,722 $307,412 $298,783
   Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss).   10,145    5,561     (222)
                                                  -------- -------- --------
   Total shareholder's equity.................... $325,867 $312,973 $298,561
                                                  ======== ======== ========


   SHAREHOLDER'S EQUITY increased in 2010 due to net income and increased
unrealized net capital gains. Shareholder's equity increased in 2009, due to
net income and a favorable change in unrealized net capital gains and losses.

   FINANCIAL RATINGS AND STRENGTH We share the insurance financial strength
ratings of our parent, ALIC, as our business is reinsured to ALIC. The
following table summarizes ALIC's financial strength ratings as of December 31,
2010.



         RATING AGENCY                                 RATING
         -------------                                 ----------------
                                                    
         A.M. Best Company, Inc....................... A+ ("Superior")
         Standard & Poor's Ratings Services........... A+ ("Strong")
         Moody's Investors Service, Inc............... A1 ("Good")


   ALIC's ratings are influenced by many factors including operating and
financial performance, asset quality, liquidity, asset/liability management,
overall portfolio mix, financial leverage (i.e., debt), exposure to risks, the
current level of operating leverage and AIC's ratings.

   State laws specify regulatory actions if an insurer's risk-based capital
("RBC"), a measure of an insurer's solvency, falls below certain levels. The
NAIC has a standard formula for annually assessing RBC. The formula for
calculating RBC for life insurance companies takes into account factors
relating to insurance, business, asset and interest rate risks. As of
December 31, 2010, our RBC was within the range that we target.

   The NAIC has also developed a set of financial relationships or tests known
as the Insurance Regulatory Information System to assist state regulators in
monitoring the financial condition of insurance companies and identifying
companies that require special attention or actions by insurance regulatory
authorities. The NAIC analyzes financial data provided by insurance companies
using prescribed ratios, each with defined "usual ranges". Generally,
regulators will begin to monitor an insurance company if its ratios fall
outside the usual ranges for four or more of the ratios. If an insurance
company has insufficient capital, regulators may act to reduce the amount of
insurance it can issue. Our ratios are within these ranges.

   LIQUIDITY SOURCES AND USES Our potential sources of funds principally
include the activities as follows.

    .  Receipt of insurance premiums

    .  Contractholder fund deposits

    .  Reinsurance recoveries

    .  Receipts of principal and interest on investments

    .  Sales of investments

    .  Intercompany loans

                                      57



    .  Capital contributions from parent

   Our potential uses of funds principally include the activities as follows.

    .  Payment of contract benefits, surrenders and withdrawals

    .  Reinsurance cessions and payments

    .  Operating costs and expenses

    .  Purchase of investments

    .  Repayment of intercompany loans

    .  Dividends to parent

    .  Tax payments/settlements

   CASH FLOWS As reflected in our Statements of Cash Flows, net cash provided
by (used in) operating activities was $2.1 million, $4.3 million and $(5.9)
million in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively. Fluctuations in net cash provided
by operating activities primarily occur as a result of changes in net
investment income and differences in the timing of reinsurance payments to and
from ALIC.

   Under the terms of reinsurance agreements, all premiums and deposits,
excluding variable annuity and life contract deposits allocated to separate
accounts and those reinsured to non-affiliated reinsurers, are transferred to
ALIC, which maintains the investment portfolios supporting our products.
Payments of contractholder claims, benefits, contract surrenders and
withdrawals and certain operating costs (excluding investment-related
expenses), are reimbursed by ALIC, under the terms of the reinsurance
agreements. We continue to have primary liability as a direct insurer for risks
reinsured. Our ability to meet liquidity demands is dependent on ALIC's and
other reinsurers' ability to meet those obligations under the reinsurance
programs.

   Our ability to pay dividends is dependent on business conditions, income,
cash requirements and other relevant factors. The payment of shareholder
dividends without the prior approval of the state insurance regulator is
limited by Nebraska law to formula amounts based on net income and capital and
surplus, determined in conformity with statutory accounting practices, as well
as the timing and amount of dividends paid in the preceding twelve months. The
maximum amount of dividends that we can pay during 2011 without prior approval
of the Nebraska Department of Insurance is $31.1 million.

   CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS Due to the reinsurance agreements that we have in
place, our contractual obligations are ceded to ALIC and other non-affiliated
reinsurers.

REGULATION AND LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

   We are subject to extensive regulation and we are involved in various legal
and regulatory actions, all of which have an effect on specific aspects of our
business. For a detailed discussion of the legal and regulatory actions in
which we are involved, see Note 9 of the financial statements.

PENDING ACCOUNTING STANDARDS

   There are several pending accounting standards that we have not implemented
either because the standard has not been finalized or the implementation date
has not yet occurred. For a discussion of these pending standards, see Note 2
of the financial statements.

   The effect of implementing certain accounting standards on our financial
results and financial condition is often based in part on market conditions at
the time of implementation of the standard and other factors we are

                                      58



unable to determine prior to implementation. For this reason, we are sometimes
unable to estimate the effect of certain pending accounting standards until the
relevant authoritative body finalizes these standards or until we implement
them.

ITEM 11(J).QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

   Information required for Item 11(j) is incorporated by reference to the
material under the caption "Market Risk" in Item 11(h) of this report.

ITEM 11(K).DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS, PROMOTERS AND CONTROL PERSONS.

IDENTIFICATION OF DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS:

   Directors are elected at each annual meeting of shareholders, for a term of
one year. The biographies of each of the directors below contains information
regarding the person's service as a director, business experience, director
positions held currently or at any time during the last five years, and the
experiences, qualifications, attributes or skills that caused the company
management to determine that a director should serve as such for Lincoln
Benefit. Unless otherwise indicated, each director and executive officer has
served for at least five years in the business position currently or most
recently held.

   ROBERT K. BECKER, 55, has been Senior Vice President since March 2010.
Mr. Becker is also the Chairman of the Board, Chief Executive Officer and
Manager of Allstate Financial Services, LLC ("AFS, LLC") and Vice President of
Allstate Life Insurance Company. Mr. Becker is responsible for Allstate's
broker dealer operations as well as recruiting, training and product strategy
for registered representatives of AFS, LLC and third party relationships. At
Allstate since 2000, Mr. Becker has progressed through various roles, including
Regional Financial Services Manager, Regional Distribution Leader and Assistant
Field Vice President. Prior to joining Allstate, Mr. Becker spent over 20 years
with MetLife Insurance Company, where he held various leadership positions.
Mr. Becker's professional designations include LUTCF, CLU, ChFC, CFP, and CLTC.
Currently, Mr. Becker also serves as a director with Allstate Life Insurance
Company, which is affiliated with Lincoln Benefit. Mr. Becker has proven
leadership experience with using excellent customer service to grow business in
a competitive environment.

   ANURAG CHANDRA, 33, has been a director and Senior Vice President since
March 2011. Mr. Chandra is also a Senior Vice President of Allstate Life
Insurance Company. Mr. Chandra has broad responsibilities for driving long-term
strategy and for improving the operational base for the Allstate Financial
group of companies. More specifically, Mr. Chandra will have direct
accountability for product development, underwriting, wholesaling and asset
liability management. Prior to joining Allstate in January 2011, Mr. Chandra
was an executive vice president and chief operating officer for HealthMarkets,
Inc. Under his leadership, the company transformed from a niche individual
health insurance manufacturer to one of the largest independent distributors in
the United States. Prior to that role, Mr. Chandra was a principal at Aquiline
Capital Partners, a global private equity firm that took advantage of market
conditions to launch successful new insurance and financial services companies.
Mr. Chandra has also held senior operating and strategic development roles at
Nationwide Financial Services and Conseco/Bankers Life and Casualty. Currently,
Mr. Chandra also serves as a director for Allstate Life Insurance Company,
which is affiliated with Lincoln Benefit. Mr. Chandra has extensive experience
with the day-to-day management of company operations.

   LAWRENCE W. DAHL, 51, has been a director since 1999 and President and Chief
Operating Officer since November 2005. In his current role, Mr. Dahl manages
the distribution relationships for Lincoln Benefit. Mr. Dahl began his Allstate
career in 1987 in the Tax Department before becoming the Executive Vice
President of Administration for Lincoln Benefit, where he was responsible for
Marketing, Field Technology, Compliance, Planning and Strategy. Mr. Dahl
progressed through various other leadership positions, including Executive Vice
President of Sales and President of Distribution before becoming the President
and Chief Operating Officer.

                                      59



Mr. Dahl has also earned a JURIS DOCTOR degree and a Certified Public Account
designation. Over the course of his career with Lincoln Benefit, Mr. Dahl has
gained deep knowledge of the life insurance industry as well as extensive
experience with distribution and sales.

   MATTHEW S. EASLEY, 55, has been a director since March 2009 and Senior Vice
President since March 2010. Mr. Easley is also a Vice President for Allstate
Life Insurance Company. Mr. Easley is responsible for Product Management,
Underwriting, and Asset Liability Management within the Allstate Financial
group of companies. Prior to joining Allstate, Mr. Easley spent 23 years at
Nationwide Financial including 11 years as the head of Annuity and Pension
Actuarial, where he started a 401(k) business with a new-to-the-world business
model, created a synthetic asset segmentation method, co-invented a patented
retirement planning software and led a team to create a new strategic plan as
part of the initial public offering of Nationwide Financial Services stock.
Currently, Mr. Easley also serves as a director for Allstate Life Insurance
Company, which is affiliated with Lincoln Benefit. Mr. Easley possesses
extensive insurance business, product and liability management experience.

   SUSAN L. LEES, 53, has been director and Senior Vice President, General
Counsel and Secretary since August 2008. Ms. Lees is also Senior Vice
President, General Counsel and Secretary of Allstate Life Insurance Company. At
Allstate for over 20 years, Ms. Lees progressed through various counsel
positions throughout Allstate before become an assistant vice president in
1999. As the leader of the Corporate Law division of Allstate Law and
Regulation, Ms. Lees gained extensive experience working with a number of the
business areas throughout the enterprise, including Allstate Life Insurance
Company. Currently, Ms. Lees serves as a director for Life Insurance Council of
New York. She also serves as a director for Allstate Life Insurance Company,
which is affiliated with Lincoln Benefit. Ms. Lees has a deep understanding of
insurance business generally, as well as applicable laws and regulations,
including corporate and securities laws and corporate governance matters. In
addition, Ms. Lees has extensive knowledge regarding Lincoln Benefit's
business, including its employees, products, agencies and customers.

   JOHN C. PINTOZZI, 45, has been director, Senior Vice President and Chief
Financial Officer since March 2005. Mr. Pintozzi also is Senior Vice President
and Chief Financial Officer for Allstate Life Insurance Company. In these
positions, Mr. Pintozzi is responsible for the planning and analysis, capital
allocation, valuation and compliance functions as well as Allstate Federal
Savings Bank. Prior to Allstate, Mr. Pintozzi was an audit partner with
Deloitte & Touche, specializing in the insurance and financial services
industries. He is a Certified Public Accountant and holds memberships with the
American Institute of Certified Public Accountants and the Illinois CPA
Society. In addition, Mr. Pintozzi currently serves as a director for Allstate
Life Insurance Company, which is affiliated with Lincoln Benefit. Mr. Pintozzi
has extensive experience in corporate and insurance company finance and
accounting.

   MATTHEW E. WINTER, 54, has been a director since December 2009, Chief
Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board since March 2010. Mr. Winter is
also the President and Chief Executive Officer of Allstate Life Insurance
Company and Senior Vice President of Allstate Insurance Company, each a parent
organization of Lincoln Benefit. Prior to Allstate, Mr. Winter was the Vice
Chairman of American International Group, President and Chief Executive Officer
of American General Life Companies, and Executive Vice President for MassMutual
Financial Group. For a brief period in 2009, Mr. Winter served as a director of
EP Global Communications, a magazine publication and distribution company.
Currently, Mr. Winter also serves as a director for Allstate Insurance Company
and Allstate Life Insurance Company, each of which is affiliated with Lincoln
Benefit. Mr. Winter was also a former Chairman of the Houston Food Bank Board
of Directors. Mr. Winter has extensive experience leading major life insurance
and financial services providers, working with financial and estate planning
products and overseeing the operations of insurance companies.

                                      60



INVOLVEMENT IN CERTAIN LEGAL PROCEEDINGS.

   No directors or executive officers have been involved in any legal
proceedings that are material to an evaluation of the ability or integrity of
any director or executive officer of Lincoln Benefit.

ITEM 11(L).EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

                 COMPENSATION DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS ("CD&A")

OVERVIEW

   Executive officers of Lincoln Benefit also serve as officers of other
subsidiaries of The Allstate Corporation ("Allstate") and receive no
compensation directly from Lincoln Benefit. They are employees of an Allstate
subsidiary. Allocations have been made for each named executive based on the
amount of the named executive's compensation allocated to Lincoln Benefit under
the Amended and Restated Service and Expense Agreement among Allstate Insurance
Company, Allstate and certain affiliates, as amended effective January 1, 2009,
to which Lincoln Benefit is a party (the "Service and Expense Agreement").
Those allocations are reflected in the Summary Compensation Table set forth
below and in this disclosure, except where noted. The named executives may have
received additional compensation for services rendered to other Allstate
subsidiaries, and those amounts are not reported. Lincoln Benefit's directors
receive no compensation for serving as directors in addition to their
compensation as employees of an Allstate affiliate.

   Each year the Compensation and Succession Committee (the "Committee") of the
Allstate Board of Directors and members of Allstate management review the
overall design of Allstate's executive compensation program to ensure
compensation is aligned with both annual and long-term performance. At target
levels of performance, annual and long-term incentive awards are designed to
constitute a significant percentage of an executive's total core compensation
and provide a strong link to Allstate's performance. Additionally, the delivery
of the largest portion of incentive compensation through stock options provides
even greater alignment with stockholder interests because the stock price must
appreciate from the date of grant for any value to be delivered to executives.

   Allstate has made changes to its executive compensation program for 2011.
Allstate has eliminated any excise tax gross-ups in new change-in-control
agreements. Allstate has also made changes to the annual incentive program for
2011 to continue to better align executive compensation with enterprise
performance. The key program change, which will apply to all bonus eligible
employees across the enterprise, will be to reduce the number of measures and
provide for greater use of enterprise-wide corporate goals. Allstate believes
this action will focus employees on those goals which will more effectively
drive sustainable long-term growth for stockholders.

COMPENSATION PHILOSOPHY

   Allstate's compensation philosophy is based on these central beliefs:

    .  Executive compensation should be aligned with performance and
       stockholder value. Accordingly, a significant amount of executive
       compensation should be in the form of equity.

    .  The compensation of our executives should vary both with appreciation in
       the price of Allstate stock and with Allstate's performance in achieving
       strategic short and long-term business goals designed to drive stock
       price appreciation.

    .  Allstate's compensation program should inspire our executives to strive
       for performance that is better than the industry average.

    .  A greater percentage of compensation should be at risk for executives
       who bear higher levels of responsibility for Allstate's performance.

    .  Allstate should provide competitive levels of compensation for
       competitive levels of performance and superior levels of compensation
       for superior levels of performance.

                                      61



   Allstate's executive compensation program has been designed around these
beliefs and includes programs and practices that ensure alignment between the
interests of its stockholders and executives and delivery of compensation
consistent with the corresponding level of performance. These objectives are
balanced with the goal of attracting, motivating, and retaining highly talented
executives to compete in our complex and highly regulated industry.

   Some of Allstate's key practices we believe support this approach include:

    .  Providing a significant portion of executive pay through stock options,
       creating direct alignment with stockholder interests.

    .  Establishment of stock ownership guidelines for senior executives that
       drive further alignment with stockholder interests. Each named executive
       officer, except Mr. Dahl, is required to hold four times salary.

    .  Stock option repricing is not permitted.

    .  A robust governance process for the design, approval, administration,
       and review of our overall compensation program.

    .  Utilization of annual incentive plan caps to limit maximum award
       opportunities and support enterprise risk management strategies.

    .  Inclusion of a clawback feature in the Annual Executive Incentive Plan
       and the 2009 Equity Incentive Plan that provides the ability to recover
       compensation from Allstate executive officers in the event of certain
       financial restatements.

    .  Incorporation of discretion in the annual executive incentive plan to
       allow for the adjustment of awards to reflect individual performance.

   Allstate's philosophy and practices have provided us with the tools to
create an effective executive compensation program as detailed below.

NAMED EXECUTIVES

   This CD&A describes the executive compensation program at Allstate and
specifically describes total 2010 compensation for the following named
executives of Lincoln Benefit*:

    .  Matthew E. Winter--Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer

    .  John C. Pintozzi--Senior Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

    .  Lawrence W. Dahl--President and Chief Operating Officer

    .  Matthew S. Easley--Senior Vice President

    .  Robert K. Becker--Senior Vice President

* Reflects titles in effect as of December 31, 2010.

COMPENSATION PRACTICES

   Allstate reviews the design of its executive compensation program and
executive pay levels on an annual basis and performance and goal attainment
within this design throughout the year. As part of that review, Allstate
considers available data regarding compensation paid to similarly-situated
executives at companies against which it competes for executive talent. With
respect to the compensation program for 2010, the Committee considered
compensation data for the peer companies listed on page 56 for Mr. Winter, as
well as proxy information from select S&P 100 companies with fiscal 2009
revenue of between $15 and $60 billion with which Allstate competes for
executive talent. Towers Watson, an independent compensation consultant,
recommended

                                      62



modifications to the peer insurance companies that Allstate uses in
benchmarking compensation for certain executives for 2010. The Committee
approved removing from the peer insurance companies Cincinnati Financial
Corporation due to its relative size and CNA Financial Corporation because it
is closely held. ACE Ltd, AFLAC Inc., and Manulife Financial Corporation were
added to augment the peer insurance companies with similarly sized insurers.

   With respect to the named executives other than Mr. Winter, Allstate
management considered compensation surveys that provided information on
companies of broadly similar size and business mix as Allstate, as well as
companies with a broader market context. The compensation surveys considered
include the Mercer Property & Casualty Insurance Company Survey, the 2009
Towers Perrin Diversified Insurance Survey, and the Towers Perrin Compensation
Data Bank. The Diversified Insurance Survey includes 18 insurance organizations
with assets ranging from $848 million to $108 billion. The Towers Perrin
Compensation Data Bank provides compensation data on 90 of the Fortune 100
companies. The Mercer Property & Casualty Insurance Company Survey includes
compensation data for 27 property and casualty insurance companies with at
least $2 billion in annual premiums. In addition, in its executive pay and
performance discussions, Allstate management considered information regarding
other companies in the financial services industries.

                           PEER INSURANCE COMPANIES

 ACE Ltd.*                              Manulife Financial Corporation*
 AFLAC Inc.*                            MetLife Inc.
 The Chubb Corporation                  The Progressive Corporation
 The Hartford Financial Services        Prudential Financial, Inc.
 Group, Inc.
 Lincoln National Corporation           The Travelers Companies, Inc.
--------
* Added in 2010

CORE ELEMENTS OF EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION PROGRAM

   Allstate's executive compensation program design balances fixed and variable
compensation elements and provides alignment with both short and long term
business goals through annual and long-term incentives. Allstate's incentives
are designed to balance overall corporate, business unit, and individual
performance with respect to measures Allstate believes correlate to the
creation of stockholder value and align with Allstate's strategic vision and
operating priorities. The following table lists the core elements of Allstate's
executive compensation program.



                                                                           POTENTIAL FOR
                                                                          VARIABILITY WITH
CORE ELEMENT                                      PURPOSE                   PERFORMANCE
------------                       -------------------------------------- ----------------
                                                                    
Annual salary                      Provides a base level of competitive   Low
                                   cash compensation for executive talent

Annual cash incentive awards       Reward performance on key strategic,   High
                                   operational, and financial measures
                                   over the year

Long-term equity incentive awards  Align the interests of executives      Moderate to High
                                   with long-term shareholder value and
                                   retain executive talent


                                      63



SALARY

   Mr. Winter's salary was set by the Allstate Board of Directors based on the
Committee's recommendation. The salaries of the other named executives are set
by Allstate management. In recommending executive base salary levels, Allstate
uses the 50/th/ percentile of its peer insurance companies for Mr. Winter and
the 50/th/ percentile of insurance and general industry data for the other
named executives as a guideline to align with Allstate's pay philosophy for
competitive positioning in the market for executive talent.

    .  The average enterprise-wide merit and promotional increases are based on
       a combination of U.S. general and insurance industry market data and are
       set at levels intended to be competitive.

    .  Annual merit increases for the named executives are based on evaluations
       of their performance using the average enterprise-wide merit increase as
       a guideline.

       .  The base salaries for each named executive were reviewed in February
          of 2010. Allstate established a new base salary for each named
          executive other than Mr. Winter based on individual performance and
          in line with the enterprise-wide merit increase.

       .  Allstate did not adjust the base salary for Mr. Winter, which had
          just been established in the last quarter of 2009 when he joined the
          corporation.

INCENTIVE COMPENSATION

   The Committee approves performance measures and goals for cash incentive
awards during the first quarter of the year. The performance measures and goals
are aligned with Allstate's objectives and tied to its strategic vision and its
operating priorities. They are designed to reward Allstate executives for
actual performance, to reflect objectives that will require significant effort
and skill to achieve, and to drive Allstate stockholder value.

   After the end of the year for annual cash incentive awards and after the end
of the three-year cycle for long-term cash incentive awards, the Committee
reviews the extent to which Allstate has achieved the various performance
measures and approves the actual amount of all cash incentive awards for
Allstate executive officers. The Committee may adjust the amount of an annual
cash incentive award but has no authority to increase the amount of an award
payable to Mr. Winter above the described plan limits. Allstate management
approves the actual amount of cash incentive awards to the other named
executives. Allstate pays the cash incentive awards in March, after the end of
the year for the annual cash incentive awards and after the end of the
three-year cycle for the long-term cash incentive awards. Long-term cash
incentives have been discontinued, and the last three year cycle ended in 2010.

   Typically the Committee also approves grants of equity awards on an annual
basis during a meeting in the first quarter. By making these awards and
approving performance measures and goals for the annual cash incentive awards
during the first quarter, Allstate is able to balance these elements of core
compensation to align with its business goals.

ANNUAL CASH INCENTIVE AWARDS

   In 2010 Allstate executives had the opportunity to earn an annual cash
incentive award based on the achievement of performance measures over a
one-year period. The annual incentive plans are designed to provide all of the
named executives with cash awards based on a combination of corporate and
business unit performance measures for each of Allstate's main business units:
Allstate Protection, Allstate Financial, and Allstate Investments. Lincoln
Benefit is part of Allstate Financial.

   The maximum amount of Mr. Winter's award was the lesser of a stockholder
approved maximum under the Annual Executive Incentive Plan of $8.5 million or
25% of the 1.0% of Operating Income pool. Operating Income is defined under the
"Performance Measures" caption on page 78. Although these limits established the

                                      64



maximum annual cash incentive awards that could be paid to Mr. Winter, the
Committee retained complete discretion to pay any lesser amount. Mr. Winter's
actual award was based on the achievement of certain performance measures as
detailed below, including assessments of his individual performance and overall
corporate and Allstate Financial business unit performance. None of the named
executives other than Mr. Winter participate in the Operating Income pool.

   For 2010, the Committee adopted corporate and Allstate Financial business
unit level annual performance measures and weighted them as applied to
Mr. Winter in accordance with his responsibility for Allstate's overall
corporate performance and the performance of the Allstate Financial business
unit. Allstate management utilized the same performance measures and weighting
with respect to each of the named executives other than Mr. Winter. Each
measure is assigned a weight expressed as a percentage of the total annual cash
incentive award opportunity, with all weights adding to 100%.

   The following table lists the performance measures and related target goals
for 2010 as well as the weighting factors and the actual results applicable to
the named executives. The performance measures were designed to focus executive
attention on key strategic, operational, and financial measures including top
line growth and profitability. For each performance measure, the Committee
approved a threshold, target, and maximum goal. The target goals for the
performance measures were based on evaluations of our historical performance
and plans to drive projected performance. A description of each performance
measure is provided under the "Performance Measures" caption on page 78.

 ANNUAL CASH INCENTIVE AWARD PERFORMANCE MEASURES, TARGET, AND WEIGHTING/(1)/



                                                                                      ACHIEVEMENT
                                                                                      RELATIVE TO
                                                                                       THRESHOLD,
PERFORMANCE                                                                             TARGET,
MEASURE                                        WEIGHTING    TARGET     ACTUAL/(2)/   MAXIMUM GOALS
-----------                                    --------- ------------- ------------- ---------------
                                                                         
CORPORATE-LEVEL PERFORMANCE MEASURE...........    20%
   Adjusted Operating Income Per Diluted                    $4.30         $3.00         Between
     Share....................................                                       threshold and
                                                                                         target
ALLSTATE FINANCIAL PERFORMANCE MEASURES.......    80%
   Adjusted Operating Income..................           $425 million  $474 million     Exceeded
                                                                                        maximum
   Adjusted Operating Return on Equity........               6.6%          7.7%         Exceeded
                                                                                        maximum
   Allstate Exclusive Agency Proprietary and             $256 million  $262 million  Between target
     AWD Weighted Sales.......................                                        and maximum
   Allstate Financial Portfolio Excess Total                  55            63       Between target
     Return (in basis points).................                                        and maximum

--------
/(1)/Information regarding Allstate's performance measures is disclosed in the
     limited context of its annual cash incentive awards and should not be
     understood to be statements of Allstate management's expectations or
     estimates of results or other guidance. Allstate specifically cautions
     investors not to apply these statements to other contexts.
/(2)/Stated as a percentage of target goals with a range from 0% to 250%, the
     actual performance comprises 54% for Adjusted Operating Income Per Diluted
     Share performance, and 189% for Allstate Financial performance. The
     weighted results stated as a percentage of the target goals for all named
     executives was 162%.

                                      65



   Target award opportunities approved by Allstate are stated as a percentage
of annual base salary. Annual cash incentive awards are calculated using base
salary, as adjusted by any merit and promotional increases granted during the
year on a prorated basis. In setting target incentive levels for named
executives, Allstate gives the most consideration to market data primarily
focusing on pay levels at peer group companies with which it directly competes
for executive talent and stockholder investment. As a result of leveraging
external market data, Mr. Winter had the highest target award opportunity of
125%, followed by Mr. Pintozzi with a target award opportunity of 60%, followed
by Messrs. Easley and Becker with a target award opportunity of 50%, followed
by Mr. Dahl with a target award opportunity of 35%.

   In calculating the annual cash incentive awards, Allstate achievement with
respect to each performance measure is expressed as a percentage of the target
goal, with interpolation applied between the threshold and target goals and
between the target and maximum goals. Unless otherwise adjusted by Allstate,
the amount of each named executive's annual cash incentive award is the sum of
the amounts calculated using the calculation below for all of the performance
measures.


                                                                                 
Actual performance interpolated relative to  X   Weighting  X   Target award opportunity as a  X   Salary**
threshold and target on a range of 50% to                          percentage of salary**
100% and relative to target and maximum
on a range of 100% to 250%*

--------
*  Actual performance below threshold results in 0%
** Base salary, as adjusted by any merit and promotional increases granted
   during the year on a prorated basis.

   Following the end of the performance year, the performance of each named
executive was evaluated. Based on a subjective evaluation of each executive's
contributions and performance individual adjustments were made to the formula
driven annual incentive amounts. The recommendations were considered and
approved by the Committee for Mr. Winter and by Allstate management for the
other named executives.

LONG-TERM INCENTIVE AWARDS--CASH AND EQUITY

   As part of total core compensation, Allstate historically has provided three
forms of long-term incentive awards: stock options, restricted stock units, and
long-term cash incentive awards. In 2009, Allstate discontinued future cycles
of the long-term cash incentive plan. The relative mix of various forms of
these awards is driven by Allstate's objectives in providing the specific form
of award, as described below.

LONG-TERM INCENTIVE AWARDS--EQUITY

   Allstate grants larger equity awards to executives with the broadest scope
of responsibility, consistent with Allstate's philosophy that a significant
amount of executive compensation should be in the form of equity and that a
greater percentage of compensation should be at risk for executives who bear
higher levels of responsibility for Allstate's performance. However, from time
to time, larger equity awards are granted to attract new executives. Allstate
annually reviews the mix of equity incentives provided to the named executives.
The mix consisted of 65% stock options and 35% restricted stock units for
Mr. Winter. Other employees eligible for equity incentive awards, including the
named executives other than Mr. Winter, had the choice of receiving the value
of their equity incentive awards in the following proportions between stock
options and restricted stock units:

    .  25% stock options and 75% restricted stock units;

    .  65% stock options and 35% restricted stock units;

    .  50% stock options and 50% restricted stock units; or

    .  75% stock options and 25% restricted stock units

                                      66



   The elections are reflected in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards at Fiscal
Year-End 2010 table. Stock options, which are performance-based, require growth
in the Allstate stock price to deliver any value to an executive. The
restricted stock units provide alignment with Allstate stockholder interests
along with providing an effective retention tool.

STOCK OPTIONS

   Stock options represent the opportunity to buy shares of Allstate's stock at
a fixed exercise price at a future date. Allstate uses them to align the
interests of Allstate's executives with long-term stockholder value, as the
stock price must appreciate from the date of grant for any value to be
delivered to executives.

   Key elements:

    .  Under Allstate's stockholder-approved equity incentive plan, the
       exercise price cannot be less than the fair market value of a share on
       the date of grant.

    .  Stock option repricing is not permitted. In other words, absent an event
       such as a stock split, if the Committee cancels an award and substitutes
       a new award, the exercise price of the new award cannot be less than the
       exercise price of the cancelled award.

    .  All stock option awards have been made in the form of nonqualified stock
       options.

    .  The options granted to the named executives in 2010 become exercisable
       in three installments, 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date
       and 25% on each of the third and fourth anniversary dates, and expire in
       ten years, except in certain change-in-control situations or under other
       special circumstances approved by the Committee.

RESTRICTED STOCK UNITS

   Each restricted stock unit represents Allstate's promise to transfer one
fully vested share of stock in the future if and when the restrictions expire
(when the unit "vests"). Because restricted stock units are based on and
payable in stock, they serve to reinforce the alignment of interests of
Allstate's executives and Allstate's stockholders. In addition, because
restricted stock units have a real, current value that is forfeited, except in
some circumstances, if an executive terminates employment before the restricted
stock units vest, they provide a retention incentive. Under the terms of the
restricted stock unit awards, the executives have only the rights of general
unsecured creditors of Allstate and no rights as stockholders until delivery of
the underlying shares.

   Key elements:

    .  The restricted stock units granted to the named executives in 2010 vest
       in three installments, 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date
       and 25% on each of the third and fourth anniversary dates, except in
       certain change-in-control situations or under other special
       circumstances approved by Allstate.

    .  The restricted stock units granted to the named executives in 2010
       include the right to receive previously accrued dividend equivalents
       when the underlying restricted stock unit vests.

TIMING OF EQUITY AWARDS AND GRANT PRACTICES

   The Committee grants equity incentive awards to current employees on an
annual basis normally during a meeting in the first fiscal quarter, after the
issuance of Allstate's prior fiscal year-end earnings release. Throughout the
year, the Committee grants equity incentive awards in connection with new hires
and promotions and in recognition of achievements. Equity incentive awards to
employees other than Allstate executive officers also may be granted by an
equity award committee which currently consists of Allstate's chief executive
officer. The equity award committee may grant restricted stock units and stock
options in connection with new hires and

                                      67



promotions and in recognition of achievements. The grant date for awards other
than annual awards is fixed as the first business day of a month following the
committee action.

STOCK OWNERSHIP GUIDELINES

   Because Allstate believes management's interests must be linked with those
of Allstate's stockholders, Allstate instituted stock ownership guidelines in
1996 that require each of the named executives, other than Mr. Dahl, to own
common stock, including restricted stock units, worth a multiple of base
salary, as of March 1 following the fifth year after assuming a senior
management position. Unexercised stock options do not count towards meeting the
stock ownership guidelines. For the named executives, the goal is four times
salary. Mr. Winter has until March 2015 to meet his goal. Messrs. Easley and
Pintozzi have met their respective goals. Mr. Becker has until March 2014 to
meet his goal. After a named executive meets the guideline for the position, if
the value of his or her shares does not equal the specified multiple of base
salary solely due to the fact that the value of the shares has declined, the
executive is still deemed to be in compliance with the guideline. However, an
executive in that situation may not sell shares acquired upon the exercise of
an option or conversion of an equity award except to satisfy tax withholding
obligations, until the value of his or her shares again equals the specified
multiple of base salary. In accordance with Allstate's policy on insider
trading, all officers, directors, and employees are prohibited from engaging in
transactions with respect to any securities issued by Allstate or any of its
subsidiaries that might be considered speculative or regarded as hedging, such
as selling short or buying or selling options.

LONG-TERM INCENTIVE AWARDS--CASH

   There were no pay-outs on any long-term cash incentive awards for the
2008-2010 cycle, the final cycle under the Long-Term Executive Incentive
Compensation Plan. Long-term cash incentive awards were originally designed to
reward executives for collective results attained over a three-year performance
cycle. Only Messrs. Pintozzi and Easley were eligible for these awards. There
were three performance measures for the 2008-2010 cycle: average adjusted
return on equity relative to peers, which was weighted at 50% of the potential
award, Allstate Protection growth in policies in force, and Allstate Financial
return on total capital, both weighted at 25% of the potential award. The
Allstate Protection growth in policies in force measure had target set at 5.0%,
with actual performance of -5.9%. The Allstate Financial return on total
capital measure had target set at 9.5%, with actual performance of -12.6%. The
selection and weighting of these measures was intended to focus executive
attention on the collective achievement of Allstate's long-term financial goals
across its various product lines. A description of each performance measure is
provided under the "Performance Measures" caption on page 78.

   The average adjusted return on equity relative to peers measure compared
Allstate's performance to a group of other insurance companies. If the average
adjusted return on equity had exceeded the average risk free rate of return on
three-year Treasury notes over the three-year cycle, plus 200 basis points,
Allstate's ranked position relative to the peer group would have determined the
percentage of the total target award for this performance measure to be paid.
However, the average adjusted return on equity did not exceed the average risk
free rate of return, plus 200 basis points, resulting in no payout.

                                      68



OTHER ELEMENTS OF COMPENSATION

   To remain competitive with other employers and to attract, retain, and
motivate highly talented executives and other employees, we provide the
benefits listed in the following table.



                                                                                           OTHER       ALL FULL-TIME
                                                                                         OFFICERS       AND REGULAR
                                                                           NAMED        AND CERTAIN      PART-TIME
BENEFIT OR PERQUISITE                                                    EXECUTIVES      MANAGERS        EMPLOYEES
---------------------                                                   ------------ ---------------   -------------
                                                                                              
401(k)/(1)/ and defined benefit pension................................ (check mark) (check mark)      (check mark)
Supplemental retirement benefit........................................ (check mark) (check mark)
Health and welfare benefits/(2)/....................................... (check mark) (check mark)      (check mark)
Supplemental long-term disability and executive physical program....... (check mark) (check mark)/(3)/
Deferred compensation.................................................. (check mark) (check mark)
Tax preparation and financial planning services........................ (check mark) (check mark)/(4)/
Mobile phones, ground transportation and personal use of aircraft/(5)/. (check mark) (check mark)

--------
/(1)/Allstate contributed $.50 for every dollar of basic pre-tax deposits made
     in 2010 on the first 3 percent of eligible pay and $.25 for every dollar
     of basic pre-tax deposits made in 2010 on the next 2 percent of eligible
     pay for eligible participants, including the named executives.
/(2)/Including medical, dental, vision, life, accidental death and
     dismemberment, long-term disability, and group legal insurance.
/(3)/An executive physical program is available to all officers.
/(4)/All officers are eligible for tax preparation services. Financial planning
     services were provided to Mr. Winter only.
/(5)/Ground transportation is available to Mr. Winter. In limited circumstances
     approved by Allstate's CEO, Mr. Winter is permitted to use Allstate's
     corporate aircraft for personal purposes. Mr. Winter did not use the
     corporate aircraft for personal purposes in 2010. Mobile phones are
     available to members of Allstate's senior management team, other officers,
     and certain managers, and certain employees depending on their job
     responsibilities.

RETIREMENT BENEFITS

   Each named executive participates in two different defined benefit pension
plans. The Allstate Retirement Plan (ARP) is a tax qualified defined benefit
pension plan available to all of Allstate's regular full-time and regular
part-time employees who meet certain age and service requirements. The ARP
provides an assured retirement income related to an employee's level of
compensation and length of service at no cost to the employee. As the ARP is a
tax qualified plan, federal tax law places limits on (1) the amount of an
individual's compensation that can be used to calculate plan benefits and
(2) the total amount of benefits payable to a participant under the plan on an
annual basis. These limits may result in a lower benefit under the ARP than
would have been payable if the limits did not exist for certain of our
employees. Therefore, the Allstate Insurance Company Supplemental Retirement
Income Plan (SRIP) was created for the purpose of providing ARP-eligible
employees whose compensation or benefit amount exceeds the federal limits with
an additional defined benefit in an amount equal to what would have been
payable under the ARP if the federal limits described above did not exist.

CHANGE-IN-CONTROL AND POST-TERMINATION BENEFITS

   Since a change-in-control or other triggering event may never occur,
Allstate does not view change-in-control benefits or post-termination benefits
as compensation. Consistent with Allstate compensation objectives, Allstate
offers these benefits to attract, motivate, and retain certain highly talented
executives. A change-in-control of Allstate could have a disruptive impact on
both Allstate and its executives. Allstate's change-in-control benefits and
post-termination benefits are designed to mitigate that impact and to maintain
the connection between the interests of Allstate's executives and Allstate
stockholders. Allstate's change-in-control

                                      69



agreements entered into prior to January 1, 2011, provide an excise tax
gross-up to mitigate the possible disparate tax treatment for similarly
situated employees. However, starting in 2011, new change-in-control agreements
will not include an excise tax gross-up provision. Of the named executives,
Messrs. Winter, Pintozzi, and Easley are subject to change-in-control
agreements.

   As part of the change-in-control benefits, executives with change-in-control
agreements receive previously deferred compensation and equity awards that
might otherwise be eliminated by new directors elected in connection with a
change-in-control, and also receive certain protections for cash incentive
awards and benefits if an executive's employment is terminated within a
two-year period after a change-in-control. The change-in-control and
post-termination arrangements which are described in the "Potential Payments as
a Result of Termination or Change-in-Control" section are not provided
exclusively to the named executives. A larger group of management employees is
eligible to receive many of the post-termination benefits described in that
section.

EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION TABLES

                          SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE

   The following table sets forth information concerning the compensation of
the named executives for all services rendered to Lincoln Benefit in 2009 and
2010, allocated to Lincoln Benefit in a manner consistent with the allocation
of compensation expenses under the Service and Expense Agreement.



                                                                                    CHANGE IN
                                                                                  PENSION VALUE
                                                                                       AND
                                                                                  NONQUALIFIED
                                                                     NON-EQUITY     DEFERRED
                                                  STOCK   OPTION   INCENTIVE PLAN COMPENSATION      ALL OTHER
                                  SALARY   BONUS AWARDS   AWARDS    COMPENSATION    EARNINGS       COMPENSATION   TOTAL
NAME/(1)/                    YEAR ($)/(2)/  ($)  ($)/(3)/ ($)/(4)/    ($)/(5)/      ($)/(6)/         ($)/(7)/      ($)
--------                     ---- -------  ----- -------  -------  -------------- -------------    ------------ ---------
                                                                                     
Matthew E. Winter........... 2010 172,200      0 210,943  391,756     347,930          1,100/(8)/     10,082    1,134,011
(CHAIRMAN OF THE BOARD AND
 CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER)                     --

John C. Pintozzi............ 2010 130,757      0  94,860   94,859     157,535          8,735/(9)/      7,528      494,274
(SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT AND
 CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER)    2009 120,224  7,436  55,594  106,439      75,456         10,673           9,053      384,875

Lawrence W. Dahl............ 2010 274,586      0  53,428   17,810     137,159        136,233/(10)/    36,639      655,855
(PRESIDENT--CHIEF OPERATING
 OFFICER)                    2009 253,299      0  25,195   48,246     113,091        235,494          97,306      772,631

Matthew S. Easley........... 2010 121,588      0  87,172   29,058      94,335          6,276/(11)/     9,496      347,925
(SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT)      2009 114,709      0  45,652   87,398      72,160          6,064           8,708      334,691

Robert K. Becker............ 2010  89,294      0  18,609   55,811      81,067         35,616/(12)/     6,763      287,160
(SENIOR VICE PRESIDENT)

--------
/(1)/Messrs. Winter and Becker were not named executives for fiscal year 2009.
/(2)/Reflects amounts for 2009 that were paid in 2009 which, due to the timing
     of Allstate's payroll cycle, included amounts earned in 2008.
/(3)/The aggregate grant date fair value of restricted stock unit awards
     computed in accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board ("FASB")
     Accounting Standards Codification Topic 718 ("ASC 718"). The number of
     restricted stock units granted in 2010 to each named executive is provided
     in the Grants of Plan-Based Awards table on page 66. The fair value of
     restricted stock unit awards is based on the final closing price of
     Allstate's stock as of the date of grant. The final closing price in part
     reflects the payment of future dividends expected.

                                      70



/(4)/The aggregate grant date fair value of option awards computed in
     accordance with FASB ASC 718. The fair value of each option award is
     estimated on the date of grant using a binomial lattice model. The fair
     value of each option award is estimated on the date of grant using the
     assumptions as set forth in the following table:



                                                     2010          2009
                                                 ------------- -------------
                                                         
   Weighted average expected term...............  7.8 years     8.1 years
   Expected volatility.......................... 23.7 - 52.3%  26.3 - 79.2%
   Weighted average volatility..................    35.1%         38.3%
   Expected dividends...........................  2.4 - 2.8%       2.6%
   Weighted average expected dividends..........     2.6%          2.6%
   Risk-free rate...............................  0.1 - 3.9%    0.0 - 3.7%


   The number of options granted in 2010 to each named executive is provided in
   the Grants of Plan-Based Awards table on page 66.

/(5)/Amounts earned under the annual incentive plan are paid in the year
     following performance. Amounts earned under the Long-Term Executive
     Incentive Compensation Plan are paid in the year following the performance
     cycle. The amounts shown in the table above include amounts earned in 2010
     and 2009 and payable under these plans in 2011 and 2010, respectively. The
     break-down for each component is as follows:



                               ANNUAL CASH              LONG-TERM
                                INCENTIVE             CASH INCENTIVE
            NAME          YEAR AWARD AMOUNT   CYCLE    AWARD AMOUNT
            ----          ---- ------------ --------- --------------
                                          
            Mr. Winter... 2010   $347,930   2008-2010    $     0
            Mr. Pintozzi. 2010   $157,535   2008-2010    $     0
                          2009   $ 54,970   2007-2009    $20,486
            Mr. Dahl..... 2010   $137,159   2008-2010    $     0
                          2009   $ 50,748*  2007-2009    $     0
            Mr. Easley... 2010   $ 94,335   2008-2010    $     0
                          2009   $ 52,444   2007-2009    $19,716
            Mr. Becker... 2010   $ 81,067   2008-2010    $     0

   -----
*  In 2009, as President and Chief Operating Officer of Lincoln Benefit,
   Mr. Dahl participated in a cash-based sales incentive plan (the "Sales
   Incentive Plan") based on first year premiums for universal life and term
   policies as well as annuity deposits sold by one of Lincoln Benefit's
   distribution channels. Payments related to the Sales Incentive Plan totaled
   $62,343 for 2009. Mr. Dahl did not participate in the Sales Incentive Plan
   in 2010. No other named executives of Lincoln Benefit participated in the
   Sales Incentive Plan.
/(6)/Amounts reflect the aggregate increase in actuarial value of the pension
     benefits as set forth in the Pension Benefits table, accrued during 2010
     and 2009. These are benefits under the Allstate Retirement Plan (ARP) and
     the Allstate Insurance Company Supplemental Retirement Income Plan (SRIP).
     Non-qualified deferred compensation earnings are not reflected since our
     Deferred Compensation Plan does not provide above-market earnings. The
     pension plan measurement date is December 31. (See note 16 to Allstate's
     audited financial statements for 2010.)
/(7)/The "All Other Compensation for 2010--Supplemental Table" provides details
     regarding the amounts for 2010 for this column.
/(8)/Reflects increases in the actuarial value of the benefits provided to
     Mr. Winter pursuant to the SRIP of $1,100.
/(9)/Reflects increases in the actuarial value of the benefits provided to
     Mr. Pintozzi pursuant to the ARP and SRIP of $4,396 and $4,339,
     respectively.
/(10)/Reflects increases in the actuarial value of the benefits provided to
      Mr. Dahl pursuant to the ARP and SRIP of $82,402 and $53,831,
      respectively.
/(11)/Reflects increases in the actuarial value of the benefits provided to
      Mr. Easley pursuant to the ARP and SRIP of $3,098 and $3,178,
      respectively.
/(12)/Reflects increases in the actuarial value of the benefits provided to
      Mr. Becker pursuant to the ARP and SRIP of $23,305 and $12,311,
      respectively.

                                      71



              ALL OTHER COMPENSATION FOR 2010--SUPPLEMENTAL TABLE

                                 (In dollars)

   The following table describes the incremental cost of other benefits
provided in 2010 that are included in the "All Other Compensation" column.



                                                             TOTAL
                              401(K)     PTO               ALL OTHER
          NAME               MATCH/(1)/ PAYOUT OTHER/(2)/ COMPENSATION
          ----               ---------  ------ ---------  ------------
                                           
          Mr. Winter... 2010   1,400         0   8,682       10,082
          Mr. Pintozzi. 2010   2,009         0   5,519        7,528
          Mr. Dahl..... 2010   4,900    21,539  10,200       36,639
          Ms. Easley... 2010   2,009         0   7,487        9,496
          Mr. Becker... 2010   1,986         0   4,777        6,763

--------
/(1)/Each of the named executives participated in our 401(k) plan during 2010.
     The amount shown is the amount allocated to their accounts as employer
     matching contributions. Mr. Winter will not be vested in the employer
     matching contribution until he has completed three years of vesting
     service.
/(2)/"Other" consists of premiums for group life insurance and personal
     benefits and perquisites consisting of cell phones, tax preparation
     services, financial planning, executive physicals, ground transportation,
     and supplemental long-term disability coverage. There was no incremental
     cost for the use of mobile phones. Allstate provides supplemental
     long-term disability coverage to regular full-time and regular part-time
     employees whose annual earnings exceed the level which produces the
     maximum monthly benefit provided by the Group Long Term Disability
     Insurance Plan. This coverage is self-insured (funded and paid for by
     Allstate when obligations are incurred). No obligations for the named
     executives were incurred in 2010 and so no incremental cost is reflected
     in the table. None of the personal benefits and perquisites individually
     exceeded the greater of $25,000 or 10% of the total amount of these
     benefits for the named executives, except for the payment to Mr. Dahl, in
     accordance with Nebraska law, of $21,539 for paid time off accrued but not
     taken in 2010.

                                      72



           GRANTS OF PLAN-BASED AWARDS AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2010/(1)/

   The following table provides information about non-equity incentive plan
awards and equity awards granted to our named executives during the fiscal year
2010 to the extent the expense for such awards was allocated to Lincoln Benefit
under the Service and Expense Agreement.



                                                                                 ALL OTHER ALL OTHER
                                                                                   STOCK     OPTION
                                                      ESTIMATED FUTURE PAYOUTS    AWARDS:   AWARDS:    EXERCISE
                                                     UNDER NON-EQUITY INCENTIVE  NUMBER OF NUMBER OF    OR BASE
                                                          PLAN AWARDS/(2)/       SHARES OF SECURITIES  PRICE OF
                                                     --------------------------- STOCK OR  UNDERLYING   OPTION
                  GRANT                              THRESHOLD TARGET   MAXIMUM    UNITS    OPTIONS     AWARDS
NAME              DATE             PLAN NAME            ($)     ($)       ($)       (#)       (#)     ($/SHR)/(3)/
----          -------------- ----------------------- --------- ------- --------- --------- ---------- -----------
                                                                              
Mr. Winter... --             Annual cash incentive    107,625  215,250 1,104,233
              Feb. 22, 2010  Restricted stock units                                6,716
              Feb. 22, 2010  Stock options                                                   39,571     $31.41

Mr. Pintozzi. --             Annual cash incentive     39,219   78,439   196,097
              Feb. 22, 2010  Restricted stock units                                3,020
              Feb. 22, 2010  Stock options                                                    9,582     $31.41

Mr. Dahl..... --             Annual cash incentive     48,006   96,012   240,029
              Feb. 22, 2010  Restricted stock units                                1,701
              Feb. 22, 2010  Stock options                                                    1,799     $31.41

Mr. Easley... --             Annual cash incentive     36,475   72,949   182,373
              Feb. 22, 2010  Restricted stock units                                2,775
              Feb. 22, 2010  Stock options                                                    2,935     $31.41

Mr. Becker... --             Annual cash incentive     22,307   44,613   111,533
              Feb. 22, 2010  Restricted stock units                                  592
              Feb. 22, 2010  Stock options                                                    5,638     $31.41






                 GRANT DATE
              FAIR VALUE ($)/(4)/
              -------------------
               STOCK     OPTION
NAME           AWARDS    AWARDS
----          --------  --------
                  
Mr. Winter...
              $210,943
                        $391,756

Mr. Pintozzi.
              $ 94,860
                        $ 94,859

Mr. Dahl.....
              $ 53,428
                        $ 17,810

Mr. Easley...
              $ 87,172
                        $ 29,058

Mr. Becker...
              $ 18,609
                        $ 55,811

--------
/(1)/Awards under the annual executive incentive plans and the 2009 Equity
     Incentive Plan.
/(2)/The amounts in these columns consist of the threshold, target, and maximum
     annual cash incentive awards for the named executives. The threshold
     amount for each named executive is fifty percent of target, as the minimum
     amount payable if threshold performance is achieved. If threshold is not
     achieved the payment to named executives would be zero. The target amount
     is based upon achievement of certain performance measures set forth in the
     "Annual Cash Incentive Awards" section. The maximum amount payable to
     Mr. Winter is the lesser of a stockholder approved maximum under the
     Annual Executive Incentive Plan of $8.5 million or 25% of the award pool.
     The award pool is equal to 1.0% of Operating Income. None of the other
     named executives participate in the operating income pool. A description
     of the Operating Income performance measure is provided under the
     "Performance Measures" caption on page 78.
/(3)/The exercise price of each option is equal to the fair market value of
     Allstate's common stock on the date of grant. Fair market value is equal
     to the closing sale price on the date of grant or, if there was no such
     sale on the date of grant, then on the last previous day on which there
     was a sale.
/(4)/The aggregate grant date fair value of restricted stock units was $31.41
     and for stock option awards was $9.90 for 2010, computed in accordance
     with FASB ASC 718. The assumptions used in the valuation are discussed in
     footnotes 3 and 4 to the Summary Compensation Table on pages 63 and 64.

                                      73



OUTSTANDING EQUITY AWARDS AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2010

               OUTSTANDING EQUITY AWARDS AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2010

   The following table summarizes the outstanding equity awards of the named
executives as of December 31, 2010, allocated in a manner consistent with the
allocation of compensation expenses to Lincoln Benefit under the Service and
Expense Agreement for 2010. The percentage of each equity award actually
allocated to Lincoln Benefit has varied over the years during which these
awards were granted depending on the extent of services rendered by such
executive to Lincoln Benefit and the arrangements in place at the time of such
equity awards between Lincoln Benefit and the executive's Allstate-affiliated
employer. Because the aggregate amount of such equity awards attributable to
services rendered to Lincoln Benefit by each named executive cannot be
calculated without unreasonable effort, the allocated amount of each equity
award provided for each named executive in the following table is the amount
determined by multiplying each named executive's equity award for services
rendered to Allstate and all of its affiliates by the percentage used for
allocating such named executive's compensation to Lincoln Benefit in 2010 under
the Service and Expense Agreement.



                                        OPTION AWARDS/(1)/                                          STOCK AWARDS
              ------------------------------------------------------------------------   ------------------------------------
                                                                                                         NUMBER
                                                                                                           OF
                                                                                                         SHARES
                                                                                                        OR UNITS
                                NUMBER OF         NUMBER OF                                             OF STOCK MARKET VALUE
                               SECURITIES        SECURITIES                                               THAT   OF SHARES OR
                               UNDERLYING        UNDERLYING                                               HAVE     UNITS OF
                 OPTION        UNEXERCISED       UNEXERCISED      OPTION     OPTION                       NOT     STOCK THAT
                  GRANT        OPTIONS (#)       OPTIONS (#)     EXERCISE  EXPIRATION     STOCK AWARD    VESTED    HAVE NOT
NAME              DATE       EXERCISABLE/(2)/ UNEXERCISABLE/(3)/  PRICE       DATE        GRANT DATE    (#)/(4)/ VESTED/(5)/
----          -------------- ---------------  -----------------  -------- -------------- -------------- -------- ------------
                                                                                         
Mr. Winter... Nov. 2, 2009        2,406             7,219         $29.64  Nov. 2, 2019   Nov. 2, 2009    1,694     $ 54,019
              Feb. 22, 2010           0            39,571         $31.41  Feb. 22, 2020  Feb. 22, 2010   6,716     $214,100

                                                                                                                  AGGREGATE
                                                                                                                 MARKET VALUE
                                                                                                                 ------------
                                                                                                                   $268,119
Mr. Pintozzi. Sep. 30, 2002         513                 0         $35.17  Sep. 30, 2012
              Feb. 7, 2003        1,435                 0         $31.78  Feb. 7, 2013
              Feb. 6, 2004        2,041                 0         $45.96  Feb. 6, 2014
              Feb. 22, 2005       5,616                 0         $52.57  Feb. 22, 2015
              Feb. 21, 2006       5,562                 0         $53.84  Feb. 21, 2016
              Feb. 21, 2006       3,690                 0         $53.84  Feb. 21, 2016
              Feb. 20, 2007       4,094             1,365         $62.24  Feb. 20, 2017  Feb. 20, 2007     753     $ 23,998
              Feb. 26, 2008       4,872             4,872         $48.82  Feb. 26, 2018  Feb. 26, 2008   1,057     $ 33,710
              Feb. 27, 2009       2,542            15,312         $16.83  Feb. 27, 2019  Feb. 27, 2009   3,592     $114,526
              Feb. 22, 2010           0             9,582         $31.41  Feb. 22, 2020  Feb. 22, 2010   3,020     $ 96,279

                                                                                                                  AGGREGATE
                                                                                                                 MARKET VALUE
                                                                                                                 ------------
                                                                                                                   $268,513
Mr. Dahl..... May 15, 2001        4,224                 0         $42.00  May 15, 2011
              Feb. 7, 2002        5,868                 0         $33.38  Feb. 7, 2012
              Feb. 7, 2003        3,200                 0         $31.78  Feb. 7, 2013
              Feb. 6, 2004        3,333                 0         $45.96  Feb. 6, 2014
              Feb. 22, 2005       2,492                 0         $52.57  Feb. 22, 2015
              Feb. 21, 2006       3,418                 0         $53.84  Feb. 21, 2016
              Feb. 20, 2007       2,154               719         $62.24  Feb. 20, 2017  Feb. 20, 2007     397     $ 12,656
              Feb. 26, 2008       2,747             2,747         $48.82  Feb. 26, 2018  Feb. 26, 2008     596     $ 19,001
              Feb. 27, 2009       1,127             6,382         $16.83  Feb. 27, 2019  Feb. 27, 2009   1,497     $ 47,724
              Feb. 22, 2010           0             1,799         $31.41  Feb. 22, 2020  Feb. 22, 2010   1,701     $ 54,228

                                                                                                                  AGGREGATE
                                                                                                                 MARKET VALUE
                                                                                                                 ------------
                                                                                                                   $133,609


                                      74





                                      OPTION AWARDS/(1)/                                          STOCK AWARDS
            ------------------------------------------------------------------------   ------------------------------------
                                                                                                       NUMBER
                                                                                                         OF
                                                                                                       SHARES
                                                                                                      OR UNITS
                              NUMBER OF         NUMBER OF                                             OF STOCK MARKET VALUE
                             SECURITIES        SECURITIES                                               THAT   OF SHARES OR
                             UNDERLYING        UNDERLYING                                               HAVE     UNITS OF
               OPTION        UNEXERCISED       UNEXERCISED      OPTION     OPTION                       NOT     STOCK THAT
                GRANT        OPTIONS (#)       OPTIONS (#)     EXERCISE  EXPIRATION     STOCK AWARD    VESTED    HAVE NOT
NAME            DATE       EXERCISABLE/(2)/ UNEXERCISABLE/(3)/  PRICE       DATE        GRANT DATE    (#)/(4)/ VESTED/(5)/
----        -------------- ---------------  -----------------  -------- -------------- -------------- -------- ------------
                                                                                       
Mr. Easley. May 9, 2005         6,150                 0         $57.04  May 9, 2015
            Feb. 21, 2006       5,274                 0         $53.84  Feb. 21, 2016
            Feb. 21, 2006       3,690                 0         $53.84  Feb. 21, 2016
            Feb. 20, 2007       3,940             1,314         $62.24  Feb. 20, 2017  Feb. 20, 2007     724     $ 23,096
            Feb. 26, 2008       4,712             4,712         $48.82  Feb. 26, 2018  Feb. 26, 2008   1,023     $ 32,599
            Feb. 27, 2009       4,191            12,573         $16.83  Feb. 27, 2019  Feb. 27, 2009   2,950     $ 94,044
            Feb. 22, 2010           0             2,935         $31.41  Feb. 22, 2020  Feb. 22, 2010   2,775     $ 88,476

                                                                                                                AGGREGATE
                                                                                                               MARKET VALUE
                                                                                                               ------------
                                                                                                                 $238,215
Mr. Becker. Feb. 6, 2004          595                 0         $45.96  Feb. 6, 2014
            Feb. 22, 2005         465                 0         $52.57  Feb. 22, 2015
            Feb. 21, 2006         561                 0         $53.84  Feb. 21, 2016
            Feb. 20, 2007         410               137         $62.24  Feb. 20, 2017  Feb. 20, 2007      76     $  2,418
            Feb. 26, 2008         501               501         $48.82  Feb. 26, 2018  Feb. 26, 2008     109     $  3,464
            Feb. 27, 2009       1,190             3,569         $16.83  Feb. 27, 2019  Feb. 27, 2009     838     $ 26,704
            Feb. 22, 2010           0             5,638         $31.41  Feb. 22, 2020  Feb. 22, 2010     592     $ 18,887

                                                                                                                AGGREGATE
                                                                                                               MARKET VALUE
                                                                                                               ------------
                                                                                                                 $ 51,473

--------
/(1)/The options granted in 2010 vest in three installments of 50% on the
     second anniversary date and 25% on each of the third and fourth
     anniversaries dates. The other options vest in four installments on the
     first four anniversaries of the grant date. The exercise price of each
     option is equal to the fair market value of Allstate's common stock on the
     date of grant. For options granted prior to 2007, fair market value is
     equal to the average of high and low sale prices on the date of grant, and
     for options granted in 2007 and thereafter, fair market value is equal to
     the closing sale price on the date of grant or in each case, if there was
     no sale on the date of grant, then on the last previous day on which there
     was a sale.
/(2)/The aggregate value and aggregate number of exercisable in-the-money
     options as of December 31, 2010, for each of the named executives is as
     follows: Mr. Winter $5,391 (2,406 aggregate number exercisable),
     Mr. Pintozzi $38,401 (3,977 aggregate number exercisable), Mr. Dahl
     $17,281 (4,327 aggregate number exercisable), Mr. Easley $63,069 (4,191
     aggregate number exercisable), and Mr. Becker $17,907 (1,190 aggregate
     number exercisable)
/(3)/The aggregate value and aggregate number of unexercisable in-the-money
     options as of December 31, 2010, for each of the named executives is as
     follows: Mr. Winter $34,770 (46,791 aggregate number exercisable),
     Mr. Pintozzi $234,947 (24,894 aggregate number unexercisable), Mr. Dahl
     $96,895 (8,181 aggregate number unexercisable), Mr. Easley $190,598
     (15,508 aggregate number unexercisable), and Mr. Becker $56,370 (9,207
     aggregate number unexercisable).
/(4)/The restricted stock unit awards granted in 2010 vest in three
     installments of 50% on the second anniversary of the grant date and 25% on
     each of the third and fourth anniversary dates. The other restricted stock
     unit awards vest in one installment on the fourth anniversary of the grant
     date, unless otherwise noted.
/(5)/Amount is based on the closing price of Allstate common stock of $31.88 on
     December 31, 2010.

OPTION EXERCISES AND STOCK VESTED AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2010

   The following table summarizes the options exercised by the named executives
during 2010 and the restricted stock and restricted stock unit awards that
vested during 2010, allocated in a manner consistent with the allocation of
compensation expenses to Lincoln Benefit under the Service and Expense
Agreement for 2010.

                                      75



           OPTION EXERCISES AND STOCK VESTED AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2010



                        OPTION AWARDS
                       (AS OF 12/31/10)                  STOCK AWARDS
               -------------------------------- -------------------------------
               NUMBER OF SHARES                 NUMBER OF SHARES
                 ACQUIRED ON    VALUE REALIZED    ACQUIRED ON    VALUE REALIZED
 NAME            EXERCISE (#)   ON EXERCISE ($)   VESTING (#)    ON VESTING ($)
 ----          ---------------- --------------- ---------------- --------------
                                                     
 Mr. Winter...          0           $     0          $    0         $     0
 Mr. Pintozzi.      2,562           $36,015           1,087         $33,921
 Mr. Dahl.....      4,851           $33,820             516         $16,110
 Mr. Easley...          0           $     0           1,043         $32,551
 Mr. Becker...          0           $     0              84         $ 2,637


RETIREMENT BENEFITS

   Each named executive participates in two different defined benefit pension
plans. Pension expense for each named executive under these plans has been
accrued annually over the course of the executive's career with Allstate. The
aggregate amount of the annual accrual specifically allocated to Lincoln
Benefit over that period of time has varied depending on the extent of services
rendered by such executive to Lincoln Benefit and the arrangements in place at
the time of accrual between Lincoln Benefit and the executive's
Allstate-affiliated employer. Because the aggregate amount of such annual
accruals earned prior to 2010 attributable to services rendered to Lincoln
Benefit by each named executive cannot be calculated without unreasonable
effort, the present value of accumulated benefit provided for each named
executive in the following table is the amount determined by multiplying the
present value of such named executive's accumulated pension benefit for
services rendered to Allstate and all of its affiliates over the course of such
named executive's career with Allstate by the percentage used for allocating
such named executive's compensation to Lincoln Benefit under the Service and
Expense Agreement in 2010.

                               PENSION BENEFITS



                                                       NUMBER OF       PRESENT
                                                         YEARS        VALUE OF           PAYMENTS
                                                       CREDITED      ACCUMULATED        DURING LAST
NAME                          PLAN NAME               SERVICE (#) BENEFIT/(1)(2)/ ($) FISCAL YEAR ($)
----             ------------------------------------ ----------- -----------------   ---------------
                                                                          
Mr. Winter/(3)/. Allstate Retirement Plan                 1.2                0               0
                 Supplemental Retirement Income Plan      1.2            1,100               0
Mr. Pintozzi.... Allstate Retirement Plan                 8.3           19,939               0
                 Supplemental Retirement Income Plan      8.3           20,553               0
Mr. Dahl........ Allstate Retirement Plan                23.9          522,155               0
                 Supplemental Retirement Income Plan     23.9          437,358               0
Mr. Easley...... Allstate Retirement Plan                 5.7           10,343               0
                 Supplemental Retirement Income Plan      5.7           15,229               0
Mr. Becker...... Allstate Retirement Plan                10.0          116,258               0
                 Supplemental Retirement Income Plan     10.0           90,137               0

--------
/(1)/These amounts are estimates and do not necessarily reflect the actual
    amounts that will be paid to the named executives, which will only be known
    at the time they become eligible for payment. Accrued benefits were
    calculated as of December 31, 2010, and used to calculate the Present Value
    of Accumulated Benefits at December 31, 2010. December 31 is our pension
    plan measurement date used for financial statement reporting purposes.

   The amounts listed in this column are based on the following assumptions:

    .  Discount rate of 6%, payment form assuming 80% paid as a lump sum and
       20% paid as an annuity, lump-sum/annuity conversion segmented interest
       rates of 5.0% for the first five years, 6.5% for the

                                      76



      next 15 years, and 7% for all years after 20 and the 2011 combined static
       Pension Protection Act funding mortality table with a blend of 50% males
       and 50% females (as required under the Internal Revenue Code), and
       post-retirement mortality for annuitants using the 2011 Internal Revenue
       Service mandated annuitant table; these are the same as those used for
       financial reporting year-end disclosure as described in the notes to
       Allstate's consolidated financial statements. (See note 16 to Allstate's
       audited financial statements for 2010.)

    .  Based on guidance provided by the Securities and Exchange Commission, we
       have assumed normal retirement age which is age 65 under both the ARP
       and SRIP, regardless of any announced or anticipated retirements.

    .  No assumption for early termination, disability, or pre-retirement
       mortality.

/(2)/The figures shown in the table above reflect the present value of the
    current accrued pension benefits calculated using the assumptions described
    in the preceding footnote. If the named executives' employment terminated
    on December 31, 2010, the present value of the non-qualified pension
    benefits for each named executive earned through December 31, 2010, is
    shown in the following table:



                                                             LUMP SUM
         NAME                       PLAN NAME               AMOUNT ($)
         ----          ------------------------------------ ----------
                                                      
         Mr. Winter... Supplemental Retirement Income Plan     1,159
         Mr. Pintozzi. Supplemental Retirement Income Plan    22,528
         Mr. Dahl..... Supplemental Retirement Income Plan   660,832
         Mr. Easley... Supplemental Retirement Income Plan    15,895
         Mr. Becker... Supplemental Retirement Income Plan   118,725


   The amount shown is based on the lump sum methodology (i.e., interest rate
   and mortality table) used by the Allstate pension plans in 2011, as required
   under the Pension Protection Act. Specifically, the interest rate for 2011
   is based on 20% of the average August 30-year Treasury Bond rate from the
   prior year and 80% of the average corporate bond segmented yield curve from
   August of the prior year. The mortality table for 2011 is the 2011 combined
   static Pension Protection Act funding mortality table with a blend of 50%
   males and 50% females, as required under the Internal Revenue Code.

/(3)/Mr. Winter is not currently vested in the Allstate Retirement Plan or the
    Supplemental Retirement Income Plan.

   The benefits and value of benefits shown in the Pension Benefits table are
based on the following material factors:

  ALLSTATE RETIREMENT PLAN ("ARP")

   The ARP has two different types of benefit formulas (final average pay and
cash balance) which apply to participants based on their date of hire or
individual choice made prior to the January 1, 2003 introduction of a cash
balance design. Of the named executives, Messrs. Winter, Pintozzi, and Easley
are eligible to earn cash balance benefits. Benefits under the final average
pay formula are earned and stated in the form of a straight life annuity
payable at the normal retirement date (age 65). Participants who earn final
average pay benefits may do so under one or more benefit formulas based on when
they become members of the ARP and their years of service.

   Mr. Dahl and Mr. Becker earn ARP benefits under the post-1988 final average
pay formula which is the sum of the Base Benefit and the Additional Benefit, as
defined as follows:

    .  Base Benefit =1.55% of the participant's average annual compensation,
       multiplied by credited service after 1988 (limited to 28 years of
       credited service)

                                      77



    .  Additional Benefit =0.65% of the amount, if any, of the participant's
       average annual compensation that exceeds the participant's covered
       compensation (the average of the maximum annual salary taxable for
       Social Security over the 35-year period ending the year the participant
       would reach Social Security retirement age) multiplied by credited
       service after 1988 (limited to 28 years of credited service)

   Since Mr. Dahl earned benefits between January 1, 1978, and December 31,
1988, one component of his ARP benefit will be based on the following benefit
formula:

1. Multiply years of credited service from 1978 through 1988 by 2 1/8%.

2. Then, multiply the percentage from step (1) by

       a. Average annual compensation (five-year average) at December 31, 1988,
          and by

       b. Estimated Social Security at December 31, 1988.

3. Then, subtract 2(b) from 2(a). The result is the normal retirement allowance
   for service from January 1, 1978, through December 31, 1988.

4. The normal retirement allowance is indexed for final average pay. In
   addition, there is an adjustment of 18% of the normal retirement allowance
   as of December 31, 1988, to reflect a conversion to a single life annuity.

   For participants eligible to earn cash balance benefits, pay credits are
added to the cash balance account on a quarterly basis as a percent of
compensation and based on the participant's years of vesting service as follows:

                         CASH BALANCE PLAN PAY CREDITS



                                                    PAY CREDIT
                  VESTING SERVICE                       %
                  ---------------                   ----------
                                                 
                  Less than 1 year.................      0%
                  1 year, but less than 5 years....    2.5%
                  5 years, but less than 10 years..      3%
                  10 years, but less than 15 years.      4%
                  15 years, but less than 20 years.      5%
                  20 years, but less than 25 years.      6%
                  25 years or more.................      7%


  SUPPLEMENTAL RETIREMENT INCOME PLAN ("SRIP")

   SRIP benefits are generally determined using a two-step process:
(1) determine the amount that would be payable under the ARP formula specified
above if the federal limits described above did not apply, then (2) reduce the
amount described in (1) by the amount actually payable under the ARP formula.
The normal retirement date under the SRIP is age 65. If eligible for early
retirement under the ARP, an eligible employee is also eligible for early
retirement under the SRIP.

  OTHER ASPECTS OF THE PENSION PLANS

   For the ARP and SRIP, eligible compensation consists of salary, annual cash
incentive awards, pre-tax employee deposits made to Allstate's 401(k) plan and
Allstate's cafeteria plan, holiday pay, and vacation pay. Eligible compensation
also includes overtime pay, payment for temporary military service, and
payments for short term disability, but does not include long-term cash
incentive awards or income related to the exercise of stock options and the
vesting of restricted stock and restricted stock units. Compensation used to
determine benefits under the ARP is limited in accordance with the Internal
Revenue Code. For final average pay benefits, average annual compensation is
the average compensation of the five highest consecutive calendar years within
the last ten consecutive calendar years preceding the actual retirement or
termination date.

                                      78



   Payment options under the ARP include a lump sum, straight life annuity, and
various survivor annuity options. The lump sum under the final average pay
benefit is calculated in accordance with the applicable interest rate and
mortality as required under the Internal Revenue Code. The lump sum payment
under the cash balance benefit is generally equal to a participant's cash
balance account balance. Payments from the SRIP are paid in the form of a lump
sum using the same interest rate and mortality assumptions used under the ARP.

  TIMING OF PAYMENTS

   The earliest retirement age that a named executive may retire with unreduced
retirement benefits under the ARP and SRIP is age 65. However, a participant
earning final average pay benefits is entitled to an early retirement benefit
on or after age 55 if he or she terminates employment after the completion of
20 or more years of service. A participant earning cash balance benefits who
terminates employment with at least three years of vesting service is entitled
to a lump sum benefit equal to his or her cash balance account balance.
Currently, none of the named executives are eligible for an early retirement
benefit.

   SRIP benefits earned through December 31, 2004 (Pre 409A SRIP Benefits) are
generally payable at age 65, the normal retirement date under the ARP. Pre 409A
SRIP Benefits may be payable earlier upon reaching age 50 if disabled,
following early retirement at age 55 or older with 20 years of service, or
following death in accordance with the terms of the SRIP. SRIP benefits earned
after December 31, 2004 (Post 409A SRIP Benefits) are paid on the January 1
following termination of employment after reaching age 55 (a minimum six month
deferral period applies), or following death in accordance with the terms of
the SRIP.

   Eligible employees are vested in the normal retirement benefit under the ARP
and the SRIP on the earlier of the completion of five years of service or upon
reaching age 65 for participants with final average pay benefits or the
completion of three years of service or upon reaching age 65 for participants
whose benefits are calculated under the cash balance formula.

    .  Mr. Winter's SRIP benefit is not currently vested but would become
       payable following death. Mr. Winter will turn 65 on January 22, 2022.

    .  Mr. Pintozzi's Pre 409A SRIP benefit would become payable as early as
       January 1, 2011, but is immediately payable upon death. Mr. Pintozzi's
       Post 409A Benefit would be paid on January 1, 2021, or immediately upon
       death. Mr. Pintozzi will turn 65 on May 18, 2030.

    .  Mr. Dahl's Pre 409A SRIP Benefit would become payable as early as
       January 1, 2015, but is immediately payable upon death or disability.
       Mr. Dahl's Post 409A Benefit would be paid on January 1, 2015, or
       immediately upon death. Mr. Dahl will turn 65 on August 2, 2024.

    .  Mr. Easley's Post 409A Benefit would become payable as early as
       January 1, 2011, but is immediately payable upon death. Mr. Easley's
       Post 409A Benefit would be paid on January 1, 2012, or immediately upon
       death. Mr. Easley will turn 65 on March 28, 2021.

    .  Mr. Becker's Pre 409A SRIP Benefit would become payable as early as
       January 1, 2021, but is immediately payable upon death or disability.
       Mr. Becker's Post 409A Benefit would be paid on January 1, 2011, or
       immediately upon death. Mr. Becker will turn 65 on July 9, 2020.

  EXTRA SERVICE AND PENSION BENEFIT ENHANCEMENT

   No additional service is granted under the ARP or the SRIP. Generally,
Allstate has not granted additional service credit outside of the actual
service used to calculate ARP and SRIP benefits.

NON-QUALIFIED DEFERRED COMPENSATION

   The aggregate amount of the annual accrual specifically allocated to Lincoln
Benefit over each named executive's career with Allstate has varied depending
on the extent of services rendered by such executive to

                                      79



Lincoln Benefit and the arrangements in place at the time of accrual between
Lincoln Benefit and the executive's Allstate-affiliated employer. Because the
aggregate earnings and balance attributable to services rendered to Lincoln
Benefit by each named executive cannot be calculated without unreasonable
effort, the aggregate earnings and aggregate balance provided for each named
executive in the following table is the amount determined by multiplying the
value of such named executive's non-qualified deferred compensation benefit for
services rendered to Allstate and all of its affiliates over the course of such
named executive's career with Allstate by the percentage used for allocating
such named executive's compensation to Lincoln Benefit under the Service and
Expense Agreement in 2010.

          NON-QUALIFIED DEFERRED COMPENSATION AT FISCAL YEAR-END 2010



                 EXECUTIVE    REGISTRANT   AGGREGATE    AGGREGATE    AGGREGATE
               CONTRIBUTIONS CONTRIBUTIONS  EARNINGS  WITHDRAWALS/    BALANCE
                IN LAST FY    IN LAST FY   IN LAST FY DISTRIBUTIONS AT LAST FYE
 NAME               ($)           ($)       ($)/(1)/       ($)       ($)/(2)/
 ----          ------------- ------------- ---------- ------------- -----------
                                                     
 Mr. Winter...       0             0           0            0            0
 Mr. Pintozzi.       0             0           0            0            0
 Mr. Dahl.....       0             0           0            0            0
 Ms. Easley...       0             0           0            0            0
 Mr. Becker...       0             0           0            0            0

--------
/(1)/Aggregate earnings were not included in the named executive's prior year
     compensation.
/(2)/There are no amounts reported in the Aggregate Balance at Last FYE column
     that were reported in the 2010 or 2009 Summary Compensation Tables.

   In order to remain competitive with other employers, Allstate allows
employees, including the named executives, whose annual compensation exceeds
the amount specified in the Internal Revenue Code (e.g., $245,000 in 2010), to
defer up to 80% of their salary and/or up to 100% of their annual cash
incentive award that exceeds that amount under the Deferred Compensation Plan.
Allstate does not match participant deferrals and does not guarantee a stated
rate of return.

   Deferrals under the Deferred Compensation Plan are credited with earnings,
or are subject to losses, based on the results of the investment option or
options selected by the participants. The investment options available in 2010
under the Deferred Compensation Plan are Stable Value, S&P 500, International
Equity, Russell 2000, and Bond Funds--options available in 2010 under our
401(k) plan. Under the Deferred Compensation Plan, deferrals are not actually
invested in these funds, but instead are credited with earnings or losses based
on the funds' investment experience, which are net of administration and
investment expenses. Because the rate of return is based on actual investment
measures in our 401(k) plan, no above-market earnings are paid. Similar to
participants in our 401(k) plan, participants can change their investment
elections daily. Investment changes are effective the next business day. The
Deferred Compensation Plan is unfunded; participants have only the rights of
general unsecured creditors.

   Deferrals under the Deferred Compensation Plan are segregated into Pre 409A
balances and Post 409A balances. A named executive may elect to begin receiving
a distribution of a Pre 409A balance upon separation from service or in one of
the first through fifth years after separation from service. In either event,
the named executive may elect to receive payment of a Pre 409A balance in a
lump sum or in annual cash installment payments over a period of two to ten
years. An irrevocable distribution election is required before making any Post
409A deferrals into the plan. The distribution options available to the Post
409A balances are similar to those available to the Pre 409A balances, except
the earliest distribution date is six months following separation from service.
Upon a showing of unforeseeable emergency, a plan participant may be allowed to
access certain funds in a deferred compensation account earlier than the dates
specified above.

                                      80



POTENTIAL PAYMENTS AS A RESULT OF TERMINATION OR CHANGE-IN-CONTROL

   The following table lists the compensation and benefits that Allstate would
pay or provide to the named executives in various scenarios involving a
termination of employment, other than compensation and benefits generally
available to all salaried employees.

                             COMPENSATION ELEMENTS



                                                                                                          NON-
                                                                                                        QUALIFIED
                            BASE         SEVERANCE         ANNUAL                        RESTRICTED      PENSION
TERMINATION SCENARIOS      SALARY           PAY           INCENTIVE     STOCK OPTIONS   STOCK UNITS   BENEFITS/(1)/
---------------------    ------------ ----------------- -------------- ---------------- ------------- --------------
                                                                                    
VOLUNTARY TERMINATION... Ceases       None              Forfeited      Unvested are     Forfeited     Distributions
                         immediately                    unless         forfeited,                     commence
                                                        terminated     vested expire                  per plan
                                                        on last day    at the earlier
                                                        of fiscal      of three
                                                        year           months or
                                                                       normal
                                                                       expiration

INVOLUNTARY              Ceases       None              Forfeited      Unvested are     Forfeited     Distributions
 TERMINATION/(3)/....... immediately                    unless         forfeited,                     commence
                                                        terminated     vested expire                  per plan
                                                        on last day    at the earlier
                                                        of fiscal      of three
                                                        year           months or
                                                                       normal
                                                                       expiration

RETIREMENT/(4)/......... Ceases       None              Pro rated for  Continue to      RSUs          Distributions
                         Immediately                    the year       vest upon        continue to   commence
                                                        based on       normal or        vest upon     per plan
                                                        actual         health           normal
                                                        performance    retirement;      retirement.
                                                        for the year   unvested         Forfeited in
                                                                       forfeited upon   early
                                                                       early            retirement.
                                                                       retirement. All
                                                                       expire at
                                                                       earlier of five
                                                                       years or
                                                                       normal
                                                                       expiration

TERMINATION DUE TO       Ceases       Lump sum          Pro rated at   Vest             Vest          Immediately
 CHANGE IN CONTROL/(5)/. Immediately  equal to a        target         immediately      immediately   payable
                                      multiple of       (reduced by    upon a change    upon a        upon a
                                      salary, a         any actually   in control       change in     change in
                                      multiple of       paid)                           control       control
                                      annual
                                      incentive at
                                      target and
                                      pension
                                      enhancement/(6)/

DEATH................... One month    None              Pro rated for  Vest             Vest          Distributions
                         salary paid                    year based     immediately      immediately   commence
                         upon death                     on actual      and expire at                  per plan
                                                        performance    earlier of two
                                                        for the year   years or
                                                                       normal
                                                                       expiration



                                               HEALTH,
                                              WELFARE AND
                             DEFERRED           OTHER
TERMINATION SCENARIOS    COMPENSATION/(2)/     BENEFITS
---------------------    ------------------ ----------------
                                      
VOLUNTARY TERMINATION... Distributions      None
                         commence per
                         participant
                         election





INVOLUNTARY              Distributions      None
 TERMINATION/(3)/....... commence per
                         participant
                         election





RETIREMENT/(4)/......... Distributions      None
                         commence per
                         participant
                         election











TERMINATION DUE TO       Immediately        Outplacement
 CHANGE IN CONTROL/(5)/. payable upon a     services
                         change in control  provided;
                          continuation
                          coverage
                           subsidized/(7)/





DEATH................... Payable within     None
                         90 days







                                      81





                                                                                              NON-
                                                                                            QUALIFIED
                          BASE      SEVERANCE     ANNUAL                      RESTRICTED     PENSION         DEFERRED
TERMINATION SCENARIOS    SALARY       PAY        INCENTIVE    STOCK OPTIONS   STOCK UNITS  BENEFITS/(1)/  COMPENSATION/(2)/
---------------------  ------------ ---------  -------------- --------------- -----------  ------------   ----------------
                                                                                     
     DISABILITY....... Ceases         None     Pro rated for  Vest            Forfeited    Participant     Distributions
                       Immediately             year based     immediately                  may             commence per
                                               on actual      and expire at                request         participant
                                               performance    earlier of two               payment if      election
                                               for the year   years or                     age 50 or
                                                              normal                       older
                                                              expiration



                         HEALTH,
                       WELFARE AND
                          OTHER
TERMINATION SCENARIOS    BENEFITS
---------------------  -------------
                    
     DISABILITY....... Supplemental
                       Long Term
                       Disability
                       benefits




--------
/(1)/See the section titled Pension Benefits for further detail on
     non-qualified pension benefits and timing of payments.
/(2)/See the Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation section for additional
     information on the Deferred Compensation Plan and distribution options
     available.
/(3)/Examples of "Involuntary Termination" independent of a change-in-control
     include performance-related terminations; terminations for employee
     dishonesty and violation of Allstate rules, regulations, or policies; and
     terminations resulting from lack of work, rearrangement of work, and
     reduction in force.
/(4)/Retirement for purposes of the annual cash incentive plans is defined as
     voluntary termination on or after the date the named executive attains age
     55 with at least 20 years of service. The "normal retirement date" under
     the equity awards is the date on or after the date the named executive
     attains age 60 with at least one year of service. The "health retirement
     date" is the date on which the named executive terminates for health
     reasons after attaining age 50, but before attaining age 60, with at least
     ten years of continuous service. The "early retirement date" is the date
     the named executive attains age 55 with 20 years of service.
/(5)/Of the named executives, only Messrs. Winter, Pintozzi, and Easley are
     subject to change-in-control agreements. In general, a change-in-control
     is one or more of the following events: (1) any person acquires 30% or
     more of the combined voting power of Allstate common stock within a
     12-month period; (2) any person acquires more than 50% of the combined
     voting power of Allstate common stock; (3) certain changes are made to the
     composition of the Board; or (4) the consummation of a merger,
     reorganization, or similar transaction. These triggers were selected
     because, in a widely held company the size of Allstate, they could each
     result in a substantial change in management. Effective upon a
     change-in-control, the named executives become subject to covenants
     prohibiting competition and solicitation of employees, customers, and
     suppliers at any time until one year after termination of employment.
     During the two-year period following a change-in-control, the
     change-in-control agreements provide for a minimum salary, annual cash
     incentive awards, and other benefits. In addition, they provide that the
     named executives' positions, authority, duties, and responsibilities will
     be at least commensurate in all material respects with those held prior to
     the change-in-control. If a named executive incurs legal fees or other
     expenses in an effort to enforce the change-in-control agreement, Allstate
     will reimburse the named executive for these expenses unless it is
     established by a court that the named executive had no reasonable basis
     for the claim or acted in bad faith.
/(6)/For those named executives subject to change-in-control agreements,
     severance benefits would be payable if the named executive's employment is
     terminated either by Allstate without "cause" or by the executive for
     "good reason" as defined in the agreements during the two-year period
     following the change-in-control. Cause means the named executive has been
     convicted of a felony or other crime involving fraud or dishonesty, has
     willfully or intentionally breached the change-in-control agreement, has
     habitually neglected his or her duties, or has engaged in willful or
     reckless material misconduct in the performance of his or her duties. Good
     reason includes a material diminution in a named executive's base
     compensation, authority, duties, or responsibilities, a material change in
     the geographic location where the named executive performs services, or a
     material breach of the change-in-control agreement by Allstate. Mr.
     Winter's cash severance payment would be three times salary and three
     times annual incentive at target. Messrs. Pintozzi's and Easley's cash
     severance payments would be two times their respective salary and two
     times their respective annual incentive at target.

   For the named executives subject to change-in-control agreements, the
   pension enhancement is a lump sum payment equal to the positive difference,
   if any, between: (a) the sum of the lump-sum values of each maximum annuity
   that would be payable to the named executive under any defined benefit plan
   (whether or not qualified under Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code)
   if the named executive had: (i) become fully vested in all such benefits,
   (ii) attained as of the named executive's termination date an age that is
   two years (three years for Mr. Winter) greater than the named executive's
   actual age, (iii) accrued a number of years of service that is two years
   (three years for Mr. Winter) greater than the number of years of service
   actually accrued by the named executive as of the named executive's
   termination date, and (iv) received a lump-sum severance benefit consisting
   of two times base salary (three for Mr. Winter), two (three for Mr. Winter)
   times annual incentive cash compensation calculated at target, plus the 2010
   annual incentive cash award as covered compensation in equal monthly
   installments during the two-year period following the named executive's
   termination date (a three-year period applies to Mr. Winter); and (b) the
   lump-sum values of the maximum annuity benefits vested and payable to named
   executive under each defined benefit plan that is qualified under
   Section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code plus the aggregate amounts
   simultaneously or previously paid to the named executive under the defined
   benefit plans (whether or not qualified under Section 401(a)). The
   calculation of the lump sum amounts payable under this formula does not
   impact the benefits payable under the ARP or the SRIP.

/(7)/For the named executives subject to change-in-control agreements, if the
     named executive's employment is terminated by reason of death during the
     two-year period commencing on the date of a change-in-control, the named
     executive's estate or beneficiary will be entitled to survivor and other
     benefits, including retiree medical coverage, if eligible, that are not
     less favorable than the most favorable benefits available to the estates
     or surviving families of peer executives at Allstate. In the event of
     termination by reason of disability, Allstate will pay disability and
     other benefits, including supplemental long-term disability benefits and
     retiree medical coverage, if eligible, that are not less favorable than
     the most favorable benefits available to disabled peer executives. In
     addition, such survivor or disability benefits shall not be materially
     less favorable, in the aggregate, than the most favorable benefits in
     effect during the 90-day period preceding the change-in-control.

                                      82



             ESTIMATE OF POTENTIAL PAYMENTS UPON TERMINATION/(1)/

   The table below describes the amount of compensation payable to each named
executive or the value of benefits provided to the named executives, calculated
in a manner consistent with the allocation of compensation expenses to Lincoln
Benefit under the Service and Expense Agreement for 2010, that exceed the
compensation or benefits generally available to all salaried employees in each
termination scenario. The "Total" column in the following table does not
reflect compensation or benefits previously accrued or earned by the named
executives such as deferred compensation and non-qualified pension benefits.
The payment of the 2010 annual cash incentive award and any 2010 salary earned
but not paid in 2010 due to Allstate's payroll cycle are not included in these
tables because these amounts are payable to the named executives regardless of
termination, death, or disability. Benefits and payments are calculated
assuming a December 31, 2010, employment termination date.



                                                                    RESTRICTED
                                                        STOCK          STOCK
                                                      OPTIONS--       UNITS--        WELFARE       EXCISE TAX
                                                      UNVESTED       UNVESTED      BENEFITS AND   REIMBURSEMENT
                                                         AND            AND        OUTPLACEMENT      AND TAX
                                           SEVERANCE ACCELERATED    ACCELERATED      SERVICES     GROSS-UP/(2)/   TOTAL
NAME                                          ($)        ($)            ($)            ($)             ($)         ($)
----                                       --------- -----------    -----------    ------------   ------------- ---------
                                                                                              
MR. WINTER
Voluntary Termination/Retirement/(3)/.....         0         0              0              0               0            0
Involuntary Termination...................                   0              0              0               0            0
Termination due to Change-in-Control/(4)/. 1,202,254    34,770        268,119         10,263/(5)/    448,200    1,963,606
Death.....................................              34,770        268,119              0               0      302,889
Disability................................              34,770              0        637,274/(6)/          0      672,044
MR. PINTOZZI
Voluntary Termination/Retirement/(3)/.....         0         0              0              0               0            0
Involuntary Termination...................                   0              0              0               0            0
Termination due to Change-in-Control/(4)/.   442,285   234,947        268,513         13,593/(5)/          0      959,338
Death.....................................         0   234,947        268,513              0               0      503,460
Disability................................         0   234,947              0        707,459/(6)/          0      942,406
MR. DAHL
Voluntary Termination/Retirement/(3)/.....         0         0              0              0               0            0
Involuntary Termination...................                   0              0              0               0            0
Termination due to Change-in-Control/(4)/.         0    96,895/(7)/   133,609/(7)/         0               0      230,504
Death.....................................              96,895        133,609              0               0      230,504
Disability................................              96,895              0        703,387/(6)/          0      800,282
MR. EASLEY
Voluntary Termination/Retirement/(3)/.....         0         0              0              0               0            0
Involuntary Termination...................                   0              0              0               0            0
Termination due to Change-in-Control/(4)/.   381,650   190,598        238,215         12,614/(5)/          0      823,077
Death.....................................             190,598        238,215              0               0      428,813
Disability................................             190,598              0        397,373/(6)/          0      587,971
MR. BECKER
Voluntary Termination/Retirement/(3)/.....         0         0              0              0               0            0
Involuntary Termination...................                   0              0              0               0            0
Termination due to Change-in-Control/(4)/.         0    56,370/(7)/    51,473/(7)/         0               0      107,843
Death.....................................         0    56,370         51,473              0               0      107,843
Disability................................         0    56,370              0        186,591/(6)/          0      242,961

--------
/(1)/A "0" indicates that either there is no amount payable to the named
     executive or no amount payable to the named executive that is not also
     made available to all salaried employees.
/(2)/Certain payments made as a result of a change in control are subject to a
    20% excise tax imposed on the named executive by Section 4999 of the Code.
    The Excise Tax Reimbursement and Tax Gross-up is the amount Allstate would
    pay to the named executive as reimbursement for the 20% excise tax plus a
    tax gross-up for any taxes incurred by the named executive resulting from
    the reimbursement of such excise tax. The estimated amounts of
    reimbursement of any resulting excise taxes were determined without regard
    to the effect that restrictive covenants and any other facts and
    circumstances may have on the amount of excise taxes, if any, that
    ultimately might be payable in the event these payments were made to a
    named executive which is not subject to reliable advance prediction or a
    reasonable estimate. Allstate believes providing an excise tax gross-up
    mitigates the possible disparate tax treatment for similarly situated
    employees and is appropriate in this limited circumstance to prevent the
    intended value of a benefit from being significantly and arbitrarily
    reduced. However, starting in 2011, new change-in-control agreements will
    not include an excise tax gross-up provision.

                                      83



/(3)/As of December 31, 2010 none of the named executives was eligible to
     retire in accordance with Allstate's policy or the terms of any of the
     Allstate compensation and benefit plans including the equity incentive
     plans.
/(4)/The values in this change-in-control row represent amounts paid if both
     the change-in-control and termination occur on December 31, 2010. If there
     was a change-in-control that did not result in a termination, the amounts
     payable to each named executive would be as follows:



                    STOCK OPTIONS--                            TOTAL--
                     UNVESTED AND   RESTRICTED STOCK UNITS-- UNVESTED AND
                      ACCELERATED   UNVESTED AND ACCELERATED ACCELERATED
      NAME                ($)                 ($)                ($)
      ----          --------------- ------------------------ ------------
                                                    
      Mr. Winter...      34,770             268,119            302,889
      Mr. Pintozzi.     234,947             268,513            503,460
      Mr. Dahl.....      96,895             133,609            230,504
      Mr. Easley...     190,598             238,215            428,813
      Mr. Becker...      56,370              51,473            107,843


   A change-in-control also would accelerate the distribution of non-qualified
   deferred compensation and SRIP benefits for Messrs. Winter, Pintozzi, and
   Easley. Within five business days after the effective date of a
   change-in-control, each named executive subject to a change-in-control
   agreement would receive any deferred compensation account balances and a
   lump sum payment equal to the present value of the named executive's SRIP
   benefit. Please see the Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation at Fiscal Year
   End 2010 table and footnote 2 to the Pension Benefits table in the
   Retirement Benefits section for details regarding the applicable amounts for
   each named executive.

/(5)/The Welfare Benefits and Outplacement Services amount includes the cost to
     provide certain welfare benefits to the named executive and family during
     the period which the named executive is eligible for continuation coverage
     under applicable law. The amount shown reflects Allstate's costs for these
     benefits or programs assuming an 18-month continuation period. The value
     of outplacement services for Mr. Winter is $20,000 and $15,000 for Messrs.
     Pintozzi and Easley.
/(6)/The named executives are eligible to participate in Allstate's
     supplemental long-term disability plan for employees whose annual earnings
     exceed the level which produces the maximum monthly benefit provided by
     the Allstate Long Term Disability Plan (Basic Plan). The benefit is equal
     to 50% of the named executive's qualified annual earnings divided by
     twelve and rounded to the nearest one hundred dollars, reduced by $7,500,
     which is the maximum monthly benefit payment that can be received under
     the Basic Plan. The amount reflected assumes the named executive remains
     totally disabled until age 65 and represents the full present value of the
     monthly benefit payable until age 65.
/(7)/Messrs. Dahl and Becker did not have change-in control agreements in
     place. However, pursuant to the terms of their equity awards unvested
     stock options and restricted stock units would have become immediately
     payable upon a change-in control.

RISK MANAGEMENT AND COMPENSATION

   Allstate management has reviewed its compensation policies and practices and
believes that they are appropriately structured, that they are consistent with
its key operating priority of keeping Allstate financially strong, and that
they avoid providing incentives for employees to engage in unnecessary and
excessive risk taking. Allstate believes that executive compensation has to be
examined in the larger context of an effective risk management framework and
strong internal controls. The Allstate Board and its Audit Committee both play
an important role in risk management oversight, including reviewing how
management measures, evaluates, and manages the corporation's exposure to risks
posed by a wide variety of events and conditions. In addition, the Compensation
and Succession Committee of Allstate employs an independent executive
compensation consultant each year to assess Allstate's executive pay levels,
practices, and overall program design.

   A review and assessment of potential compensation-related risks was
conducted by Allstate management and reviewed by the Chief Risk Officer.
Performance related incentive plans were analyzed using a process developed in
conjunction with our independent executive compensation consultant.

   The 2010 risk assessment specifically noted that our compensation programs:

    .  provide a balanced mix of cash and equity through annual and long-term
       incentives to align with short-term and long-term business goals.

    .  utilize a full range of performance measures that Allstate believes
       correlate to long-term Allstate shareholder value creation.

                                      84



    .  incorporate strong governance practices, including paying cash incentive
       awards only after a review of executive and corporate performance.

    .  enable the use of negative discretion to adjust annual incentive
       compensation payments when formulaic payouts are not warranted due to
       other circumstances.

   Furthermore, to ensure Allstate's compensation programs do not motivate
imprudent risk taking, awards to Allstate executive officers, including
Mr. Winter, made after May 19, 2009, under the 2009 Equity Incentive Plan and
awards made under the Annual Executive Incentive Plan are subject to clawback
in the event of certain financial restatements.

PERFORMANCE MEASURES

   Information regarding our performance measures is disclosed in the limited
context of Allstate's annual and long-term cash incentive awards and should not
be understood to be statements of management's expectations or estimates of
results or other guidance. We specifically caution investors not to apply these
statements to other contexts.

   The following are descriptions of the performance measures used for
Allstate's annual cash incentive awards for 2010 and its long-term cash
incentive awards for the 2008-2010 cycle which may be applied to compensation
of Lincoln Benefit's named executives. These measures are not GAAP measures.
They were developed uniquely for incentive compensation purposes and are not
reported items in our financial statements. Some of these measures use non-GAAP
measures and operating measures. The Committee has approved the use of non-GAAP
and operating measures when appropriate to drive executive focus on particular
strategic, operational, or financial factors or to exclude factors over which
our executives have little influence or control, such as capital market
conditions.

ANNUAL CASH INCENTIVE AWARDS FOR 2010

   OPERATING INCOME: This measure is used to assess financial performance. This
measure is equal to net income adjusted to exclude the after tax effects of the
items listed below:

    .  Realized capital gains and losses (which includes the related effect on
       the amortization of deferred acquisition and deferred sales inducement
       costs) except for periodic settlements and accruals on certain non-hedge
       derivative instruments.

    .  Gains and losses on disposed operations.

    .  Adjustments for other significant non-recurring, infrequent, or unusual
       items, when (a) the nature of the charge or gain is such that it is
       reasonably unlikely to recur within two years or (b) there has been no
       similar charge or gain within the prior two years.

CORPORATE MEASURE

   ADJUSTED OPERATING INCOME PER DILUTED SHARE: This measure is used to assess
financial performance. The measure is equal to net income adjusted to exclude
the after-tax effects of the items listed below, divided by the weighted
average shares outstanding on a diluted basis:

    .  Realized capital gains and losses (which includes the related effect on
       the amortization of deferred acquisition and deferred sales inducement
       costs) except for periodic settlements and accruals on certain non-hedge
       derivative instruments.

    .  Gains and losses on disposed operations.

    .  Adjustments for other significant non-recurring, infrequent, or unusual
       items, when (a) the nature of the charge or gain is such that it is
       reasonably unlikely to recur within two years or (b) there has been no
       similar charge or gain within the prior two years.

                                      85



    .  Restructuring and related charges.

    .  Effects of acquiring businesses.

    .  Negative operating results of sold businesses.

    .  Underwriting results of the Discontinued Lines and Coverages segment.

    .  Any settlement, awards, or claims paid as a result of lawsuits and other
       proceedings brought against Allstate subsidiaries regarding the scope
       and nature of coverage provided under insurance policies issued by such
       companies.

ALLSTATE FINANCIAL MEASURES

   ADJUSTED OPERATING INCOME: This is a measure Allstate management uses to
assess the profitability of the business. The Allstate Financial segment
measure, operating income, is adjusted to exclude the after tax effects of
restructuring and related charges and the potential amount by which 2010
guaranty fund assessments related to insured solvencies exceed $6 million. For
disclosure of the Allstate Financial segment measure see footnote 18 to
Allstate's audited financial statements.

   ADJUSTED OPERATING RETURN ON EQUITY: This is a measure Allstate management
uses to assess profitability and capital efficiency. This measure is calculated
using adjusted operating income, as defined above, as the numerator, and
Allstate Financial's adjusted average subsidiary shareholder's equity as the
denominator. Adjusted subsidiary shareholder's equity is the sum of
subsidiaries' shareholder's equity for Allstate Life Insurance Company,
Allstate Bank, a proportionate share of American Heritage Life Investment
Corporation and certain other minor entities and excludes the effect of
unrealized net capital gains and losses, net of tax and deferred acquisition
costs. The average adjusted shareholder's equity is calculated by dividing the
sum of Allstate Financial's adjusted shareholder's equity at year-end 2009 and
at the end of each quarter of 2010 by five.

   ALLSTATE EXCLUSIVE AGENCY PROPRIETARY AND AWD WEIGHTED SALES: This operating
measure is used to quantify the current year sales of financial products
through Allstate's Exclusive Agency proprietary distribution channel, including
agencies and direct, and the Allstate Workplace Division. The measure is
calculated by applying a percentage or factor against the premium or deposits
of life insurance, annuities and Allstate Workplace Division products that vary
based on the relative expected profitability of the specific product. For
non-Allstate Workplace Division proprietary products sold through Allstate
Financial Services channel, the percentage or factors are consistent with those
used for production credits by Allstate Protection.

ALLSTATE FINANCIAL PORTFOLIO RELATIVE TOTAL RETURN:

   PORTFOLIO RELATIVE TOTAL RETURN: Management uses the three following
measures to assess the value of active portfolio management relative to the
total return of a market based benchmark. The measure is calculated as the
difference, in basis points, of the specific portfolio total return over a
designated benchmark. Total return is principally determined using industry
standards and the same sources used in preparing the financial statements to
determine fair value. (See footnotes to our audited financial statements for
our methodologies for estimating the fair value of our investments.) In
general, total return represents the annualized increase or decrease, expressed
as a percentage, in the value of the portfolio. Time weighted returns are
utilized. The designated benchmark is a composite of pre-determined, customized
indices which reflect the investment risk parameters established in investment
policies by the boards of the relevant subsidiaries, weighted in proportion to
our investment plan, in accordance with our investment policy. The specific
measures and investments included are listed below:

    .  PROPERTY LIABILITY PORTFOLIO RELATIVE TOTAL RETURN: Total return for
       Property-liability investments and Kennett investments.

    .  ALLSTATE FINANCIAL PORTFOLIO RELATIVE TOTAL RETURN: Total return for
       Allstate Financial investments.

                                      86



    .  ALLSTATE PENSION PLANS PORTFOLIO RELATIVE TOTAL RETURN: Total return for
       the Allstate Retirement Plan and Agents Pension Plan investments.

LONG-TERM CASH INCENTIVE AWARDS

   AVERAGE ADJUSTED RETURN ON EQUITY RELATIVE TO PEERS: This measure is used to
assess Allstate's financial performance against its peers. It is calculated as
Allstate's ranked position relative to the insurance company peer group based
upon three-year average adjusted return on equity, calculated on the same basis
for Allstate and each of the peer insurance companies. Three-year average
adjusted return on equity is the sum of the annual adjusted return on equity
for each of the three years in the cycle divided by three. The annual adjusted
return on equity is calculated as the ratio of net income divided by the
average of shareholders' equity at the beginning and at the end of the year
after excluding the component of accumulated other comprehensive income for
unrealized net capital gains and losses.

   ALLSTATE FINANCIAL RETURN ON TOTAL CAPITAL: This is a measure management
uses to measure the efficiency of capital utilized in the business. Three-year
Allstate Financial return on total capital is the sum of the annual adjusted
return on subsidiaries' shareholder's equity for each of the three years
divided by three. The annual adjusted return on subsidiaries' shareholder's
equity is the Allstate Financial measure, net income, divided by the average
subsidiaries' shareholder's equity at the beginning and at the end of the year.
The subsidiaries' shareholder's equity is the sum of the subsidiaries'
shareholder's equity for Allstate Life Insurance Company, Allstate Bank,
American Heritage Life Investment Corporation, and certain other minor
entities, adjusted to exclude the loan protection business and excluding the
component of accumulated other comprehensive income for unrealized net capital
gains. (See note 18 to Allstate's audited financial statements for Allstate
Financial net income.)

   ALLSTATE PROTECTION GROWTH IN POLICIES IN FORCE OVER THREE-YEAR CYCLE: This
is a measure used by management to assess growth in the number of policies in
force, which is a driver of premiums written. The measure is calculated as the
sum of the percent increase in each of the three years in the total number of
policies in force at the end of the year over the beginning of the year. The
measure excludes property insurance, Allstate Motor Club, and the loan
protection business and includes Allstate Canada.

ITEM 11(M).SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT.

SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS.

   The following table shows the number of Lincoln Benefit shares owned by any
beneficial owner who owns more than five percent of any class of Lincoln
Benefit's voting securities.



                      NAME AND ADDRESS OF             AMOUNT AND NATURE OF       PERCENT OF
TITLE OF CLASS         BENEFICIAL OWNER               BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP         CLASS
    (A)                      (B)                              (C)                   (D)
--------------  -------------------------------- ------------------------------- ----------
                                                                        
Capital Stock   Allstate Life Insurance Company             100,000                100%
                3100 Sanders Road,
                Northbrook, IL 60062

N/A             Allstate Insurance Company       Indirect voting and investment    N/A
                2775 Sanders Road,                  power of shares owned by
                Northbrook, IL 60062                Allstate Life Insurance
                                                            Company

N/A             The Allstate Corporation         Indirect voting and investment    N/A
                2775 Sanders Road,                  power of shares owned by
                Northbrook, IL 60062                Allstate Life Insurance
                                                            Company


                                      87



SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF DIRECTORS AND EXECUTIVE OFFICERS

   The following table shows the number of shares of Allstate common stock
beneficially owned by each director and named executive officer of Lincoln
Benefit individually, and by all executive officers and directors of Lincoln
Benefit as a group. Shares reported as beneficially owned include shares held
indirectly through the Allstate 401(k) Savings Plan and other shares held
indirectly, as well as shares subject to stock options exercisable on or prior
to May 9, 2011 and restricted stock units for which restrictions expire on or
prior to May 9, 2011. The percentage of Allstate shares of common stock
beneficially owned by any Lincoln Benefit director, named executive officer or
by all directors and executive officers of Lincoln Benefit as a group does not
exceed 1%. The following share amounts are as of March 10, 2011. As of
March 10, 2010, none of these shares were pledged as security.

                                                     COMMON STOCK SUBJECT TO
                                                     OPTIONS EXERCISABLE AND
                                                      RESTRICTED STOCK UNITS
                                                      FOR WHICH RESTRICTIONS
                                                        EXPIRE ON OR PRIOR
                             AMOUNT AND NATURE OF        TO MAY 9, 2011 -
                           BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP OF         INCLUDED IN
                            ALLSTATE COMMON STOCK           COLUMN (A)
 NAME OF BENEFICIAL OWNER            (A)                       (B)
 ------------------------  ------------------------  ------------------------
 Anurag Chandra...........            0                         0
 Robert K. Becker.........          17,535                    12,162
 Lawrence W. Dahl.........          34,755                    33,178
 Matthew S. Easley........          95,825                    89,126
 Susan L. Lees............          39,344                    27,732
 John C. Pintozzi.........         102,679                    97,514
 Matthew E. Winter........           8539                      8385
 ALL DIRECTORS AND
   EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AS
   A GROUP................         281,142                   255,935

                                      88



ITEM 11(N)TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PERSONS, PROMOTERS AND CERTAIN CONTROL
          PERSONS.

TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PERSONS.

   This table describes certain intercompany agreements involving Lincoln
Benefit and the following companies:

    .  Allstate Life Insurance Company ("ALIC"), the direct parent of Lincoln
       Benefit;

    .  Allstate Insurance Company ("AIC"), an indirect parent of Lincoln
       Benefit; and

    .  The Allstate Corporation ("AllCorp"), the ultimate indirect parent of
       Lincoln Benefit.



                                         APPROXIMATE DOLLAR VALUE
                                         OF THE AMOUNT INVOLVED IN   RELATED PERSON(S) INVOLVED IN THE TRANSACTION/1/ AND
                                         THE TRANSACTION, PER FISCAL THE APPROXIMATE DOLLAR VALUE OF THE AMOUNT OF THE
TRANSACTION DESCRIPTION                           YEAR               RELATED PERSON'S INTEREST IN THE TRANSACTION ($)
-----------------------                  -----------------------     ---------------------------------------------------
                                                       ($)                ALIC                AIC            ALLCORP
                                                                                           
Investment Management Agreement          2008      131,668,584         68,941,225/2/      51,404,171           677,981
among Allstate Investments, LLC,
Allstate Insurance Company, The          2009      142,073,012         76,392,634/2/      54,248,353         1,151,990
Allstate Corporation and certain
affiliates effective January 1, 2007.    2010      130,793,008         73,282,918/2/      47,445,127           687,957

Tax Sharing Agreement among The          2008      465,439,826/3/    (109,322,083)       633,316,282      (121,960,368)
Allstate Corporation and certain
affiliates dated as of November 12,      2009   (1,173,212,154)/3/   (534,572,879)      (467,570,173)     (121,813,486)
1996, as supplemented by Supplemental
Intercompany Tax Sharing Agreement       2010     (113,770,599)/3/   (621,234,096)       647,559,256      (146,676,325)
between Allstate Life Insurance
Company and Lincoln Benefit Life
Company effective December 21, 2000.

Cash Management Services Master          2008        1,338,376/4/         198,098/5/         816,143/5/            N/A
Agreement between Allstate Insurance
Company, Allstate Bank (aka Allstate     2009        1,527,072/4/         158,312/5/       1,052,781/5/
Federal Savings Bank), and certain
affiliates dated March 16, 1999, as      2010          967,620/4/          76,166/5/         694,117/5/
amended by Amendment No.1 effective
January 5, 2001, and Amendment No. 2
entered into November 8, 2002, between
Allstate Insurance Company, Allstate
Bank and Allstate Motor Club, Inc., and
as supplemented by the Premium
Depository Service Supplement dated as
of September 30, 2005, the Variable
Annuity Service Supplement dated
November 10, 2005, and the Sweep
Agreement Service Supplement dated as
of October 11, 2006.

--------
/1/  Each identified Related Person is a Party to the transaction.
/2/  Gross amount of expense received under the transaction.
/3/  Total amounts paid to Internal Revenue Service.
/4/  Each identified Related Person is a Party to the transaction.
/5/  Total fees collected for all bank accounts covered under the transaction.

                                      89





                                              APPROXIMATE DOLLAR VALUE
                                              OF THE AMOUNT INVOLVED IN   RELATED PERSON(S) INVOLVED IN THE TRANSACTION/1/ AND
                                              THE TRANSACTION, PER FISCAL THE APPROXIMATE DOLLAR VALUE OF THE AMOUNT OF THE
TRANSACTION DESCRIPTION                               YEAR                RELATED PERSON'S INTEREST IN THE TRANSACTION ($)
-----------------------                       ------------------------    -------------------------------------------------
                                                            ($)                ALIC              AIC             ALLCORP
                                                                                               
Amended and Restated Service and              2008    3,295,180,640       215,640,945/2/   2,186,281,461/2/     5,351,262/2/
Expense Agreement between Allstate
Insurance Company, The Allstate               2009    3,451,765,246       180,154,068/2/   1,937,571,496/2/     2,510,800/2/
Corporation and certain affiliates effective
January 1, 2004, as amended by                2010    3,619,106,706       175,950,701/2/   1,823,391,816/2/     4,191,150/2/
Amendment No. 1 effective January 1,
2009, and as supplemented by New York
Insurer Supplement to Amended and
Restated Service and Expense Agreement
between Allstate Insurance Company, The
Allstate Corporation, Allstate Life
Insurance Company of New York and
Intramerica Life Insurance Company,
effective March 5, 2005.

Reinsurance Agreements between Lincoln        2008      766,582,944/6/    766,582,944/6/             N/A              N/A
Benefit Life Company and Allstate Life
Insurance Company: Coinsurance                2009      873,759,209/6/    873,759,209/6/
Agreement effective December 31, 2001;
Modified Coinsurance Agreement                2010      888,764,276/6/    888,764,276/6/
effective December 31, 2001; Modified
Coinsurance Agreement effective
December 31, 2001.

Intercompany Loan Agreement among             2008      400,040,660        50,014,792/7/       1,732,736      400,040,660
The Allstate Corporation, Allstate Life
Insurance Company, Lincoln Benefit Life       2009       86,111,674                 0/8/      86,111,674       86,111,674
Company and other certain subsidiaries of
The Allstate Corporation dated                2010      149,971,764       149,971,764        149,971,764      149,971,764
February 1, 1996.

Agreement for the Settlement of State and     2008        2,089,067           356,331/9/       1,732,736              N/A
Local Tax Credits among Allstate
Insurance Company and certain affiliates      2009          941,379           193,504/9/         441,024
effective January 1, 2007.
                                              2010          835,435           236,540/9/         474,132

--------
/1/  Each identified Related Person is a Party to the transaction.
/2/  Gross amount of expense received under the transaction.
/6/  Net reinsurance income.
/7/  Amounts loaned and repaid.
/8/  No loans outstanding at year end.
/9/  Value of transfer transactions.

                                      90



REVIEW AND APPROVAL OF INTERCOMPANY AGREEMENTS

   All intercompany agreements to which Lincoln Benefit is a party are approved
by Lincoln Benefit's Board of Directors as well as by the board of any other
affiliate of The Allstate Corporation which is a party to the agreement.
Intercompany agreements are also submitted for approval to the Nebraska
Department of Insurance, Lincoln Benefit's domestic regulator, and any
additional states in which Lincoln Benefit might be commercially domiciled
pursuant to the applicable state's insurance holding company systems act. This
process is documented in an internal procedure that captures the review and
approval process of all intercompany agreements. All approvals are maintained
in Lincoln Benefit's corporate records.

   While there is no formal process for the review and approval of related
person transactions between unaffiliated entities specific to Lincoln Benefit,
all directors and executive officers of Lincoln Benefit are subject to the
Allstate Code of Ethics ("Code"). The Code includes a written conflict of
interest policy that was adopted by the Board of Directors of the Allstate
Corporation, the ultimate parent company of Lincoln Benefit. Any potential
relationship or activity that could impair independent thinking and judgment,
including holding a financial interest in a business venture that is similar to
Allstate, or in a business that has a relationship with Allstate, must be
disclosed to Human Resources. Human Resources will work with representatives
from the Law Department, including Enterprise Business Conduct, to determine
whether an actual conflict of interest exists. Each director and executive
officer must sign a Code of Ethics certification annually.

INDEPENDENCE STANDARDS FOR DIRECTORS

   Although not subject to the independence standards of the New York Stock
Exchange, for purposes of this S-1 registration statement, Lincoln Benefit has
applied the independence standards required for listed companies of the New
York Stock Exchange to the Board of Directors. Applying these standards,
Lincoln Benefit has been determined that none of the directors are considered
to be independent.

COMPENSATION COMMITTEE INTERLOCKS AND INSIDER PARTICIPATION

   The Board of Directors of Lincoln Benefit does not have a compensation
committee. All compensation decisions are made by The Allstate Corporation, as
the ultimate parent company of Lincoln Benefit. No executive officer of Lincoln
Benefit served as a member of the compensation committee of another entity for
which any executive officer served as a director for Lincoln Benefit.

  OTHER INFORMATION

   A section entitled "Experts" is added to your prospectus as follows:

  EXPERTS

   The financial statements and the related financial statement schedules
included herein have been audited by Deloitte & Touche LLP, an independent
registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing herein.
Such financial statements and financial statement schedules are included in
reliance upon the report of such firm given upon their authority as experts in
accounting and auditing.

  PRINCIPAL UNDERWRITER

   Contingent on regulatory approval, ALFS, Inc ("ALFS") is expected to merge
into Allstate Distributors, LLC ("ADLLC"), effective April 29, 2011. At that
time, ALFS will assign its rights and delegate its duties as principal
underwriter to ADLLC. This change will have no effect on Lincoln Benefit's
obligations to you under your Contract. The section of your prospectus
concerning the principal underwriter is amended accordingly.

   Contingent on regulatory approval, ADLLC serves as distributor of the
securities registered herein. The securities offered herein are sold on a
continuous basis, and there is no specific end date for the offering.

                                      91



ADLLC, an affiliate of Lincoln Benefit, is a wholly owned subsidiary of
Allstate Life Insurance Company. ADLLC is a registered broker dealer under the
Securities and Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and is a member of the
Financial Industry Regulatory Authority. ADLLC is not required to sell any
specific number or dollar amount of securities, but will use its best efforts
to sell the securities offered.

ADMINISTRATION

   We have primary responsibility for all administration of the Contracts and
the Variable Account. We entered into an administrative services agreement with
The Prudential Insurance Company of America ("PICA") whereby, PICA or an
affiliate provides administrative services to the Variable Account and the
Contracts on our behalf. In addition, PICA entered into a master services
agreement with se/2/, inc., of 5801 SW 6th Avenue, Topeka, Kansas 66636,
whereby se/2/, inc. provides certain business process outsourcing services with
respect to the Contracts. se/2/, inc. may engage other service providers to
provide certain administrative functions. These service providers may change
over time, and as of December 31, 2010, consisted of the following: Keane BPO,
LLC (administrative services) located at 625 North Michigan Avenue, Suite 1100,
Chicago, IL 60611; RR Donnelly Global Investment Markets (compliance printing
and mailing) located at 111 South Wacker Drive, Chicago, IL 60606; Jayhawk File
Express, LLC (file storage and document destruction) located at 601 E. 5th
Street, Topeka, KS 66601-2596; Co-Sentry.net, LLC (back-up printing and
disaster recovery) located at 9394 West Dodge Rd, Suite 100, Omaha, NE 68114;
Convey Compliance Systems, Inc. (withholding calculations and tax statement
mailing) located at 3650 Annapolis Lane, Suite 190, Plymouth, MN 55447;
Spangler Graphics, LLC (compliance mailings) located at 29305 44th Street,
Kansas City, KS 66106; Veritas Document Solutions, LLC (compliance mailings)
located at 913 Commerce Ct, Buffalo Grove, IL 60089; Records Center of Topeka,
a division of Underground Vaults & Storage, Inc. (back-up tapes storage)
located at 1540 NW Gage Blvd. #6, Topeka, KS 66618; EquiSearch Services, Inc.
(lost shareholder search) located at 11 Martime Avenue, Suite 665, White
Plains, NY 10606; ZixCorp Systems, Inc. (email encryption) located at 2711 N.
Haskell Ave., Suite 2300, Dallas, TX 75204; DST Systems, Inc. (FAN mail,
positions, prices) located at 333 West 11 Street, 5th Floor, Kansas City, MO
64105.

   In administering the Contracts, the following services are provided, among
others:

    .  maintenance of Contract Owner records;

    .  Contract Owner services;

    .  calculation of unit values;

    .  maintenance of the Variable Account; and

    .  preparation of Contract Owner reports.

                                      92




                         ALLSTATE LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
                   ALLSTATE LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY OF NEW YORK
                          LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY


                   Supplement, dated October 18, 2010, to the
                    following Prospectuses, as supplemented:

                      Allstate Provider, dated May 1, 2002
                       Premier Planner, dated May 1, 2004

This supplement amends the above-referenced prospectuses for certain Variable
Annuity contracts issued by Allstate Life Insurance Company or Allstate Life
Insurance Company of New York or Lincoln Benefit Life Company, as applicable.

Effective as of November 19, 2010 (the Closure Date), the following variable
sub-account available in the Allstate Provider and Premier Planner Variable
Annuities will be closed to all contract owners except those contract owners who
have contract value invested in the variable sub-account as of the Closure Date:

             Goldman Sachs VIT Strategic International Equity Fund

Contract owners who have contract value invested in this variable sub-account as
of the Closure Date may continue to submit additional investments into the
variable sub-account thereafter, although they will not be permitted to invest
in the variable sub-account if they withdraw or otherwise transfer their entire
contract value from the variable sub-account following the Closure Date.
Contract owners who do not have contract value invested in the variable
sub-account as of the Closure Date will not be permitted to invest in this
variable sub-account thereafter.

Dollar cost averaging and/or auto-rebalancing, if elected by a contract owner,
will not be affected by the closure.

If you have any questions, please contact your financial representative or our
Variable Annuity Service Center at (800) 457-7617. Our representatives are
available to assist you from 7:30 a.m. to 5 p.m. Central time.

Please read the prospectus supplement carefully and then file it with your
important papers. No other action is required of you.



                       Supplement Dated December 31, 2009
                   To the Prospectus for Your Variable Annuity
                                    Issued By
                         Allstate Life Insurance Company
                   Allstate Life Insurance Company of New York
                          Lincoln Benefit Life Company

This supplement amends the prospectus for your variable annuity contract issued
by Allstate Life Insurance Company, Allstate Life Insurance Company of New York,
or Lincoln Benefit Life Company.

The following provision is added to your prospectus:

WRITTEN REQUESTS AND FORMS IN GOOD ORDER. Written requests must include
sufficient information and/or documentation, and be sufficiently clear, to
enable us to complete your request without the need to exercise discretion on
our part to carry it out. You may contact our Customer Service Center to learn
what information we require for your particular request to be in "good order."
Additionally, we may require that you submit your request on our form. We
reserve the right to determine whether any particular request is in good order,
and to change or waive any good order requirements at any time.

If you have any questions, please contact your financial representative or call
our Customer Service Center at 1-800-457-7617. If you own a Putnam contract,
please call 1-800-390-1277.

For future reference, please keep this supplement together with your prospectus.




                          Lincoln Benefit Life Company
                        Supplement dated August 14, 2009
                 To the following Prospectuses, as supplemented:

               Consultant Solutions, Prospectus Dated May 1, 2009
                   Consultant I, Prospectus Dated May 1, 2009
                   LBL Advantage, Prospectus Dated May 1, 2004
                   Consultant II, Prospectus Dated May 1, 2004
                  Premier Planner, Prospectus Dated May 1, 2004

This prospectus supplement amends certain disclosure contained in the
prospectuses referenced above for your variable annuity contract issued by
Lincoln Benefit Life Company ("Lincoln Benefit").

The "Annual Reports and Other Documents" section is deleted and replaced with
the following:

INCORPORATION OF CERTAIN DOCUMENTS BY REFERENCE

The Securities and Exchange Commission ("SEC") recently adopted rule 12h-7 under
the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the "Exchange Act"). Rule 12h-7
exempts an insurance company from filing reports under the Exchange Act when the
insurance company issues certain types of insurance products that are registered
under the Securities Act of 1933 and such products are regulated under state
law. Each of the variable annuities described in the prospectuses referenced
above fall within the exemption provided under rule 12h-7. Lincoln Benefit is
hereby providing notice that it is electing to rely on the exemption provided
under rule 12h-7 effective as of the date of this prospectus supplement or as
soon as possible thereafter, and will be suspending filing reports under the
Exchange Act.

The SEC allows us to "incorporate by reference" information that we file with
the SEC into this prospectus supplement which means that incorporated documents
are considered part of this prospectus supplement. We can disclose important
information to you by referring you to those documents. This prospectus
supplement incorporates by reference our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year
ended December 31, 2008, filed with the SEC on March 18, 2009, and our Quarterly
Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2009, filed with the SEC on
May 12, 2009.

Lincoln Benefit will provide to each person, including any beneficial owner, to
whom a prospectus is delivered, a copy of any or all of the information that has
been incorporated by reference into the prospectus but not delivered with the
prospectus. Such information will be provided upon written or oral request at no
cost to the requester by writing to Lincoln Benefit, P.O. Box 758565, Topeka, KS
66675-8565 or by calling 1-800- 457- 7617. The public may read and copy any
materials that Lincoln Benefit files with the SEC at the SEC's Public Reference
Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. The public may obtain
information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at
1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy,
and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file
electronically with the SEC (see http://www.sec.gov).



                          Lincoln Benefit Life Company

                                 LBL Advantage
                                 Consultant II
                                Premier Planner

                         Supplement, dated May 1, 2009

This supplement amends certain disclosure contained in the prospectus for
certain annuity contracts issued by Lincoln Benefit Life Company.

Under the "More Information" section, the subsection entitled "Legal Matters" is
deleted and replaced with the following:

LEGAL MATTERS

Certain matters of state law pertaining to the Contracts, including the validity
of the Contracts and Lincoln Benefit Life Company's right to issue such
Contracts under applicable state insurance law, have been passed upon by Susan
L. Lees, General Counsel of Lincoln Benefit Life Company.

The "Annual Reports and Other Documents" section is deleted and replaced with
the following:

ANNUAL REPORTS AND OTHER DOCUMENTS

Lincoln Benefit Life Company ("Lincoln Benefit") incorporates by reference into
the prospectus its latest annual report on Form 10-K filed pursuant to Section
13(a) or Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act since the end of the fiscal year
covered by its latest annual report, including filings made on Form 10-Q and
Form 8-K. In addition, all documents subsequently filed by Lincoln Benefit
pursuant to Sections 13(a), 13(c), 14 or 15(d) of the Exchange Act also are
incorporated into the prospectus by reference. Lincoln Benefit will provide to
each person, including any beneficial owner, to whom a prospectus is delivered,
a copy of any or all of the information that has been incorporated by reference
into the prospectus but not delivered with the prospectus. Such information will
be provided upon written or oral request at no cost to the requester by writing
to Lincoln Benefit, P.O. Box 758565, Topeka, KS 66675-8565 or by calling 1-800-
457-7617. Lincoln Benefit files periodic reports as required under the
Securities Exchange Act of 1934. The public may read and copy any materials that
Lincoln Benefit files with the SEC at the SEC's Public Reference Room at 100 F
Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. The public may obtain information on the
operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The
SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy, and information
statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically
with the SEC (see http://www.sec.gov).




                          Lincoln Benefit Life Company
                  Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account

                      Supplement, dated March 31, 2008, to
                  the LBL Advantage Variable Annuity Prospectus
             and the LBL Premier Planner Variable Annuity Prospectus

This supplement amends certain disclosure contained in the above-referenced
prospectus for certain variable annuity contracts issued by Lincoln Benefit Life
Company.

We have received notice that the Board of Trustees of the Rydex Variable Trust
has approved the following fund name change:

     Effective April 1, 2008, the name of the Rydex VT OTC Fund will be changed
     to the Rydex VT NASDAQ-100 (R) Fund.

Due to this name change, the corresponding Rydex VT OTC Sub-Account available
for your product will change its name to the Rydex VT NASDAQ-100 (R) Sub-Account
effective April 1, 2008.

The name change does not in any way affect the investment objective of the Fund,
which remains unchanged, or the manner in which the investment advisor manages
the fund.

Please keep this supplement for future reference together with your prospectus.




                          Lincoln Benefit Life Company
                  Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account

                     Supplement, dated February 26, 2007 to

         The LBL Advantage Variable Annuity Prospectus dated May 1, 2004

        The Premier Planner Variable Annuity Prospectus dated May 1, 2004

This supplement amends certain disclosures contained in the above-referenced
prospectuses for certain variable annuity contracts issued by Lincoln Benefit
Life Company.

We have received notice that the Board of Trustees ("Board") of the Legg Mason
Variable Portfolios has approved the reorganization, on or about April 27, 2007
("Conversion Date"), of the Legg Mason Partners Variable All Cap Portfolio -
Class II into the Legg Mason Partners Variable Fundamental Value Portfolio -
Class I, which will be added as an investment choice to your contract as of
April 27, 2007.

To reflect the change in the underlying Portfolio, we will transfer any Contract
Value you have in the Legg Mason Partners Variable All Cap Portfolio - Class II
Sub-Account ("All Cap Sub-Account) into the Legg Mason Partners Variable
Fundamental Value Portfolio - Class I Sub-Account ("Fundamental Value
Sub-Account"). Contract owners will receive a confirmation of the transaction
reflecting this change.

Salomon Brothers Asset Management Inc. is the investment advisor for the Legg
Mason Partners Variable Fundamental Value Portfolio - Class I. The investment
objective for this Portfolio is: Long-term capital growth with current income as
a secondary consideration.

If you currently have allocations made to the All Cap Sub-Account through
automatic additions, automatic portfolio rebalancing, dollar cost averaging or
systematic withdrawal programs, any future allocations will be made to the
Fundamental Value Sub-Account as of the Conversion Date.

For additional information on how to transfer to another investment alternative,
or how to make a change to your current allocation(s), please contact your
financial representative or call our Customer Service Center at 1-800-865-5237.

       Please keep this supplement for future reference together with your
                                  prospectuses.




                          Lincoln Benefit Life Company
                  Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account

                       Supplement, dated January 14, 2005,
                                       to
                 The Premier Planner Variable Annuity Prospectus
                                dated May 1, 2004

This supplement amends certain disclosure contained in the above-referenced
prospectus for certain variable annuity contracts issued by Lincoln Benefit Life
Company.

We have received notice that the Board of Trustees ("Board") of PIMCO Advisors
VIT has approved the liquidation, on or about April 29, 2005 (the "Closing
Date"), of the PEA Science and Technology Portfolio (the "PEA Portfolio").

The Board based its decision, in part, upon the fact that the PEA Portfolio is
relatively small in asset size and has failed to garner significant exposure in
the variable contract market. In addition, the Board believes the outlook for
future growth of the PEA Portfolio is not encouraging.

Due to the liquidation of the PEA Portfolio, we will no longer accept new
premiums for investment in, nor will we permit transfers to, the PEA Science and
Technology Portfolio Sub-Account ("PEA Sub-Account") on or after April 29, 2005.

Because the PEA Sub-Account will no longer be offered as an investment
alternative as of the Closing Date, you may wish to transfer, prior to April 29,
2005, some or all of your interest in the PEA Sub-Account to the other
investment alternatives currently offered by your Contract. Any value remaining
in the PEA Sub-Account will be transferred automatically, as of the Closing
Date, to the PIMCO VIT Money Market Sub-Account, an investment alternative
already available under your Contract. These transfers are not subject to a
transfer fee.

If you currently have allocations made to the PEA Sub-Account through automatic
additions, automatic portfolio rebalancing, dollar cost averaging or systematic
withdrawal programs, your allocation in the PEA Sub-Account will also need to be
changed in these programs. If you do not change this allocation to other
investment alternatives currently available under your Policy, any allocation to
the PEA Sub-Account will be automatically allocated, as of the Closing Date, to
the PIMCO VIT Money Market Sub-Account.

If your interest in the PEA Sub-Account is transferred automatically on the
Closing Date to the PIMCO VIT Money Market Sub-Account, for 60 days following
the Closing Date, you may transfer your interest in the PIMCO VIT Money Market
Sub-Account to any other investment alternative(s) available under your
Contract. This transfer is not subject to a transfer fee.

We will send you a confirmation that shows the amount that we credited to the
PIMCO VIT Money Market Sub-Account or to the investment alternative that you
chose and the date of the transaction. For additional information on how to
transfer to another investment alternative, or how to make a change to your
current allocation(s), please contact your financial representative or call our
Customer Service Center at the number listed below.

Attached, as Appendix A, is a list of the Portfolios and Fixed Account
Investment Alternatives currently available under your Contract.

Please keep this supplement for future reference together with your
prospectuses.

Number for Customer Service Center: 1-800-865-5237

                                   Appendix A

The Premier Planner Variable Annuity contract offers a variety of Investment
Alternatives that encompass investment choices ranging from aggressive to
conservative. Below is a listing of the Portfolios and Fixed Account Investment
Alternatives currently available. Also included is the investment objective for
each Portfolio.

For more complete information about each Portfolio, including expenses and risks
associated with the Portfolio, please refer to the relevant prospectus for the
Portfolio.

                                   PORTFOLIOS

AIM V.I. Basic Value Fund - Series I Seeks long-term growth of capital.

Alger American Growth Portfolio - Class S Seeks long-term capital appreciation.

Fidelity VIP Growth Portfolio - Service Class 2 Seeks capital appreciation.




Fidelity VIP Investment Grade Bond Portfolio - Service Class 2 Seeks as high a
level of current income as is consistent with the preservation of capital.

Fidelity VIP Overseas Portfolio - Service Class 2 Seeks long-term growth of
capital.

Goldman Sachs VIT CORESM Small Cap Equity Fund Seeks long-term growth of
capital.

Goldman Sachs VIT International Equity Fund Seeks long-term capital
appreciation.

Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation Portfolio: Institutional Shares Seeks
long-term growth of capital.

Janus Aspen Series Foreign Stock Portfolio: Service Shares Seeks long-term
growth of capital.

Janus Aspen Series Worldwide Growth Portfolio: Service Shares Seeks long-term
growth of capital in a manner consistent with the preservation of capital.

Lazard Emerging Markets Portfolio Seeks long-term capital appreciation

Lazard International Equity Portfolio Seeks long-term capital appreciation

MFS New Discovery Series - Service Class Seeks capital appreciation.

MFS Utilities Series - Service Class Seeks capital growth and current income.

Oppenheimer Main Street Small Cap Fund/VA - Service Shares Seeks capital
appreciation.

PAVIT OpCap Balanced Portfolio Seeks growth of capital and investment income.

PAVIT OpCap Equity Portfolio Seeks long-term capital appreciation.

PAVIT OpCap Small Cap Portfolio Seeks capital appreciation.

PIMCO VIT Foreign Bond Portfolio (U.S. Dollar-Hedged) - Administrative Shares
Seeks to maximize total return, consistent with preservation of capital and
prudent investment management.

PIMCO VIT Money Market Portfolio - Administrative Shares Seeks to obtain maximum
current income consistent with preservation of capital and daily liquidity.

PIMCO VIT Total Return Portfolio - Administrative Shares Seeks to maximize total
return, consistent with preservation of capital and prudent investment
management.

Putnam VT High Yield Fund - Class IB

Seeks high current income. Capital growth is a secondary goal when consistent
with achieving high current income. The fund seeks its goal by investing at
least 80% in U.S. corporate rated below investment grade (junk bonds) and that
have intermediate to long-term maturities (three years or longer.)

Rydex VT OTC Fund

Seeks investment results that correspond to a benchmark for over-the-counter
securities. The Portfolio's current benchmark is the NASDAQ 100 Index.

Salomon Brothers Variable All Cap Fund - Class I Seeks capital appreciation.

Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Fund - Class I Seeks long-term growth of
capital with current income as a secondary objective.

Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth Portfolio, Class I Seeks long-term capital
appreciation by investing primarily in growth-oriented equity securities of
large capitalization companies.

Van Kampen UIF High Yield Portfolio, Class I Seeks above-average total return
over a market cycle of three to five years by investing primarily in high yield
securities (commonly referred to as "junk bonds").

Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap Growth Portfolio, Class I Seeks above-average total
return over a market cycle of three to five years by investing in common stocks
and other equity securities.




Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value Portfolio, Class I Seeks above-average total
return over a market cycle of three to five years by investing in common stocks
and other equity securities.

Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Portfolio, Class II Seeks capital growth.

Van Kampen LIT Growth and Income Portfolio, Class II Seeks long-term growth of
capital and income.

                              Fixed Account Options

Standard Fixed Account
Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option




                   PREMIER PLANNER VARIABLE ANNUITY PROSPECTUS

                                FLEXIBLE PREMIUM

                 INDIVIDUAL DEFERRED VARIABLE ANNUITY CONTRACTS

                                    ISSUED BY

                          LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY

                               IN CONNECTION WITH

                  LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT

             STREET ADDRESS: 2940 SOUTH 84TH ST., LINCOLN, NE 68506

            MAILING ADDRESS: P. O. BOX 80469, LINCOLN, NE 68501-0469

                        TELEPHONE NUMBER: 1-800-865-5237

The Contract is a deferred annuity contract designed to aid you in long-term
financial planning. You may purchase it on either a tax qualified or non-tax
qualified basis. Lincoln Benefit Life no longer offers this Contract in most
states. If you have already purchased the Contract you may continue to make
purchase payments according to the Contract.

Because this is a flexible premium annuity contract, you may pay multiple
premiums. We allocate your premium to the investment options under the Contract
and our Fixed Account in the proportions that you choose. The Contract currently
offers thirty-four investment options, each of which is a Subaccount of the
Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account ("Separate Account"). Each
Subaccount invests exclusively in shares of one of the following Portfolios:

AIM VARIABLE INSURANCE FUNDS

                      AIM V.I. Basic Value Fund - Series I

THE ALGER AMERICAN FUND:

                    Alger American Growth Portfolio - Class S

FIDELITY(R) VARIABLE INSURANCE PRODUCTS:

Fidelity VIP Growth Portfolio - Service Class 2 Fidelity VIP Investment Grade
Bond Portfolio - Service Class 2 Fidelity VIP Overseas Portfolio - Service
Class 2

GOLDMAN SACHS VARIABLE INSURANCE TRUST:

Goldman Sachs VIT CORE(SM) Small Cap Equity Fund Goldman Sachs VIT International
Equity Fund

JANUS ASPEN SERIES:

Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation Portfolio -Institutional Shares Janus
Aspen Series Foreign Stock Portfolio - Service Shares (formerly International
Value Portfolio)

Janus Aspen Series Worldwide Growth Portfolio - Service Shares

J.P. MORGAN SERIES TRUST II:

                        JPMorgan Small Company Portfolio

LAZARD RETIREMENT SERIES, INC.:

Lazard Emerging Markets Portfolio
Lazard International Equity Portfolio

MFS(R) VARIABLE INSURANCE TRUST(SM):

MFS New Discovery Series - Service Class MFS Utilities Series - Service Class

OPPENHEIMER VARIABLE ACCOUNT FUNDS:

           Oppenheimer Main Street Small Cap Fund/VA - Service Shares

PIMCO ADVISORS VIT:

PAVIT OpCap Balanced Portfolio
PAVIT OpCap Equity Portfolio
PAVIT OpCap Small Cap Portfolio
PAVIT PEA Science and Technology Portfolio

PIMCO VARIABLE INSURANCE TRUST:

PIMCO VIT Foreign Bond Portfolio (U.S. Dollar-Hedged) - Administrative Shares
PIMCO VIT Money Market Portfolio - Administrative Shares PIMCO VIT StocksPLUS
Growth and Income Portfolio - Administrative Shares PIMCO VIT Total Return
Portfolio - Administrative Shares

PUTNAM VARIABLE TRUST:

                      Putnam VT High Yield Fund - Class 1B

THE RYDEX VARIABLE TRUST:

                                Rydex VT OTC Fund

SALOMON BROTHERS VARIABLE SERIES FUNDS INC:

Salomon Brothers Variable All Cap Fund - Class I Salomon Brothers Variable
Investors Fund - Class I

VAN KAMPEN LIFE INVESTMENT TRUST:

Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Portfolio, Class II Van Kampen LIT Growth and
Income Portfolio, Class II

                                  1 PROSPECTUS




THE UNIVERSAL INSTITUTIONAL FUNDS, INC.:

Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth Portfolio, Class I* Van Kampen UIF High Yield
Portfolio, Class I* Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap Growth Portfolio, Class I* Van Kampen
UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value Portfolio, Class I**

*    Morgan Stanley Investment Management, Inc., the advisor for the UIF
     Portfolios, does business in certain instances using the name Van Kampen.

**   Effective 9/20/2003, the Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap Core Portfolio, Class I
     changed its name to Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap Value Portfolio, Class I.

Some of the portfolios described in this Prospectus may not be available in your
Contract. We may make available other investment options in the future.

Your Contract Value will vary daily as a function of the investment performance
of the Subaccounts to which you have allocated Purchase Payments and any
interest credited to the Fixed Account. We do not guarantee any minimum Contract
Value for amounts allocated to the Subaccounts. Benefits provided by this
Contract, when based on the Fixed Account, are subject to a Market Value
Adjustment, which may result in an upward or downward adjustment in withdrawal
benefits, death benefits, settlement values, and transfers to the Subaccounts.

The maximum age of the oldest Contract Owner and Annuitant is age 85 as of the
date we receive the completed application. The maximum age of the oldest
Contract Owner and Annuitant for purchasing the Contract with the Enhanced Death
Benefit Rider is age 80.

Each time you pay a Premium, we will credit your Contract Value with a Credit
Enhancement. In addition to this Contract, we also offer other annuity contracts
that do not provide for Credit Enhancements. The expenses for this Contract may
be higher than the expenses for an annuity contract that does not provide for
Credit Enhancements. Over time, the amount of the Credit Enhancements may be
more than offset by the higher expenses. You and your agent should decide if
this Contract is right for you.

In certain states the Contract may be offered as a group contract with
individual ownership represented by Certificates. The discussion of Contracts in
this prospectus applies equally to Certificates under group contracts, unless
the content specifies otherwise.

This prospectus sets forth the information you ought to know about the Contract.
You should read it before investing and keep it for future reference.

We have filed a Statement of Additional Information with the Securities and
Exchange Commission ("SEC"). The current Statement of Additional Information is
dated May 1, 2004. The information in the Statement of Additional Information is
incorporated by reference in this prospectus. You can obtain a free copy by
writing us or calling us at the telephone number given above. The Table of
Contents of the Statement of Additional Information appears on page 44 of this
prospectus.

At least once each year we will send you an annual statement. The annual
statement details values and specific information for your Contract. It does not
contain our financial statements. Our financial statements are set forth in the
Statement of Additional Information. Lincoln Benefit Life Company ("Lincoln
Benefit") will file annual and quarterly reports and other information with the
SEC. You may read and copy any reports, statements or other information we file
at the SEC's public reference room in Washington, D.C. You can obtain copies of
these documents by writing to the SEC and paying a duplicating fee. Please call
the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information as to the operation of the
public reference room. Our SEC filings are also available to the public on the
SEC Internet site (http:// www.sec.gov).

The Date of this Prospectus is May 1, 2004.

EFFECTIVE MAY 1, 2004, THIS PRODUCT IS NO LONGER BEING OFFERED FOR SALE.

THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION HAS NOT APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED THESE
SECURITIES NOR HAS IT PASSED ON THE ACCURACY OR THE ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS.
ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

THIS PROSPECTUS IS VALID ONLY IF ACCOMPANIED OR PRECEDED BY CURRENT PROSPECTUSES
FOR THE PORTFOLIOS LISTED ABOVE. IF ANY OF THESE PROSPECTUSES IS MISSING OR
OUTDATED, PLEASE CONTACT US AND WE WILL SEND YOU THE PROSPECTUS YOU NEED.

PLEASE READ THIS PROSPECTUS CAREFULLY AND RETAIN IT FOR YOUR FUTURE REFERENCE.

                                  2 PROSPECTUS




TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
DEFINITIONS                                                                    5
FEE TABLES                                                                     6
   Examples                                                                    7
   Explanation of the Expense Examples                                         7
QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS ABOUT YOUR CONTRACT                                      8
FINANCIAL INFORMATION                                                         12
DESCRIPTION OF THE CONTRACTS                                                  13
   Summary                                                                    13
   Contract Owner                                                             13
   Annuitant                                                                  13
   Modification of the Contract                                               13
   Assignment                                                                 13
   Free Look Period                                                           13
PURCHASES AND CONTRACT VALUE                                                  14
   Minimum Purchase Payment                                                   14
   Automatic Payment Plan                                                     14
   Credit Enhancement                                                         14
Allocation of Purchase Payments                                               14
Contract Value                                                                15
Separate Account Accumulation Unit Value                                      15
Transfer During Accumulation Period                                           15
Transfers Authorized by Telephone                                             15
Market Timing & Excessive Trading                                             16
Trading Limitations                                                           16
Automatic Dollar Cost Averaging Program                                       16
Portfolio Rebalancing                                                         16
THE INVESTMENT AND FIXED ACCOUNT OPTIONS                                      17
   Separate Account Investments                                               17
      The Portfolios                                                          17
      Voting Rights                                                           20
      Additions, Deletions, and Substitutions of Securities                   20
   The Fixed Account                                                          21
      General                                                                 21
Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option                                      21
Market Value Adjustment                                                       23
Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account Option                                    23
ANNUITY BENEFITS                                                              23
   Annuity Date                                                               23
   Annuity Options                                                            24
   Other Options                                                              24
   Annuity Payments: General                                                  24
   Variable Annuity Payments                                                  25
   Fixed Annuity Payments                                                     25

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
Transfers During Annuity Period                                               25
Death Benefit During Annuity Period                                           25
Certain Employee Benefit Plans                                                26
OTHER CONTRACT BENEFITS                                                       26
   Death Benefit                                                              26
      General                                                                 26
      Due Proof of Death                                                      26
      Death Proceeds                                                          26
      Death Benefit Amount                                                    26
      Death Benefit Payments                                                  26
   Enhanced Death Benefit Rider                                               28
   Beneficiary                                                                29
   Contract Loans for 403(b) Contracts                                        29
   Withdrawals (Redemptions)                                                  30
   Systematic Withdrawal Program                                              31
   ERISA Plans                                                                31
   Minimum Contract Value                                                     31
CONTRACT CHARGES                                                              31
   Mortality and Expense Risk Charge                                          32
   Administrative Charges                                                     32
      Contract Maintenance Charge                                             32
      Administrative Expense Charge                                           32
      Transfer Fee                                                            32
   Sales Charges                                                              32
      Withdrawal Charge                                                       32
      Free Withdrawal                                                         33
   Waiver Benefits                                                            33
      General                                                                 33
      Confinement Waiver Benefit                                              33
Terminal Illness Waiver Benefit                                               34
Waiver of Withdrawal Charge for Certain Qualified Plan Withdrawals            34
Premium Taxes                                                                 33
Deduction for Separate Account Income Taxes                                   34
      Other Expenses                                                          34
TAXES                                                                         35
Taxation of Lincoln Benefit Life Company                                      35
Taxation of Variable Annuities in General                                     35
   Income Tax Withholding                                                     37
   Tax Qualified Contracts                                                    38
DESCRIPTION OF LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY AND THE SEPARATE ACCOUNT          41
   Lincoln Benefit Life Company                                               41
   Separate Account                                                           41
State Regulation of Lincoln Benefit                                           41

                                  3 PROSPECTUS




                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
ADMINISTRATION                                                                41
DISTRIBUTION OF CONTRACTS                                                     42
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS                                                             42
LEGAL MATTERS                                                                 42
ANNUAL REPORTS AND OTHER DOCUMENTS                                            42
REGISTRATION STATEMENT                                                        43

                                                                            PAGE
                                                                            ----
TABLE OF CONTENTS OF STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION                      44
APPENDIX A ACCUMULATION UNIT VALUES                                           45
APPENDIX B ILLUSTRATION OF A MARKET VALUE ADJUSTMENT                          53

THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFERING IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH
SUCH OFFERING MAY NOT LAWFULLY BE MADE. WE DO NOT AUTHORIZE ANYONE TO PROVIDE
ANY INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS REGARDING THE OFFERING DESCRIBED IN THIS
PROSPECTUS OTHER THAN AS CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS.

                                  4 PROSPECTUS




DEFINITIONS

Please refer to this list for the meaning of the following terms:

ACCUMULATION PERIOD - The period of time beginning on the day money is put into
an annuity contract and ending when the contract is annuitized or surrendered.

ACCUMULATION UNIT - A unit of measurement which we use to calculate Contract
Value.

ANNUITANT - The living person named on an annuity contact whose life expectancy
is used to calculate the annuity payments when the contract is annuitized.

ANNUITIZATION - The process by which the accumulation phase of the contract is
terminated and the conteract is converted to the payoout phase. This is
accomplished by paying the entire contract value over a period of time.

ANNUITIZED VALUE - The Contract Value adjusted by any applicable Market Value
Adjustment and less any applicable taxes.

ANNUITY DATE - The date on which annuity payments are scheduled to begin.

ANNUITY PERIOD - The period during which annuity payments are paid. The Annuity
Period begins on the Annuity Date.

ANNUITY UNIT - A unit of measurement which we use to calculate the amount of
Variable Annuity payments.

BENEFICIARY(IES) - The person designated to receive the death benefit in the
event of all of the owners' deaths.

COMPANY ("WE," "US," "OUR," "LINCOLN BENEFIT") - Lincoln Benefit Life Company.

CONTRACT ANNIVERSARY - Each anniversary of the Issue Date.

CONTRACT OWNER ("YOU," "YOUR") - The person(s) or entity having the privileges
of ownership defined in the Contract. If your Contract is issued as part of a
retirement plan, your ownership privileges may be modified by the plan.

CONTRACT VALUE - The sum of the values of your investment in the Subaccounts of
the Separate Account and the Fixed Account.

CONTRACT YEAR - Each twelve-month period beginning on the Issue Date and each
Contract Anniversary.

CONTRIBUTION YEAR - Each twelve-month period beginning on the date a Purchase
Payment is allocated to a Subaccount, or each anniversary of that date.

CREDIT ENHANCEMENT - An amount we add to your Contract Value when a Purchase
Payment is received. Each Credit Enhancement will be counted as earnings under
your Contract.

FIXED ACCOUNT - The portion of the Contract Value allocated to our general
account.

FIXED ANNUITY - A series of annuity payments that are fixed in amount.

GUARANTEE PERIODS - A period of years for which we have guaranteed a specific
effective annual interest rate on an amount allocated to the Fixed Account.

ISSUE DATE - The date when the Contract becomes effective.

LATEST ANNUITY DATE - The latest date by which you must begin annuity payments
under the Contract.

LOAN ACCOUNT - An account established for amounts transferred from the
Subaccounts or the Fixed Account as security for outstanding Contract loans.

MARKET VALUE ADJUSTMENT - An amount added to or subtracted from certain
transactions involving your interest in the Fixed Account, to reflect the impact
of changing interest rates.

NET INVESTMENT FACTOR - The factor used to determine the value of an
Accumulation Unit and Annuity Unit in any Valuation Period. We determine the Net
Investment Factor separately for each Subaccount.

NON-QUALIFIED PLAN - A retirement plan which does not receive special tax
treatment under Sections 401, 403(b), 408, 408A or 457 of the Tax Code.

PORTFOLIO(S) - The underlying funds in which the Subaccounts invest. Each
Portfolio is an investment company registered with the SEC or a separate
investment series of a registered investment company.

PURCHASE PAYMENTS - Amounts paid to us as premium for the Contract by you or on
your behalf.

QUALIFIED PLAN - A retirement plan which receives special tax treatment under
Sections 401, 403(b), 408 or 408A of the Tax Code or a deferred compensation
plan for a state and local government or another tax exempt organization under
Section 457 of the Tax Code.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT - The Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account, which is a
segregated investment account of the Company.

SUBACCOUNT - A subdivision of the Separate Account, which invests wholly in
shares of one of the Portfolios.

SURRENDER VALUE - The amount paid upon complete surrender of the Contract, equal
to the Contract Value, less any applicable premium taxes, Withdrawal Charge, and
the contract maintenance charge and increased or decreased by any Market Value
Adjustment.

TAX CODE - The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

                                  5 PROSPECTUS




TREASURY RATE - The U.S. Treasury Note Constant Maturity Yield for the preceding
week as reported in Federal Reserve Bulletin Release H.15.

VALUATION DATE - Each day the New York Stock Exchange is open for business.

VALUATION PERIOD - The period of time over which we determine the change in the
value of the Subaccounts in order to price Accumulation Units and Annuity Units.
Each Valuation Period begins at the close of normal trading on the New York
Stock Exchange ("NYSE") currently 4:00 p.m. Eastern time on each Valuation Date
and ends at the close of the NYSE on the next Valuation Date.

VARIABLE ANNUITY - A series of annuity payments that vary in amount based on
changes in the value of the Subaccounts to which your Contract Value has been
allocated.

WITHDRAWAL CHARGE - The contingent deferred sales charge that may be required
upon some withdrawals.

FEE TABLES

The following tables describe the fees and expenses that you will pay when
buying, owning and surrendering the Contract. The first table decribes the fees
and expenses that you will pay at the time that you buy the Contract, surrender
the Contract, or transfer cash value between investment options. State premium
taxes may also be deducted.

Contingent Deferred Sales Charge Withdrawal Charge (as a percentage of Purchase
Payments)

CONTRIBUTION YEAR   APPLICABLE CHARGE
-----------------   -----------------
        1                   8%
       2-3                  7%
       4-5                  6%
        6                   5%
        7                   4%
        8                   3%
       9 +                  0%

Transfer Fee (Applies solely to the second and subsequent transfers within a
calendar month. We are currently waiving the Transfer Fee) - $10.00

The next table describes the fees and expenses that you will pay periodically
during the time you own the Contract, not including Portfolio fees and expenses.


                                                                          
Annual Contract Maintenance Charge (waived if total Purchase Payments are
 $50,000 or more)                                                            $35.00
SEPARATE ACCOUNT ANNUAL EXPENSES (AS A PERCENTAGE OF DAILY NET ASSET VALUE
DEDUCTED FROM EACH OF THE SUBACCOUNTS OF THE SEPARATE ACCOUNT)
     BASE CONTRACT (WITHOUT OPTIONAL RIDERS)
       Mortality and Expense Risk Charge                                       1.30%
       Administrative Expense Charge                                           0.10%
                                                                             ------
       Total Separate Account Annual Expenses                                  1.40%
     BASE CONTRACT (WITH ENHANCED DEATH BENEFIT RIDER)
       Mortality and Expense Risk Charge                                       1.50%
       Administrative Expense Charge                                           0.10%
                                                                             ------
       Total Separate Account Annual Expenses                                  1.60%


The next table shows the minimum and maximum total operating expenses charged by
the Portfolios that you may pay periodically during the time that you own the
Contract. Advisers and/or other service providers of certain Portfolios may have
agreed to waive their fees and/or reimburse Portfolio expenses in order to keep
the Portfolios' expenses below

                                  6 PROSPECTUS




specified limits. The range of expenses shown in this table does not show the
effect of any such fee waiver or expense reimbursement. More detail concerning
each Portfolio's fees and expenses appears in the prospectus for each Portfolio.

                                                 Minimum   Maximum
------------------------------------------------------------------
Total Portfolio Annual Operating Expenses/(1)/
(expenses that are deducted
from Portfolio assets, which may include
management fees, distribution and/or
service (12b-1) fees and other expenses)          0.50%     4.31%
------------------------------------------------------------------

(1)  Expenses are shown as a percentage of Portfolio average daily net assets
     before any waiver or reimbursement as of December 31, 2003.

EXAMPLE 1

This Example is intended to help you compare the cost of investing in the
Contracts with the cost of investing in other variable annuity contracts. These
costs include Contract owner transaction expenses, Contract fees, Separate
Account annual expenses, and Portfolio fees and expenses and assumes no
transfers or exchanges were made. The example shows the dollar amount of expense
that you would bear directly or indirectly if you:

..    invested $10,000 in the Contract for the time periods indicated,

..    earned a 5% annual return on your investment,

..    surrendered your Contract, or began receiving income payments for a
     specified period of less than 120 months, at the end of each time period,
     and

..    elected the Enhanced Death Benefit Rider (with total Separate Account
     expenses of 1.60%)

The first line of the example assumes that the maximum fees and expenses of any
of the Portfolios are charged. The second line of the example assumes that the
minimum fees and expenses of any of the Portfolios are charged. Your actual
expenses may be higher or lower than those shown below.

THE EXAMPLE DOES NOT INCLUDE ANY TAXES OR TAX PENALTIES YOU MAY BE REQUIRED TO
PAY IF YOU SURRENDER YOUR CONTRACT.



                                                   1 Year   3 Years   5 Years   10 Years
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                     
Costs Based on Maximum Annual Portfolio Expenses   $1,236    $2,406    $3,544    $6,033
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Costs Based on Minimum Annual Portfolio Expenses   $  845    $1,277    $1,731    $2,763
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


EXAMPLE 2

This Example uses the same assumptions as Example 1 above, except that it
assumes you decided not to surrender your Contract, or you began receiving
income payments for a specified period of at least 120 months, at the end of
each time period.



                                                   1 Year    3 Years  5 Years   10 Years
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                                                     
Costs Based on Maximum Annual Portfolio Expenses    $641     $1,896   $3,119     $6,033
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Costs Based on Minimum Annual Portfolio Expenses    $250     $  767   $1,306     $2,763
----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


EXPLANATION OF EXPENSE EXAMPLES

PLEASE REMEMBER THAT YOU ARE LOOKING AT EXAMPLES AND NOT A REPRESENTATION OF
PAST OR FUTURE EXPENSES. YOUR RATE OF RETURN MAY BE HIGHER OR LOWER THAN 5%,
WHICH IS NOT GUARANTEED. THE EXAMPLES DO NOT ASSUME THAT ANY PORTFOLIO EXPENSE
WAIVERS OR REIMBURSEMENT ARRANGEMENTS ARE IN EFFECT FOR THE PERIODS PRESENTED.
EXAMPLES 1 AND 2 ASSUME THE ELECTION OF THE ENHANCED DEATH BENEFIT RIDER (TOTAL
SEPARATE ACCOUNT EXPENSES OF 1.60%). IF THIS RIDER WAS NOT ELECTED, THE EXPENSE
FIGURES SHOWN WOULD BE SLIGHTLY LOWER.

THE EXAMPLES REFLECT THE FREE WITHDRAWAL AMOUNTS, IF APPLICABLE AND AN ANNUAL
CONTRACT ADMINISTRATIVE CHARGE OF $35.

                                  7 PROSPECTUS




QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS ABOUT YOUR CONTRACT

The following are answers to some of the questions you may have about some of
the more important features of the Contract. The Contract is more fully
described in the rest of the Prospectus. Please read the Prospectus carefully.

1.   WHAT IS THE CONTRACT?

The Contract is a flexible premium deferred variable annuity contract. It is
designed for tax-deferred retirement investing. The Contract is available for
non-qualified or qualified retirement plans. The Contract, like all deferred
annuity contracts, has two phases: the Accumulation Period and the Annuity
Period. During the Accumulation Period, earnings accumulate on a tax-deferred
basis and are taxed as income when you make a withdrawal. The Annuity Period
begins when you begin receiving payments under one of the annuity payment
options described in the answer to Question 2. The amount of money accumulated
under your Contract during the Accumulation Period will be used to determine the
amount of your annuity payments during the Annuity Period.

Your premiums are invested in one or more of the Subaccounts of the Separate
Account or allocated to the Fixed Account, as you instruct us. If we offer
additional Subaccounts in the future, we may limit your right to allocate your
Contract Value to up to twenty-three options under the Contract, counting each
Subaccount and the Fixed Account as one option. We will treat all of your
Contract Value allocated to the Fixed Account as one option for purposes of this
limit, even if you have chosen more than one Guarantee Period. The value of your
Contract will depend on the investment performance of the Subaccounts and the
amount of interest we credit to the Fixed Account.

Each Subaccount will invest in a single investment portfolio (a "Portfolio") of
an underlying fund. The Portfolios offer a range of investment objectives, from
conservative to aggressive. You bear the entire investment risk on amounts
allocated to the Subaccounts. The investment policies and risks of each
Portfolio are described in the accompanying prospectuses for the Portfolios.

In some states, you may also allocate all or part of your Contract Value to the
"Fixed Account", as described in the answer to Question 5.

2.   WHAT ANNUITY OPTIONS DOES THE CONTRACT OFFER?

You may receive annuity payments on a fixed or a variable basis or a combination
of the two. We offer a variety of annuity options including:

..    a life annuity with payments guaranteed for five to twenty years;

..    a joint and full survivorship annuity, with payments guaranteed for five to
     twenty years; and

..    fixed payments for a specified period of five to thirty years.

Call us to inquire about other options.

You may change your annuity option at any time before annuitization. You may
select the date to annuitize the Contract. The date you select, however, may be
no later than the later of the tenth Contract Anniversary or the Annuitant's
90/TH/ birthday. If your Contract was issued in connection with a qualified
plan, different deadlines may apply.

If you select annuity payments on a variable basis, the amount of our payments
to you will be affected by the investment performance of the Subaccounts you
have selected. The fixed portion of your annuity payments, on the other hand,
generally will be equal in amount to the initial payment we determine. As
explained in more detail below, however, during the Annuity Period you will have
a limited ability to change the relative weighting of the Subaccounts on which
your variable annuity payments are based or to increase the portion of your
annuity payments consisting of Fixed Annuity payments.

3.   HOW DO I BUY A CONTRACT?

You can obtain a Contract application from your Lincoln Benefit agent. You must
pay at least $10,000 in Purchase Payments during the first Contract Year.
Purchase Payments must be at least $500, unless you enroll in an automatic
payment plan. Your periodic payments in an automatic payment plan must be at
least $100 per month. We may lower these minimums at our sole discretion. The
maximum age of the oldest Contract Owner and Annuitant is age 85 as of the date
we receive the completed application. The maximum age of the oldest Contract
Owner and Annuitant for purchasing the Contract with the Enhanced Death Benefit
Rider is age 80.

4.   WHAT ARE MY INVESTMENT CHOICES UNDER THE CONTRACT?

You can allocate and reallocate your investment among the Subaccounts, each of
which in turn invests in a single Portfolio. Under the Contract, the Separate
Account currently invests in the following Portfolios:



                                                                            PORTFOLIO(S)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                            
AIM Variable Insurance Funds                   AIM V.I. Basic Value Fund - Series I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The Alger American Fund                        Alger American Growth Portfolio - Class S
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Fidelity(R) Variable Insurance Products Fund   Fidelity VIP Growth Portfolio - Service Class 2
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Fidelity VIP Investment Grade Bond Portfolio - Service Class 2
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Fidelity VIP Overseas Portfolio - Service Class 2
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Goldman Sachs Variable Insurance Trust         Goldman Sachs VIT CORE(SM) Small Cap Equity
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Goldman Sachs VIT International Equity Fund
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Janus Aspen Series                             Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation Portfolio: Institutional
                                                Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Janus Aspen Series Foreign Stock Portfolio: Service Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Janus Aspen Series Worldwide Growth Portfolio: Service Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
J.P. Morgan Series Trust II                    JPMorgan Small Company Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Lazard Retirement Series, Inc.                 Lazard Emerging Markets Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Lazard International Equity Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MFS(R) Variable Insurance Trust(SM)            MFS New Discovery Series - Service Class
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               MFS Utilities Series - Service Class
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Oppenheimer Variable Account Funds             Oppenheimer Main Street Small Cap Fund/VA - Service Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO Advisors VIT                             PAVIT OpCap Balanced Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               PAVIT OpCap Equity Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               PAVIT OpCap Small Cap Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               PAVIT PEA Science and Technology Portfolio
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO Variable Insurance Trust                 PIMCO VIT Foreign Bond Portfolio (U.S. Dollar-Hedged) -
                                                Administrative Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               PIMCO VIT Money Market Portfolio - Administrative Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               PIMCO VIT StocksPLUS Growth and  Income Portfolio - Administrative
                                                Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               PIMCO VIT Total Return Portfolio - Administrative Shares
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Putnam Variable Trust                          Putnam VT High Yield Fund - Class 1B
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The Rydex Variable Trust                       Rydex VT OTC Fund
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Salomon Brothers Variable Series Funds Inc     Salomon Brothers Variable All Cap Fund - Class I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Fund - Class I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
The Universal Institutional Funds, Inc.*       Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth Portfolio - Class I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Van Kampen UIF High Yield  Portfolio - Class I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap Growth Portfolio - Class I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value Portfolio - Class I
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen Life Investment Trust               Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Portfolio - Class II
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                               Van Kampen LIT Growth and Income Portfolio - Class II
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


*    Morgan Stanley Investment Management, Inc., the advisor for the UIF
     Portfolios, does business in certain instances using the name Van Kampen.

Some of the Portfolios described in this prospectus may not be available in your
Contract.

Each Portfolio holds its assets separately from the assets of the other
Portfolios. Each Portfolio has distinct investment objectives and policies which
are described in the accompanying prospectuses for the Portfolios.

5.   WHAT IS THE FIXED ACCOUNT OPTION?

We offer two Fixed Account interest crediting options: the Guaranteed Maturity
Fixed Account Option and the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account Option.

You may allocate Purchase Payments to the Subaccount(s) and the Fixed
Account(s). Loan payments may not be allocated to the Fixed Account(s). You may
not transfer amounts into the DCA Fixed Account. The minimum amount that may be
transferred into any one of the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Options is
$500.

We will credit interest to amounts allocated to the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed
Account Option at a specified rate for a specified Guarantee Period. You select
the Guarantee Period for each amount that you allocate to the Guaranteed
Maturity Fixed Account Option. We will tell you what interest rates and
Guarantee Periods we are offering at a particular time. At the end of each
Guarantee Period, you may select a new Guarantee Period from among the choices
we are then making available or transfer or withdraw the relevant amount from
the Fixed Account without any Market Value Adjustment.

                                  9 PROSPECTUS




We may offer Guarantee Periods ranging from one to ten years in length. We are
currently offering Guarantee Periods of one, three, five, seven, and ten years
in length. In the future we may offer Guarantee Periods of different lengths or
stop offering some Guarantee Periods.

We will not change the interest rate credited to a particular allocation until
the end of the relevant Guarantee Period. From time to time, however, we may
change the interest rate that we offer to credit to new allocations to the
Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option and to amounts rolled over in the Fixed
Account for new Guarantee Periods.

In addition, if you participate in our dollar cost averaging program, you may
designate amounts to be held in the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account Option
until they are transferred monthly to the Subaccounts or Guarantee Periods of
your choosing. When you make an allocation to the Fixed Account for this
purpose, we will set an interest rate applicable to that amount. We will then
credit interest at that rate to that amount until it has been entirely
transferred to your chosen Subaccounts or Guarantee Periods. We will complete
the transfers within one year of the allocation. In our discretion we may change
the rate that we set for new allocations to the Fixed Account for the dollar
cost averaging program. We will never, however, set a rate less than an
effective annual rate of 3%.

A Market Value Adjustment may increase or decrease the amount of certain
transactions involving the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account, to reflect changes
in interest rates. As a general rule, we will apply a Market Value Adjustment to
the following transactions:

1)   when you withdraw funds from the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option
     in an amount greater than the Free Withdrawal Amount (which is described in
     the answer to Question 6);

2)   when you transfer funds from the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option
     to the Subaccounts;

3)   when you allocate part of your balance in the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed
     Account Option to a new Guarantee Period before the end of the existing
     Guarantee Period;

4)   when you annuitize your Contract; and

5)   when we pay a death benefit.

We will not apply a Market Value Adjustment to a transaction to the extent that:

1)   it occurs within 30 days after the end of a Guarantee Period applicable to
     the funds involved in the transaction; or

2)   it is necessary to meet IRS minimum withdrawal requirements.

We determine the amount of a Market Value Adjustment using a formula that takes
into consideration:

1)   whether current interest rates differ from interest rates at the beginning
     of the applicable Guarantee Period; and

2)   how many years are left until the end of the Guarantee Period.

As a general rule, if interest rates have dropped, the Market Value Adjustment
will be an addition; if interest rates have risen, the Market Value Adjustment
will be a deduction. It is therefore possible that if you withdraw an amount
from the Fixed Account during a Guarantee Period, a Market Value Adjustment may
cause you to receive less than you initially allocated to the Fixed Account.

6.   WHAT ARE MY EXPENSES UNDER THE CONTRACT?

Contract Maintenance Charge. During the Accumulation Period, each year we
subtract an annual contract maintenance charge of $35 from your Contract Value
allocated to the Subaccounts. We will waive this charge if you pay $50,000 or
more in Purchase Payments or if you allocate all of your Contract Value to the
Fixed Account.

During the Annuity Period, if allowed in your state, we will subtract the annual
contract maintenance charge in equal parts from your annuity payments. We waive
this charge if on the Annuity Date your Contract Value is $50,000 or more or if
all payments are Fixed Annuity payments.

Administrative Expense Charge and Mortality and Expense Risk Charge. We impose a
mortality and expense risk charge at an annual rate of 1.30% of average daily
net assets and an administrative expense charge at an annual rate of .10% of
average daily net assets. If you select our optional enhanced death benefit
rider, however, we may charge you a higher mortality and expense risk charge.
These charges are assessed each day during the Accumulation Period and the
Annuity Period. We guarantee that we will not raise these charges.

Transfer Fee. Although we currently are not charging a transfer fee, depending
on your state, the Contract permits us to charge you up to $10 per transfer for
each transfer after the first transfer in each month, or for each transfer in
excess of twelve within a calendar year. The Contract also permits us to impose
a minimum size on transfer amounts although the minimum size may be limited to
$25 in some states.

Withdrawal Charge (Contingent Deferred Sales Charge). During the Accumulation
Period, you may withdraw all or part of the value of your Contract before your
death or, if the Contract is owned by a company or other legal entity, before
the Annuitant's death. Certain withdrawals may be made without payment of any
Withdrawal Charge, which is a contingent deferred sales charge. Other
withdrawals are subject to the Withdrawal Charge.

The Withdrawal Charge will vary depending on how many complete years have passed
since you paid the Purchase Payment being withdrawn.

The Withdrawal

                                  10 PROSPECTUS




Charge applies to each Purchase Payment for eight complete years from the date
of the Payment (each a "Contribution Year") as follows:

Contribution   Applicable
    Year         Charge
------------   ----------
     1             8%
    2-3            7%
    4-5            6%
     6             5%
     7             4%
     8             3%
    9+             0%

In determining Withdrawal Charges, we will deem your Purchase Payments to be
withdrawn on a first-in first-out basis.

Each year, free of Withdrawal Charge or any otherwise applicable Market Value
Adjustment, you may withdraw the Free Withdrawal Amount, which equals:

(a)  the greater of:

..    earnings not previously withdrawn; or

..    15% of your total Purchase Payments made in the most recent eight years;
     plus

(b)  an amount equal to your total Purchase Payments made more than eight years
     ago, to the extent not previously withdrawn.

In most states, we also may waive the Withdrawal Charge if you: (1) require
long-term medical or custodial care outside the home; or (2) are diagnosed with
a terminal illness. These provisions will apply to the Annuitant, if the
Contract is owned by a company or other legal entity. Additional restrictions
and costs may apply to Contracts issued in connection with qualified plans.
Withdrawals of earnings are taxed as ordinary income and, if taken prior to age
59 1/2, may be subject to an additional 10% federal tax penalty. You should
consult with your tax counselor to determine what effect a withdrawal might have
on your tax liability. As described in the answer to Question 5, we may increase
or decrease certain withdrawals by a Market Value Adjustment.

Premium Taxes. Certain states impose a premium tax on annuity purchase payments
received by insurance companies. Any premium taxes relating to the Contract may
be deducted from Purchase Payments or the Contract Value when the tax is
incurred or at a later time. State premium taxes generally range from 0% to
3.5%.

Other Expenses. In addition to our charges under the Contract, each Portfolio
deducts amounts from its assets to pay its investment advisory fees and other
expenses.

7.   HOW WILL MY INVESTMENT IN THE CONTRACT BE TAXED?

You should consult a qualified tax advisor for personalized answers. Generally,
earnings under variable annuities are not taxed until amounts are withdrawn or
distributions are made. This deferral of taxes is designed to encourage
long-term personal savings and supplemental retirement plans.

Withdrawals taken prior to annuitization are generally considered to come from
the earnings in the Contract first. If the Contract is tax-qualified, generally
all withdrawals are treated as distributions of earnings. Withdrawal of earnings
are taxed as ordinary income and, if taken prior to age 59 1/2, may be subject
to an additional 10% federal tax penalty.

Special rules apply if the Contract is owned by a company or other legal entity.
Generally, such an owner must include in income any increase in the excess of
the Contract Value over the "investment in the contract" during the taxable
year.

8.   DO I HAVE ACCESS TO MY MONEY?

At any time during the Accumulation Period, we will pay you all or part of the
value of your Contract, minus any applicable charge, if you surrender your
Contract or request a partial withdrawal. Under some qualified plans, you may
also take a loan against the value of your Contract. Generally, a partial
withdrawal must equal at least $50, and after the withdrawal your remaining
Contract Value must at least equal $500.

Although you have access to your money during the Accumulation Period, certain
charges, such as the contract maintenance charge, the Withdrawal Charge, and
premium tax charges, may be deducted on a surrender or withdrawal. You may also
incur federal income tax liability or tax penalties. In addition, if you have
allocated some of the value of your Contract to the Fixed Account, the amount of
your surrender proceeds or withdrawal may be increased or decreased by a Market
Value Adjustment.

After annuitization, under certain settlement options you may be entitled to
withdraw the commuted value of the remaining payments.

9.   WHAT IS THE DEATH BENEFIT?

We will pay a death benefit while the Contract is in force and before the
Annuity Date, if the Contract Owner dies, or if the Annuitant dies and the
Contract Owner is not a living person. To obtain payment of the Death Benefit,
the Beneficiary must submit to us a complete request for payment of the Death
Benefit, which includes due proof of death as specified in the Contract.

The standard death benefit is the greatest of the following:

1)   your total Purchase Payments reduced proportionately for any prior partial
     withdrawals;

2)   your Contract Value;

3)   the amount you would have received by surrendering your Contract; or

4)   your Contract Value on each Contract Anniversary evenly divisible by eight,
     increased by the total

                                  11 PROSPECTUS




Purchase Payments since that anniversary and reduced proportionately by any
partial withdrawals since that anniversary.

We also offer an optional enhanced death benefit rider, which is described later
in this prospectus.

We will determine the value of the death benefit on the day that we receive all
of the information that we need to process the claim.

10.  WHAT ELSE SHOULD I KNOW?

Allocation of Purchase Payments. You allocate your initial Purchase Payment
among the Subaccounts and the Fixed Account in your Contract application. You
may make your allocations in specific dollar amounts or percentages, which must
be whole numbers that add up to 100%. When you make subsequent Purchase
Payments, you may again specify how you want your payments allocated. If you do
not, we will automatically allocate the payment based on your most recent
instructions. You may not allocate Purchase Payments to the Fixed Account if it
is not available in your state.

Credit Enhancements. We will credit your Contract Value with a Credit
Enhancement of 4% of each Purchase Payment before we allocate that Purchase
Payment among the Subaccounts or to the Fixed Account. The Credit Enhancements
will be allocated in the same proportions as the corresponding Purchase Payment.
As described in "Free Look Period" on page 13, if you cancel your Contract
during the free look period we may deduct any Credit Enhancement from the amount
paid you.

Transfers. During the Accumulation Period, you may transfer Contract Value among
the Subaccounts and from the Subaccounts to the Fixed Account. If we offer
additional Subaccounts in the future, we may limit your right to allocate your
Contract Value to no more than twenty-one options under the Contract. While you
may also transfer amounts from the Fixed Account, a Market Value Adjustment may
apply. You may instruct us to transfer Contract Value by writing or calling us.

You may also use our Automatic Dollar Cost Averaging or Portfolio Rebalancing
programs. You may not use both programs at the same time.

Under the Dollar Cost Averaging program, amounts are automatically transferred
at regular intervals from the Fixed Account or a Subaccount of your choosing,
including other Subaccounts or the Fixed Account. Transfers from the Dollar Cost
Averaging Fixed Account may be made monthly only. Transfers from Subaccounts may
be made monthly, quarterly, or annually.

Under the Portfolio Rebalancing program, you can maintain the percentage of your
Contract Value allocated to each Subaccount at a pre-set level. Investment
results will shift the balance of your Contract Value allocations. If you elect
rebalancing, we will automatically transfer your Contract Value back to the
specified percentages at the frequency (monthly, quarterly, semiannually,
annually) that you specify. We will automatically terminate this program if you
request a transfer outside of the program. You may not include the Fixed Account
in a Portfolio Rebalancing program. You also may not elect rebalancing after
annuitization.

During the Annuity Period, you may not make any transfers for the first six
months after the Annuity Date. Thereafter, you may make transfers among the
Subaccounts or from the Subaccounts to increase your Fixed Annuity payments.
Your transfers, however, must be at least six months apart. You may not,
however, convert any portion of your right to receive Fixed Annuity payments
into Variable Annuity payments.

Free-Look Period. You may cancel the Contract by returning it to us within 10
days after you receive it, or after whatever longer period may be permitted by
state law. You may return it by delivering it or mailing it to us. If you return
the Contract, the Contract terminates. In most states, we will pay you an amount
equal to the Contract Value minus the Credit Enhancement. The Owner will also
bear any expenses charged with respect to the Credit Enhancement amount incurred
prior to the return of the Contract such as any mortality and expense charge.
The Contract Value may be more or less than your Purchase Payments. In some
states, we are required to send you the amount of your Purchase Payments. Since
state laws differ as to the consequences of returning a Contract, you should
refer to your Contract for specific information about your circumstances. If
your Contract is qualified under Section 408 of the Internal Revenue Code, we
will refund the greater of any purchase payments or the Contract Value.

11.  WHO CAN I CONTACT FOR MORE INFORMATION?

You can write to us at Lincoln Benefit Life Company, P.O. Box 80469, Lincoln,
Nebraska 68501-0469, or call us at (800) 865-5237.

FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Attached as Appendix A is a table showing selected information concerning
Accumulation Unit Values for each Subaccount for each year since we started
offering the Contracts. Accumulation Unit Value is the unit of measure that we
use to calculate the value of your interest in a Subaccount. Accumulation Unit
Value does not reflect the deduction of certain charges that are subtracted from
your Contract Value, such as the Annual Contract Maintenance Charge. The
information in the table is included in the Separate Account's financial
statements. To obtain a fuller picture of each Subaccount's finances and
performance, you should review the Separate Account's financial statements,
which are in the Separate Account's Annual Statement dated as

                                  12 PROSPECTUS




of December 31, 2003, contained in the Statement of Additional Information. The
Statement of Additional Information also includes a brief explanation of how
performance of the Subaccounts is calculated.

DESCRIPTION OF THE CONTRACTS

SUMMARY. The Contract is a deferred annuity contract designed to aid you in
long-term financial planning. You may add to the Contract Value by making
additional Purchase Payments. In addition, the Contract Value will change to
reflect the performance of the Subaccounts to which you allocate your Purchase
Payments and your Contract Value, as well as to reflect Credit Enhancements and
interest credited to amounts allocated to the Fixed Account. You may withdraw
your Contract Value by making a partial withdrawal or by surrendering your
Contract. Upon annuitization, we will pay you benefits under the Contract in the
form of an annuity, either for the life of the Annuitant or for a fixed number
of years. All of these features are described in more detail below.

CONTRACT OWNER. As the Contract Owner, you are the person usually entitled to
exercise all rights of ownership under the Contract. You usually are also the
person entitled to receive benefits under the Contract or to choose someone else
to receive benefits. The Contract can also be purchased as an IRA or TSA (also
known as a 403(b)). The endorsements required to qualify these annuities under
the Code may limit or modify your rights and privileges under the Contract. The
maximum age of the oldest Contract Owner and Annuitant is age 85 as of the date
we receive the completed application. The Contract cannot be jointly owned by
both a non-living person and a living person. Changing ownership of this
Contract may cause adverse tax consequences and may not be allowed under
qualified plans. Please consult with a competent tax advisor prior to making a
request for a change of Contract Owner. If the Contract Owner is a grantor
trust, the Owner will be considered a non-living person for purposes of this
section and the Death Benefit section.

ANNUITANT. The Annuitant is the living person whose life span is used to
determine annuity payments. You initially designate an Annuitant in your
application. You may change the Annuitant at any time before annuity payments
begin. If your Contract was issued under a plan qualified under Section 403(b),
408 or 408A of the Tax Code, you must be the Annuitant. If the Contract is a
non-Qualified contract, you may also designate a Joint Annuitant, who is a
second person on whose life annuity payments depend. Additional restrictions may
apply in the case of Qualified Plans. If you are a living person and are not the
Annuitant and the Annuitant dies before annuity payments begin, then either you
become the new Annuitant or you must name another person as the new Annuitant.
If you are a non-living person and the Annuitant dies before annuity payments
begin, the Beneficiary may elect to receive a death benefit as discussed in
"Death of Annuitant" on page 28. You must attest that the Annuitant is alive in
order to annuitize your Contract.

MODIFICATION OF THE CONTRACT. Only a Lincoln Benefit officer may approve a
change in or waive any provision of the Contract. Any change or waiver must be
in writing. None of our agents has the authority to change or waive the
provisions of the Contract.

We are permitted to change the terms of the Contract if it is necessary to
comply with changes in the law. If a provision of the Contract is inconsistent
with state law, we will follow state law.

ASSIGNMENT. Before the Annuity Date, if the Annuitant is still alive, you may
assign an interest in the Contract if it is a non-Qualified Contract. If a
Contract is issued pursuant to a Qualified Plan, the law prohibits some types of
assignments, pledges and transfers and imposes special conditions on others. An
assignment may also result in taxes or tax penalties.

We will not be bound by any assignment until we receive written notice of it.
Accordingly, until we receive written notice of an assignment, we will continue
to act as though the assignment had not occurred. We are not responsible for the
validity of any assignment.

BECAUSE OF THE POTENTIAL TAX CONSEQUENCES AND ERISA ISSUES ARISING FROM AN
ASSIGNMENT, YOU SHOULD CONSULT WITH AN ATTORNEY BEFORE TRYING TO ASSIGN YOUR
CONTRACT.

FREE LOOK PERIOD. You may cancel the Contract by returning it to us within 10
days after you receive it, or within whatever longer period may be permitted by
state law. You may return it by delivering it to your agent or mailing it to us.
If you return the Contract, the Contract terminates. In most states, we will pay
you an amount equal to the Contract Value minus the Credit Enhancement. The
Contract Value at that time may be more or less than your Purchase Payments. The
Owner will also bear any expense charged with respect to the Credit Enhancement
amount incurred prior to the return of the Contract, such as any Mortality and
Expense Charge.

In some states, if you exercise your "free look" rights, we are required to
return the amount of your Purchase Payments. Currently, if you live in one of
those states, on the Issue Date we will allocate your Purchase Payment to the
Subaccounts and the Fixed Account Options as you specified in your application.
However, we reserve the right in the future to delay allocating your Purchase
Payments to the Subaccounts you have selected or to the Fixed Account until 20
days after the Issue Date or, if

                                  13 PROSPECTUS




your state's free look period is longer than ten days, for ten days plus the
period required by state law. During that time, we will allocate your Purchase
Payment to the PIMCO Money Market Subaccount. Your Contract will contain
specific information about your free-look rights in your state.

PURCHASES AND CONTRACT VALUE

MINIMUM PURCHASE PAYMENT. The minimum initial Purchase Payment for a Contract is
$10,000. You may pay it in a lump sum or in installments of your choice over the
first Contract Year. You may not pay more than $1 million in Purchase Payments
without our prior approval. As a general rule, subsequent Purchase Payments may
be made in amounts of $500 or more. Subsequent Purchase Payments made as part of
an Automatic Payment Plan, however, may be as small as $100 per month. However,
each Purchase Payment made to the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account must be at
least $1200. If we receive Purchase Payments designated for the Dollar Cost
Averaging Fixed Account that are lower than the required minimum of $1200, or
purchase payments designated for the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option
that are lower than $500, such amounts will be allocated to the PIMCO Money
Market Portfolio. We may lower these minimums if we choose. We may refuse any
Purchase Payment at any time.

AUTOMATIC PAYMENT PLAN. You may make scheduled Purchase Payments of $100 or more
per month by automatic payment through your bank account. Call or write us for
an enrollment form.

CREDIT ENHANCEMENT. We will add a Credit Enhancement to your Contract Value when
each Purchase Payment is received. The Credit Enhancement is payable from our
general account. The amount of a Credit Enhancement is 4% of each Purchase
Payment. The Credit Enhancement will be allocated among the Subaccounts and
Fixed Account in the same proportion that the applicable Purchase Payment is
allocated. The amount returned if the Contract Owner exercises his or her right
to return the Contract during your Free Look period will be reduced by any
Credit Enhancements applied.

The expense charges for this Contract may be higher than the expense charges for
annuity contracts that do not offer Credit Enhancements. We expect to recoup the
cost of paying Credit Enhancements through collections of the Withdrawal Charges
on the Contract (which are contingent), as well as our legitimate profits on
this and other contracts we offer. In some circumstances - for example, if you
surrender your Contract while the Withdrawal Charge still applies to a
substantial proportion of your Premiums - your net proceeds may be lower than if
you had purchased one of our other annuity contracts that does not offer Credit
Enhancements. Likewise, over time the amount of the Credit Enhancements may be
offset by higher expenses.

Credit Enhancements are treated as "earnings" for purposes of determining
Withdrawal Charges and free withdrawal amounts on surrenders and partial
withdrawals. Similarly, Credit Enhancements are not treated as an "investment in
the contract" for tax purposes.

ALLOCATION OF PURCHASE PAYMENTS. Your Purchase Payments are allocated to the
Subaccount(s) and the Fixed Account in the proportions that you have selected.
You must specify your allocation in your Contract application, either as
percentages or specific dollar amounts. If you make your allocation in
percentages, the total must equal 100%. We will allocate your subsequent
Purchase Payments in those percentages, until you give us new allocation
instructions. You may not allocate Purchase Payments to the Fixed Account if it
is not available in your state.

If we offer additional Subaccounts in the future, we may limit your right to
allocate your Purchase Payments to up to twenty-three options, counting each
Subaccount and the Fixed Account as one option. For this purpose, we will treat
all of your allocations to the Fixed Account as one option, even if you choose
more than one Guarantee Period.

If your application is complete, we will issue your Contract within two business
days of its receipt at our P.O. Box shown on the first page of this prospectus.
If your application for a Contract is incomplete, we will notify you and seek to
complete the application within five business days. For example, if you do not
fill in allocation percentages, we will contact you to obtain the missing
percentages. If we cannot complete your application within five business days
after we receive it, we will return your application and your Purchase Payment,
unless you expressly permit us to take a longer time.

Usually, we will allocate your initial Purchase Payment to the Subaccounts and
the Fixed Account, as you have instructed us, on the Issue Date. We will
allocate your subsequent Purchase Payments on the date that we receive them at
the next computed Accumulation Unit Value.

In some states, however, we are required to return at least your Purchase
Payment if you cancel your Contract during the "free-look" period. In those
states, we currently will allocate your Purchase Payments on the Issue Date as
you have instructed us, as described above. In the future, however, we reserve
the right, if you live in one of those states, to allocate all Purchase Payments
received during the "free-look period" to the PIMCO

                                  14 PROSPECTUS




Money Market Subaccount. If we exercise that right and your state's free look
period is ten days, we will transfer your Purchase Payments to your specified
Subaccounts or the Fixed Account 20 days after the Issue Date; if your state's
free look period is longer, we will transfer your Purchase Payment after ten
days plus the period required by state law have passed.

We determine the number of Accumulation Units in each Subaccount to allocate to
your Contract by dividing that portion of your Purchase Payment allocated to a
Subaccount by that Subaccount's Accumulation Unit Value on the Valuation Date
when the allocation occurs.

CONTRACT VALUE. We will establish an account for you and will maintain your
account during the Accumulation Period. The total value of your Contract at any
time is equal to the sum of the value of your Accumulation Units in the
Subaccounts you have selected, plus the value of your investment in the Fixed
Account.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT ACCUMULATION UNIT VALUE. As a general matter, the Accumulation
Unit Value for each Subaccount will rise or fall to reflect changes in the share
price of the Portfolio in which the Subaccount invests. In addition, we subtract
from Accumulation Unit Value amounts reflecting the mortality and expense risk
charge, administrative expense charge, and any provision for taxes that have
accrued since we last calculated the Accumulation Unit Value. We determine
Withdrawal Charges, transfer fees and contract maintenance charges separately
for each Contract. They do not affect Accumulation Unit Value. Instead, we
obtain payment of those charges and fees by redeeming Accumulation Units.

We determine a separate Accumulation Unit Value for each Subaccount. We also
determine a separate set of Accumulation Unit Values reflecting the cost of the
enhanced death benefit rider. If we elect or are required to assess a charge for
taxes, we may calculate a separate Accumulation Unit Value for Contracts issued
in connection with Non-Qualified and Qualified Plans, respectively, within each
Subaccount. We determine the Accumulation Unit Value for each Subaccount Monday
through Friday on each day that the New York Stock Exchange is open for
business.

You should refer to the prospectuses for the Portfolios which accompany this
prospectus for a description of how the assets of each Portfolio are valued,
since that determination has a direct bearing on the Accumulation Unit Value of
the corresponding Subaccount and, therefore, your Contract Value.

TRANSFER DURING ACCUMULATION PERIOD. During the Accumulation Period, you may
transfer Contract Value among the Fixed Account and the Subaccounts in writing
or by telephone. Currently, there is no minimum transfer amount. The Contract
permits us to set a minimum transfer amount in the future. You may not make a
transfer that would result in your allocating your Contract Value to more than
twenty-three options under the Contract at one time.

As a general rule, we only make transfers on days when the NYSE is open for
business. If we receive your request on one of those days, we will make the
transfer that day. If you transfer an amount from the Fixed Account to a
Subaccount before the end of the applicable Guarantee Period or you allocate an
amount in the Fixed Account to a new Guarantee Period before the end of the
existing Guarantee Period, we usually will increase or decrease the amount by a
Market Value Adjustment. The calculation of the Market Value Adjustment is
described in "Market Value Adjustment" on page 23.

Transfers within 30 days after the end of the applicable Guarantee Period are
not subject to a Market Value Adjustment.

The Contract permits us to defer transfers from the Fixed Account for up to six
months from the date you ask us.

You may not transfer Contract Value into the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account
Option. You may not transfer Contract Value out of the Dollar Cost Averaging
Fixed Account Option except as part of a Dollar Cost Averaging program.

TRANSFERS AUTHORIZED BY TELEPHONE. You may make transfers by telephone. The cut
off time for telephone transfer requests is 4:00 p.m. Eastern time. Calls
completed before 4:00 p.m. will be effected on that day at that day's price.
Calls completed after 4:00 p.m. will be effected on the next day on which the
NYSE is open for business, at that day's price.

We may charge you the transfer fee or impose a minimum transfer amount as
described on page 32, although we currently are waiving it. At any time, without
notice, we may suspend, modify or terminate your privilege to make transfers via
the telephone, or via other electronic or automated means previously approved by
the Company, including, but not limited to, automated telephone services,
facsimile machine, e-mail and electronic services via online access. Among other
things, we reserve the right to limit the number of such transfers among the
Separate Subaccounts in any Contract year, or to refuse any Separate Subaccount
transfer request. We also reserve the right to restrict such transfers in any
manner reasonably designed to prevent transfers that we consider disadvantageous
to other Contract owners.

We use procedures that we believe provide reasonable assurance that telephone
authorized transfers are genuine. For example, we tape telephone conversations
with persons purporting to authorize transfers and request identifying
information. Accordingly, we disclaim any liability for losses resulting from
allegedly unauthorized telephone transfers. However, if we do not take
reasonable steps to help ensure that a telephone authorization is valid, we may
be liable for such losses.

                                  15 PROSPECTUS




MARKET TIMING & EXCESSIVE TRADING. The Contracts are intended for long-term
investment. Frequent trading in response to short-term fluctuations in the
market can disrupt management of a Portfolio and raise its expenses, which can
impair Portfolio performance. Lincoln Benefit's policy is not to knowingly
accept any money intended for the purpose of market timing. Lincoln Benefit does
not market the Contracts to persons for the purpose of their engaging in market
timing activity.

Lincoln Benefit defines market timing activity to be the movement in and out of
a Subaccount in a short period of time designed to take advantage of short-term
market fluctuations based upon expected increases in Subaccount unit values.
Lincoln Benefit defines excessive trading activity as purchase and sale
transactions of a Contract Owner that occur with such frequency and/or such size
as to affect the Portfolio's ability to meet its investment objective, in the
judgment of Lincoln Benefit or the Portfolio.

Service center personnel seek to detect and report market timing or excessive
trading transfer activity through monitoring and review of trading activities.
Portfolios may also report suspected market timing or excessive trading transfer
activity. However, not all market timing or excessive trading transfer activity
can be prevented, as it may not be possible to identify it unless and until a
trading pattern is established. If we identify suspected market timing or
excessive trading activity, we will make further inquiry and take corrective
action as appropriate. Corrective action may include, but is not limited to,
refusing transfer requests, or suspending, modifying or terminating any
telephone, automated or electronic transfer privileges.

TRADING LIMITATIONS. We reserve the right to limit transfers among the
investment alternatives in any Contract Year, or to refuse any transfer request,
if:

..    we believe, in our sole discretion, that certain trading practices, such as
     excessive trading or market timing ("Prohibited Trading Practices"), by, or
     on behalf of, one or more Contract Owners, or a specific transfer request
     or group of transfer requests, may have a detrimental effect on the
     Accumulation Unit Values of any Variable Subaccount or on the share prices
     of the corresponding Portfolio or otherwise would be to the disadvantage of
     other Contract Owners; or

..    we are informed by one or more of the Portfolios that they intend to
     restrict the purchase, exchange, or redemption of Portfolio shares because
     of Prohibited Trading Practices or because they believe that a specific
     transfer or group of transfers would have a detrimental effect on the
     prices of Portfolio shares.

We may apply the restrictions in any manner reasonably designed to prevent
transfers that we consider disadvantageous to other Contract Owners.

AUTOMATIC DOLLAR COST AVERAGING PROGRAM. Under our Automatic Dollar Cost
Averaging program, you may authorize us to transfer a fixed dollar amount at
fixed intervals from the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account Option or a
Variable Subaccount of your choosing. You may not use the Dollar Cost Averaging
program to transfer amounts from the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option.
The interval between transfers from the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account may
be monthly only. The interval between transfers from Subaccounts may be monthly,
quarterly, or annually, at your option. The transfers will be made at the
Accumulation Unit Value on the date of the transfer. The transfers will continue
until you instruct us otherwise, or until your chosen source of transfer
payments is exhausted. Currently, the minimum transfer amount is $100 per
transfer. However, if you wish to Dollar Cost Average to a Guaranteed Maturity
Fixed Account Option, the minimum amount that must be transferred into any one
Option is $500. For each purchase payment allocated to this Option, your first
monthly transfer will occur 25 days after such purchase payment. If we do not
receive an allocation from you within 25 days of the purchase payment, we will
transfer the payment plus associated interest to the Money Market Subaccount in
equal monthly installments.Your request to participate in this program will be
effective when we receive your completed application at the P.O. Box given on
the first page of this prospectus. Call or write us for a copy of the
application. You may elect to increase, decrease or change the frequency or
amount of transfers under a Dollar Cost Averaging program. We will not charge a
transfer fee for Dollar Cost Averaging.

The theory of dollar cost averaging is that by spreading your investment over
time, you may be able to reduce the effect of transitory market conditions on
your investment. In addition, because a given dollar amount purchases more units
when the unit prices are relatively low rather than when the prices are higher,
in a fluctuating market, the average cost per unit may be less than the average
of the unit prices on the purchase dates. However, participation in this program
does not assure you of a greater profit from your purchases under the program,
nor will it prevent or necessarily reduce losses in a declining market.
Moreover, while we refer to this program of periodic transfers generally as
Dollar Cost Averaging, periodic transfers from a subaccount with more volatile
performance experience is unlikely to produce the desired effects of Dollar Cost
Averaging as would transfers from a less volatile subaccount.

PORTFOLIO REBALANCING. Portfolio Rebalancing allows you to maintain the
percentage of your Contract Value allocated to each Subaccount at a pre-set
level. Over time, the variations in each Subaccount's investment results will
shift the balance of your Contract Value allocations. Under the Portfolio
Rebalancing feature, each period, if the allocations change from your desired
percentages, we will automatically transfer your Contract Value, including new
Purchase Payments (unless you specify otherwise), back to the percentages you
specify. Portfolio Rebalancing is consistent with maintaining your allocation of
investments among market segments, although it is accomplished by reducing your
Contract Value allocated to the better performing segments.

                                  16 PROSPECTUS




You may choose to have rebalances made monthly, quarterly, semi-annually, or
annually until your Annuity Date. Portfolio Rebalancing is not available after
you annuitize. We will not charge a transfer fee for Portfolio Rebalancing. A
one-time request to rebalance the amounts allocated to the Subaccounts is not
part of a Portfolio Rebalancing program and is subject to all of the
requirements that are applicable to transfers made during the Accumulation
Period. We will automatically terminate this option if you request any transfers
outside the Portfolio Rebalancing program. If you wish to resume the Portfolio
Rebalancing after it has been canceled, then you must complete a new Portfolio
Rebalancing form and send it to our home office. You may not include the Fixed
Account in a Portfolio Rebalancing program.

You may request Portfolio Rebalancing at any time before your Annuity Date by
submitting a completed written request to us at the P.O. Box given on the first
page of this prospectus. Please call or write us for a copy of the request form.
If you stop Portfolio Rebalancing, you must wait 30 days to begin again. In your
request, you may specify a date for your first rebalancing. If you specify a
date fewer than 30 days after your Issue Date, your first rebalance will be
delayed one month. If you request Portfolio Rebalancing in your Contract
application and do not specify a date for your first rebalancing, your first
rebalance will occur one period after the Issue Date. For example, if you
specify quarterly rebalancing, your first rebalance will occur three months
after your Issue Date. Otherwise, your first rebalancing will occur one period
after we receive your completed request form. All subsequent rebalancing will
occur at the intervals you have specified on the day of the month that coincides
with the same day of the month as your Contract Anniversary Date.

Generally, you may change the allocation percentages, frequency, or choice of
Subaccounts at any time. If your total Contract Value subject to rebalancing
falls below any minimum value that we may establish, we may prohibit or limit
your use of Portfolio Rebalancing. You may not use Dollar Cost Averaging and
Portfolio Rebalancing at the same time. We may change, terminate, limit, or
suspend Portfolio Rebalancing at any time.

THE INVESTMENT AND FIXED ACCOUNT OPTIONS

SEPARATE ACCOUNT INVESTMENTS

THE PORTFOLIOS. Each of the Subaccounts of the Separate Account invests in the
shares of one of the Portfolios. Each Portfolio is either an open-end management
investment company registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940 or a
separate investment series of an open-end management investment company. We have
briefly described the Portfolios below. You should consult the current
prospectuses for the Portfolios for more detailed and complete information
concerning the Portfolios. If you do not have a prospectus for a Portfolio,
contact us and we will send you a copy.

We do not promise that the Portfolios will meet their investment objectives.
Amounts you have allocated to Subaccounts may grow in value, decline in value,
or grow less than you expect, depending on the investment performance of the
Portfolios in which those Subaccounts invest. You bear the investment risk that
those Portfolios possibly will not meet their investment objectives. You should
carefully review their prospectuses before allocating amounts to the Subaccounts
of the Separate Account.

PORTFOLIO                PORTFOLIO OBJECTIVE           INVESTMENT ADVISER
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
AIM VARIABLE INSURANCE FUNDS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
AIM V.I. Basic Value     Long-term growth of capital   A I M ADVISORS, INC.
 Fund - Series I (4)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
THE ALGER AMERICAN FUND
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Alger American Growth    Long-term capital             FRED ALGER  MANAGEMENT,
 Portfolio - Class S      appreciation                  INC.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FIDELITY(R) VARIABLE INSURANCE PRODUCTS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Fidelity VIP Growth      Capital appreciation          FIDELITY MANAGEMENT &
 Portfolio - Service                                    RESEARCH COMPANY
 Class 2
-------------------------------------------------------
Fidelity VIP Investment  As high a level of current
 Grade Bond Portfolio -   income as is consistent
 Service Class 2          with the preservation of
                          capital.
-------------------------------------------------------
Fidelity VIP Overseas    Long-term growth of capital
 Portfolio - Service
 Class 2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
GOLDMAN SACHS VARIABLE INSURANCE TRUST
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Goldman Sachs VIT        Long-term growth of capital   GOLDMAN SACHS ASSET
 CORE(SM) Small Cap                                     MANAGEMENT, L.P.
 Equity Fund
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Goldman Sachs VIT        Long-term capital             GOLDMAN SACHS ASSET
 International Equity    appreciation                  MANAGEMENT INTERNATIONAL
 Fund
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
JANUS ASPEN SERIES
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Janus Aspen Series       Long-term growth of capital   JANUS CAPITAL MANAGEMENT
 Capital Appreciation                                   LLC
 Portfolio:
 Institutional Shares
 (5)
-------------------------------------------------------
Janus Aspen Series       Long-term growth of capital
 Foreign Stock
 Portfolio: Service
 Shares (6)
-------------------------------------------------------
Janus Aspen Series       Long-term growth of capital
 Worldwide Growth         in a manner consistent with
 Portfolio: Service       the preservation of capital.
 Shares
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
J.P. MORGAN SERIES TRUST II
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
JP Morgan Small Company  High total return from a      J.P. MORGAN INVESTMENT
 Portfolio                portfolio of small company     MANAGEMENT, INC.
                          stocks.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
LAZARD RETIREMENT SERIES INC.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Lazard Emerging Markets  Long-term capital             LAZARD ASSET MANAGEMENT
 Portfolio                appreciation                  LLC
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Lazard International     Long-term capital
 Equity Portfolio         appreciation
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MFS(R) VARIABLE INSURANCE TRUST(SM)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MFS New Discovery        Capital appreciation          MFS(TM) INVESTMENT
 Series - Service Class                                 MANAGEMENT
-------------------------------------------------------
MFS Utilities Series -   Capital growth and current
 Service Class           income
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
OPPENHEIMER VARIABLE ACCOUNT FUNDS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Oppenheimer Main Street  Capital appreciation          OPPENHEIMERFUNDS, INC.
 Small Cap Fund/VA -
 Service Shares
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO ADVISORS VIT
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PAVIT OpCap Balanced     Growth of capital and         OPCAP ADVISORS LLC
 Portfolio (4)            investment income
-------------------------------------------------------
PAVIT OpCap Equity       Long-term capital
 Portfolio                appreciation
-------------------------------------------------------
PAVIT PEA Science and    Capital appreciation
 Technology Portfolio
 (3)
-------------------------------------------------------
PAVIT OpCap Small Cap    Capital appreciation
 Portfolio
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO VARIABLE INSURANCE TRUST
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO VIT Foreign Bond   To maximize total return,     PACIFIC INVESTMENT
 Portfolio (U.S.          consistent with               MANAGEMENT COMPANY LLC
 Dollar-Hedged) -         preservation of capital and
 Administrative Shares    prudent investment
                          management.
-------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO VIT Money Market   To obtain maximum current
 Portfolio -              income consistent with
 Administrative Shares    preservation of capital and
                          daily liquidity.
-------------------------------------------------------
StocksPLUS Growth and    A total return which exceeds
 Income Portfolio -       the total return
 Administrative Shares    performance of the S&P 500.
-------------------------------------------------------
PIMCO VIT Total Return   To maximize total return,
 Portfolio -              consistent with
 Administrative           Shares preservation of
                          capital and prudent
                          investment management.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PUTNAM VARIABLE TRUST
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Putnam VT High Yield     High current income. Capital  PUTNAM INVESTMENT
 Fund - Class IB          growth is a secondary goal    MANAGEMENT LLC
                          when consistent with
                          achieving high current
                          income. The fund seeks its
                          goal by investing at least
                          80% in U.S. corporate
                          bonds rated below investment
                          grade (junkbonds) and that
                          have intermediate to
                          long-term maturities (three
                          years or longer.)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
THE RYDEX VARIABLE TRUST
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Rydex VT OTC Fund         Investment results that      RYDEX INVESTMENTS
                          correspond to a benchmark for
                          over-the-counter
                          securities. The Portfolio's
                          current benchmark is the
                          NASDAQ 100 Index.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SALOMON BROTHERS VARIABLE SERIES FUNDS INC
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Salomon Brothers         Capital appreciation through  SALOMON BROTHERS ASSET
 Variable All Cap Fund    investment in securities      MANAGEMENT INC
 (formerly Capital        that the investment manager
 Fund) - Class I          believes have above-average
                          capital appreciation
                          potential.
-------------------------------------------------------
Salomon Brothers         Long-term growth of capital
 Variable Investors       with current income as a
 Fund - Class I (4)       secondary objective
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
THE UNIVERSAL INSTITUTIONAL FUNDS, INC.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen UIF Equity    Seeks long-term capital       VAN KAMPEN(1)
 Growth Portfolio,        appreciation by investing
 Class I (7)              primarily in
                          growth-oriented equity
                          securities of large
                          capitalization companies.
-------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen UIF High      Above-average total return
 Yield Portfolio,         over a market cycle of
 Class I                  three to five years by
                          investing primarily in high
                          yield securities.
-------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap   Seeks above-average total
 Growth Portfolio,        return over a market cycle
 Class I                  of three to five years by
                          investing in common stocks
                          and other equity
                          securities.

-------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid  Seeks to provide
 Cap Value Portfolio,     above-average current
 Class I (formerly Mid    income and long-term
 Cap Core Portfolio)      capital appreciation by
 (2) (8)                  investing primarily in
                          equity securities of
                          com[panies in the U.S. real
                          estate industry, including
                          real estate investment
                          trusts.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
VAN KAMPEN LIFE INVESTMENT TRUST
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen LIT           Capital Growth                VAN KAMPEN ASSET
 Aggressive Growth                                      MANAGEMENT
 Portfolio, Class II
 (9)
-------------------------------------------------------
Van Kampen LIT Growth    Long-term growth of capital
 and Income Portfolio,    and income
 Class II
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------

(1)  Morgan Stanley Investment Management Inc., the investment adviser to the
     Van Kampen UIF Portfolios, does business in certain instances as Van
     Kampen.

(2)  Effective September 30, 2003, The Universal Institutional Funds, Inc. U.S.
     Mid Cap Core Portfolio, Class I changed its name to The Universal
     Institutional Funds, Inc. U.S. Mid Cap Value Portfolio, Class I. The
     investment objective for this Portfolio has not changed.

(3)  Sub-advised by PIMCO Equity Advisers LLC.

(4)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Balance Fund, LSA Basic Value Fund and LSA Value
     Equity Fund were merged into the PAVIT OpCap Balanced Portfolio, AIM V.I.
     Basic Value Fund - Series I and Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Fund -
     Class I, respectively.

(5)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Capital Appreciation Fund was merged into the
     Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation Portfolio - Institutional Shares.

(6)  Effective 5/1/04 the Janus Aspen Series International Portfolio - Service
     Shares changed its name to the Janus Aspen Foreign Stock Portfolio -
     Service Shares.

(7)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Blue Chip Fund, LSA Equity Grown Fund and LSA
     Capital Growth Fund were merged into the Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth
     Portfolio, Class I.

(8)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Diversified Mid-Cap Growth Fund and LSA MidCap
     Value Fund were merged into the Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value
     Portfolio, Class I.

                                  19 PROSPECTUS




(9)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Aggressive Growth Fund and LSA Emerging Growth
     Fund were merged into the Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Portfolio, Class
     II.

Each Portfolio is subject to certain investment restrictions and policies which
may not be changed without the approval of a majority of the shareholders of the
Portfolio. See the accompanying prospectuses of the Portfolios for further
information.

We automatically reinvest all dividends and capital gains distributions from the
Portfolios in shares of the distributing Portfolio at their net asset value. The
income and realized and unrealized gains or losses on the assets of each
Subaccount are separate and are credited to or charged against the particular
Subaccount without regard to income, gains or losses from any other Subaccount
or from any other part of our business. We will use the net Purchase Payments
you allocate to a Subaccount to purchase shares in the corresponding Portfolio
and will redeem shares in the Portfolios to meet Contract obligations or make
adjustments in reserves. The Portfolios are required to redeem their shares at
net asset value and to make payment within seven days.

Some of the Portfolios have been established by investment advisors which manage
publicly traded mutual funds having similar names and investment objectives.
While some of the Portfolios may be similar to, and may in fact be modeled after
publicly traded mutual funds, you should understand that the Portfolios are not
otherwise directly related to any publicly traded mutual fund. Consequently, the
investment performance of publicly traded mutual funds and any similarly named
Portfolio may differ substantially.

Some of the Portfolios sell their shares to separate accounts underlying both
variable life insurance and variable annuity contracts. It is conceivable that
in the future it may be unfavorable for variable life insurance separate
accounts and variable annuity separate accounts to invest in the same Portfolio.
Although neither we nor any of the Portfolios currently foresees any such
disadvantages either to variable life insurance or variable annuity contract
owners, each Portfolio's Board of Directors intends to monitor events in order
to identify any material conflicts between variable life and variable annuity
contract owners and to determine what action, if any, should be taken in
response thereto. If a Board of Directors were to conclude that separate
investment funds should be established for variable life and variable annuity
separate accounts, Lincoln Benefit will bear the attendant expenses.

VOTING RIGHTS. As a general matter, you do not have a direct right to vote the
shares of the Portfolios held by the Subaccounts to which you have allocated
your Contract Value. Under current law, however, you are entitled to give us
instructions on how to vote those shares on certain matters. We will notify you
when your instructions are needed. We will also provide proxy materials or other
information to assist you in understanding the matter at issue. We will
determine the number of shares for which you may give voting instructions as of
the record date set by the relevant Portfolio for the shareholder meeting at
which the vote will occur.

As a general rule, before the Annuity Date, you are the person entitled to give
voting instructions. After the Annuity Date, the payee is that person.
Retirement plans, however, may have different rules for voting by plan
participants.

If you send us written voting instructions, we will follow your instructions in
voting the Portfolio shares attributable to your Contract. If you do not send us
written instructions, we will vote the shares attributable to your Contract in
the same proportions as we vote the shares for which we have received
instructions from other Contract Owners. We will vote shares that we hold in the
same proportions as we vote the shares for which we have received instructions
from other Contract Owners.

We may, when required by state insurance regulatory authorities, disregard
Contract Owner voting instructions if the instructions require that the shares
be voted so as to cause a change in the sub-classification or investment
objective of one or more of the Portfolios or to approve or disapprove an
investment advisory contract for one or more of the Portfolios.

In addition, we may disregard voting instructions in favor of changes initiated
by Contract Owners in the investment objectives or the investment advisor of the
Portfolios if we reasonably disapprove of the proposed change. We would
disapprove a proposed change only if the proposed change is contrary to state
law or prohibited by state regulatory authorities or we reasonably conclude that
the proposed change would not be consistent with the investment objectives of
the Portfolio or would result in the purchase of securities for the Portfolio
which vary from the general quality and nature of investments and investment
techniques utilized by the Portfolio. If we disregard voting instructions, we
will include a summary of that action and our reasons for that action in the
next semi-annual financial report to you.

This description reflects our view of currently applicable law. If the law
changes or our interpretation of the law changes, we may decide that we are
permitted to vote the Portfolio shares without obtaining instructions from our
Contract Owners, and we may choose to do so.

ADDITIONS, DELETIONS, AND SUBSTITUTIONS OF SECURITIES. If the shares of any of
the Portfolios are no longer available for investment by the Separate Account or
if, in the judgment of our Board of Directors, further investment in the shares
of a Portfolio is no longer appropriate in view of the purposes of the Contract,
we may add or substitute shares of another Portfolio or underlying fund for
Portfolio shares already purchased or to be purchased in the future by Purchase
Payments

                                  20 PROSPECTUS




under the Contract. Any substitution of securities will comply with the
requirements of the 1940 Act.

We also reserve the right to make the following changes in the operation of the
Separate Account and the Subaccounts:

(a)  to operate the Separate Account in any form permitted by law;

(b)  to take any action necessary to comply with applicable law or obtain and
     continue any exemption from applicable laws;

(c)  to transfer assets from one Subaccount to another, or from any subaccount
     to our general account;

(d)  to add, combine, or remove Subaccounts in the Separate Account; and

(e)  to change the way in which we assess charges, as long as the total charges
     do not exceed the maximum amount that may be charged the Separate Account
     and the Portfolios in connection with the Contracts.

If we take any of these actions, we will comply with the then applicable legal
requirements.

THE FIXED ACCOUNT

GENERAL. You may allocate part or all of your Purchase Payments to the Fixed
Account in states where it is available. Amounts allocated to the Fixed Account
become part of the general assets of Lincoln Benefit. Loan Payments may not be
allocated to the Fixed Account(s). Allstate Life invests the assets of the
general account in accordance with applicable laws governing the investments of
insurance company general accounts. The Fixed Account may not be available in
all states. Please contact us at 1-800-865-5237 for current information.

GUARANTEED MATURITY FIXED ACCOUNT OPTION. We will credit interest to each amount
allocated to the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option at a specified rate
for a specified Guarantee Period. You select the Guarantee Period for each
amount that you allocate to this option. We will declare the interest rate that
we will guarantee to credit to that amount for that Guarantee Period. Each
amount allocated to a Guarantee Period under this option must be at least $500.
We reserve the right to limit the number of additional Purchase Payments that
may be allocated to this option.

We will tell you what interest rates and Guarantee Periods we are offering at a
particular time. We may offer Guarantee Periods ranging from one to ten years in
length. We will decide in our discretion which Guarantee Periods to offer.
Currently, we offer Guarantee Periods of one, three, five, seven and ten years.
In the future we may offer Guarantee Periods of different lengths or stop
offering some Guarantee Periods.

We will credit interest daily to each amount allocated to a Guarantee Period
under this option at a rate which compounds to the effective annual interest
rate that we declared at the beginning of the applicable Guarantee Period. We
will not change the interest rate credited to a particular allocation until the
end of the relevant Guarantee Period. We may declare different interest rates
for Guarantee Periods of the same length that begin at different times.

The following example illustrates how a Purchase Payment allocated to this
option would grow, given an assumed Guarantee Period and effective annual
interest rate:

                                  21 PROSPECTUS




EXAMPLE
Purchase Payment        $10,000
Guarantee Period        5 years
Effective Annual Rate      4.50%
Credit Enhancement      $   400



                                            END OF CONTACT YEAR
                        -----------------------------------------------------------
                          YEAR 1      YEAR 2       YEAR 3      YEAR 4      YEAR 5
                        ----------  -----------  ----------  ----------  ----------
                                                          
Beginning Contract
 Value                  $10,400.00
 x (1 + Effective
 Annual Rate)              x 1.045
                        ----------
                        $10,868.00
Contract Value at end
 of Contract Year                   $$10,868.00
 x (1 + Effective
 Annual Rate)                           x 1.045
                                    -----------
                                    $ 11,357.06
Contract Value at end
 of Contract Year                                $11,357.06
 x (1 + Effective
 Annual Rate)                                       x 1.045
                                                 ----------
                                                 $11,868.13
Contract Value at end
 of Contract Year                                            $11,868.13
 x (1 + Effective
 Annual Rate)                                                   x 1.045
                                                             ----------
                                                             $12,402.19
Contract Value at end
 of Contract Year                                                        $12,402.19
 x (1 + Effective
 Annual Rate)                                                               x 1.045
                                                                         ----------
                                                                         $12,960.29


TOTAL INTEREST CREDITED DURING GUARANTEE PERIOD = $2,560.29 ($12,960.29 -
$10,400)

NOTE: This example assumes no withdrawals during the entire five-year Guarantee
Period. If you were to make a partial withdrawal, you might be required to pay a
Withdrawal Charge and the amount withdrawn might be increased or decreased by a
Market Value Adjustment. The hypothetical interest rate is for illustrative
purposes only and is not intended to predict future interest rates to be
declared under the Contract.

We have no specific formula for determining the rate of interest that we will
declare initially or in the future. We will set those interest rates based on
relevant factors such as then current interest rates, regulatory and tax
requirements, our sales commission and administrative expenses, general economic
trends, and competitive factors. For current interest rate information, please
contact us at 1-800-865-5237.

WE WILL DETERMINE THE INTEREST RATES TO BE DECLARED IN OUR SOLE DISCRETION. WE
CAN NEITHER PREDICT NOR GUARANTEE WHAT THOSE RATES WILL BE IN THE FUTURE.

At the end of each Guarantee Period, we will mail you a notice asking you what
to do with the relevant amount, including the accrued interest. During the
30-day period after the end of the Guarantee Period, you may:

1)   take no action. If so, we will automatically keep the relevant amount in
     the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option. The new Guarantee Period will
     be the same length as the expiring Guarantee Period and will begin on the
     day the previous Guarantee Period ends. The new interest rate will be our
     then current declared rate for Guarantee Periods of that length; or

2)   allocate the relevant Contract Value to one or more new Guarantee Periods
     of your choice in the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option. The new
     Guarantee Period(s) will begin on the day the previous Guarantee Period
     ends. The new interest rate will be our then current declared rate for
     those Guarantee Periods; or

3)   instruct us to transfer all or a portion of the relevant amount to one or
     more Subaccounts. We will effect the transfer on the day we receive your
     instructions. We will not adjust the amount transferred to include a Market
     Value Adjustment; or

4)   withdraw all or a portion of the relevant amount through a partial
     withdrawal. You may be required to pay a Withdrawal Charge, but we will not
     adjust the amount withdrawn to include a Market Value Adjustment. The
     amount withdrawn will be deemed to have been withdrawn on the day the
     Guarantee Period ends.

Under our Automatic Laddering Program, you may choose, in advance, to use
Guarantee Periods of the same length for all renewals in the Guaranteed Maturity
Fixed Account Option. You can select this program at any time during the
Accumulation Period, including on the Issue Date. We will apply renewals to
Guarantee Periods of the

                                  22 PROSPECTUS




selected length until you direct us in writing to stop. We may stop offering
this program at any time.

MARKET VALUE ADJUSTMENT. If permitted by your state, we may increase or decrease
the amount of some transactions involving your investment in the Guaranteed
Maturity Fixed Account Option to include a Market Value Adjustment. The formula
for determining Market Value Adjustments reflects changes in interest rates
since the beginning of the relevant Guarantee Period. As a result, you will bear
some of the investment risk on amounts allocated to the Guaranteed Maturity
Fixed Account Option.

As a general rule, we will apply a Market Value Adjustment to the following
transactions involving your Fixed Account balance:

1)   when you withdraw funds from the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option
     in an amount greater than the Free Withdrawal Amount, as described on page
     33;

2)   when you transfer funds from the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Option
     to the Subaccounts;

3)   when you allocate part of your balance in the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed
     Account Option to a new Guarantee Period before the end of the existing
     Guarantee Period;

4)   when you annuitize your Contract; and

5)   when we pay a death benefit.

We will not apply a Market Value Adjustment to a transaction, to the extent
that:

1)   it occurs within 30 days after the end of a Guarantee Period applicable to
     the funds involved in the transaction; or

2)   you make a withdrawal to satisfy the IRS' required minimum distribution
     rules for this Contract.

The formula for calculating Market Value Adjustments is set forth in Appendix B
to this prospectus, which also contains additional examples of the application
of the Market Value Adjustment. This formula primarily compares:

1)   the Treasury Rate at the time of the relevant transaction for a maturity
     equal in length to the relevant Guarantee Period; and

2)   the Treasury Rate at the beginning of the Guarantee Period for a maturity
     equal in length to the Guarantee Period.

Generally, if the Treasury Rate at the beginning of the Guarantee Period is
higher than the corresponding current Treasury Rate, then the Market Value
Adjustment will increase the amount payable to you or transferred. Similarly, if
the Treasury Rate at the beginning of the Guarantee Period is lower than the
corresponding current Treasury Rate, then the Market Value Adjustment will
reduce the amount payable to you or transferred.

For example, assume that you purchased a Contract and selected an initial
Guarantee Period of five years and the five-year Treasury Rate for that duration
is 4.50%. Assume that at the end of three years, you make a partial withdrawal.
If, at that later time, the current five-year Treasury Rate is 4.20%, then the
Market Value Adjustment will be positive, which will result in an increase in
the amount payable to you. Similarly, if the current five-year Treasury Rate is
4.80%, then the Market Value Adjustment will be negative, which will result in a
decrease in the amount payable to you.

DOLLAR COST AVERAGING FIXED ACCOUNT OPTION. If permitted by your state, you may
also allocate Purchase Payments to the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account
Option. We will credit interest to Purchase Payments allocated to this option
for up to one year at the current rate that we declare when you make the
allocation. The effective annual rate will never be less than 3%. You may not
transfer funds to this option from the Subaccounts or the Guaranteed Maturity
Fixed Account Option. We will follow your instructions in transferring amounts
from this option to the Subaccounts or the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account
Option on a monthly basis only, as described in "Automatic Dollar Cost Averaging
Program" on page 16 of this prospectus.

ANNUITY BENEFITS

ANNUITY DATE. You may select the Annuity Date, which is the date on which
annuity payments are to begin, in your application. The Annuity Date must always
be the business day on or immediately following the tenth day of a calendar
month.

The Annuity Date may be no later than the Latest Annuity Date. As a general
rule, the Latest Annuity Date is the later of the 10th Contract Anniversary or
the youngest Annuitant's 90/TH/ birthday. If your Contract was issued pursuant
to a Qualified Plan, however, the Tax Code generally requires you to begin to
take at least a minimum distribution by the later of:

..    the year of your separation from service; or

..    April 1 of the calendar year following the calendar year in which you
     attain age 70 1/2 .

If your Contract is issued pursuant to Section 408 of the Tax Code (traditional
IRAs), you must begin taking minimum distributions by April 1 of the calendar
year following the calendar year in which you reach age 70 1/2. No minimum
distributions are required by the Tax Code for Contracts issued pursuant to
Section 408A (Roth IRAs).

                                  23 PROSPECTUS




If your Contract was purchased by a Qualified Plan, we may require you to
annuitize by the date required by the Tax Code, unless you show us that you are
meeting the minimum distribution requirements in some other way.

If you do not select an Annuity Date, the Latest Annuity Date will automatically
become the Annuity Date. You may change the Annuity Date by writing to us at the
address given on the first page of the prospectus.

ANNUITY OPTIONS. You may elect an Annuity Option at any time before the Annuity
Date. As part of your election, you may choose the length of the applicable
guaranteed payment period within the limits available for your chosen Option. If
you do not select an Annuity Option, we will pay monthly annuity payments in
accordance with the applicable default Option. The default Options are:

..    Option A with 10 years (120 months) guaranteed, if you have designated only
     one Annuitant; and

..    Option B with 10 years (120 months) guaranteed, if you have designated
     joint Annuitants.

You may freely change your choice of Annuity Option, as long as you request the
change at least thirty days before the Annuity Date. Three Annuity Options are
generally available under the Contract. Each is available in the form of:

..    a Fixed Annuity;

..    a Variable Annuity; or

..    a combination of both Fixed and Variable Annuity.

A portion of each payment will be considered taxable and the remaining portion
will be a non-taxable return of your investment in the Contract, which is also
called the "basis." Once the investment in the Contract is depleted, all
remaining payments will be fully taxable. If the Contract is tax-qualified,
generally, all payments will be fully taxable. Taxable payments taken prior to
age 59 1/2 may be subject to an additional 10% federal tax penalty.

The three Annuity Options are:

OPTION A, LIFE ANNUITY WITH PAYMENTS GUARANTEED FOR 5 TO 20 YEARS. We make
periodic payments at least as long as the Annuitant lives. If the Annuitant dies
before all of the guaranteed payments have been made, we will pay the remaining
guaranteed payments to the Beneficiary.

OPTION B, JOINT AND SURVIVOR ANNUITY, WITH PAYMENTS GUARANTEED FOR 5 TO 20
YEARS. We make periodic payments at least as long as either the Annuitant or the
Joint Annuitant is alive. If both the Annuitant and the Joint Annuitant die
before all of the guaranteed payments have been made, we will pay the remaining
guaranteed payments to the Beneficiary.

OPTION C, PAYMENTS FOR A SPECIFIED PERIOD CERTAIN OF 5 YEARS TO 30 YEARS. We
make periodic payments for the period you have chosen. If the Annuitant dies
before all of the guaranteed payments have been made, we will pay the remaining
guaranteed payments to the Beneficiary. If you elect this option, and request
Variable Annuity payments, you may at any time before the period expires request
a lump sum payment, subject to a Withdrawal Charge. We will charge a Withdrawal
Charge on any portion of your lump sum payment attributable to Purchase Payments
made within the prior eight years. The amount of the Withdrawal Charge will be
determined as described in "Withdrawal Charge" on page 32 below. If you elected
Variable Annuity payments, the lump sum payment after Withdrawal Charge will
depend on:

..    the investment results of the Subaccounts you have selected,

..    the Contract Value at the time you elected annuitization, and

..    the length of the remaining period for which the payee would be entitled to
     payments.

No lump sum payment is available if you request Fixed Annuity payments. If you
purchased your Contract under a retirement plan, you may have a more limited
selection of Annuity Options to choose from. You should consult your Plan
documents to see what is available.

You may not "annuitize" your Contract for a lump sum payment. Instead, before
the Annuity Date you may surrender your Contract for a lump sum. As described on
page 32 below, however, we will subtract any applicable Withdrawal Charge and
increase or decrease your surrender proceeds by any applicable Market Value
Adjustment.

OTHER OPTIONS. We may have other Annuity Options available. You may obtain
information about them by writing or calling us.

If your Contract is issued under Sections 401, 403(b), 408 or 408A of the Tax
Code, we will only make payments to you and/or your spouse.

ANNUITY PAYMENTS: GENERAL. On the Annuity Date, we will apply the Annuitized
Value of your Contract to the Annuity Option you have chosen. Your annuity
payments may consist of Variable Annuity payments or Fixed Annuity payments or a
combination of the two. We will determine the amount of your annuity payments as
described in "Variable Annuity Payments" and "Fixed Annuity Payments" on page
25.

You must notify us in writing at least 30 days before the Annuity Date how you
wish to allocate your Annuitized Value between Variable Annuity and Fixed
Annuity payments. You must apply at least the Contract Value in the Fixed
Account on the Annuity Date to Fixed Annuity payments. If you wish to apply any
portion of your Fixed Account balance to your Variable Annuity payments, you
should plan ahead and transfer that amount to the Subaccounts prior to the
Annuity Date. If you do not tell us how to allocate your Contract Value among
Fixed and

                                  24 PROSPECTUS




Variable Annuity payments, we will apply your Contract Value in the Separate
Account to Variable Annuity payments and your Contract Value in the Fixed
Account to Fixed Annuity payments.

Annuity payments begin on the Annuity Date. We make subsequent annuity payments
on the tenth of the month or, if the NYSE is closed on that day, the next day on
which the NYSE is open for business.

Annuity payments will be made in monthly, quarterly, semi-annual or annual
installments as you select. If the amount available to apply under an Annuity
Option is less than $5,000, however, and state law permits, we may pay you a
lump sum instead of the periodic payments you have chosen. In addition, if the
first annuity payment would be less than $50, and state law permits us, we may
reduce the frequency of payments so that the initial payment will be at least
$50.

We may defer for up to 15 days the payment of any amount attributable to a
Purchase Payment made by check to allow the check reasonable time to clear.

YOU MAY NOT WITHDRAW CONTRACT VALUE DURING THE ANNUITY PERIOD, IF WE ARE MAKING
PAYMENTS TO YOU UNDER ANY ANNUITY OPTION, SUCH AS OPTION A OR B ABOVE, INVOLVING
PAYMENT TO THE PAYEE FOR LIFE OR ANY COMBINATION OF PAYMENTS FOR LIFE AND
MINIMUM GUARANTEE PERIOD FOR A PREDETERMINED NUMBER OF YEARS.

VARIABLE ANNUITY PAYMENTS. One basic objective of the Contract is to provide
Variable Annuity Payments which will to some degree respond to changes in the
economic environment. The amount of your Variable Annuity Payments will depend
upon the investment results of the Subaccounts you have selected, any premium
taxes, the age and sex of the Annuitant, and the Annuity Option chosen. We
guarantee that the Payments will not be affected by: (1) actual mortality
experience; and (2) the amount of our administration expenses.

We cannot predict the total amount of your Variable Annuity payments. The
Variable Annuity payments may be more or less than your total Purchase Payments
because: (a) Variable Annuity payments vary with the investment results of the
underlying Portfolios; and (b) Annuitants may die before their actuarial life
expectancy is achieved.

The length of any guaranteed payment period under your selected Annuity Option
will affect the dollar amounts of each Variable Annuity payment. As a general
rule, longer guarantee periods result in lower periodic payments, all other
things being equal. For example, if a life Annuity Option with no minimum
guaranteed payment period is chosen, the Variable Annuity payments will be
greater than Variable Annuity payments under an Annuity Option for a minimum
specified period and guaranteed thereafter for life.

The investment results of the Subaccounts to which you have allocated your
Contract Value will also affect the amount of your periodic payment. In
calculating the amount of the periodic payments in the annuity tables in the
Contract, we assumed an annual investment rate of 3 1/2%. If the actual net
investment return is less than the assumed investment rate, then the dollar
amount of the Variable Annuity payments will decrease. The dollar amount of the
Variable Annuity payments will stay level if the net investment return equals
the assumed investment rate and the dollar amount of the Variable Annuity
payments will increase if the net investment return exceeds the assumed
investment rate. You should consult the Statement of Additional Information for
more detailed information as to how we determine Variable Annuity Payments.

FIXED ANNUITY PAYMENTS. You may choose to apply a portion of your Annuitized
Value to provide Fixed Annuity payments. We determine the Fixed Annuity payment
amount by applying the applicable Annuitized Value to the Annuity Option you
have selected.

As a general rule, subsequent Fixed Annuity payments will be equal in amount to
the initial payment. However, as described in "Transfers During the Annuity
Period" below, after the Annuity Date, you will have a limited ability to
increase the amount of your Fixed Annuity payments by making transfers from the
Subaccounts.

We may defer making Fixed Annuity payments for a period of up to six months or
whatever shorter time state law may require. During the deferral period, we
credit interest at a rate at least as high as state law requires.

TRANSFERS DURING THE ANNUITY PERIOD. During the Annuity Period, you will have a
limited ability to make transfers among the Subaccounts so as to change the
relative weighting of the Subaccounts on which your Variable Annuity payments
will be based. In addition, you will have a limited ability to make transfers
from the Subaccounts to increase the proportion of your annuity payments
consisting of Fixed Annuity payments. You may not, however, convert any portion
of your right to receive Fixed Annuity payments into Variable Annuity payments.

You may not make any transfers for the first six months after the Annuity Date.
Thereafter, you may make transfers among the Subaccounts or make transfers from
the Subaccounts to increase your Fixed Annuity payments. Your transfers must be
at least six months apart.

DEATH BENEFIT DURING ANNUITY PERIOD. If any Contract Owner dies after the
Annuity Date, the Successor Contract Owner will receive any guaranteed annuity
payments scheduled to continue. If the successor Owner dies before all of the
guaranteed payments have been made, we will continue the guaranteed payments to
the Beneficiary(ies). After annuity payments begin, upon the death of the
Annuitant and any Joint Annuitant, we will make any remaining guaranteed
payments to the

                                  25 PROSPECTUS




Beneficiary. The amount and number of these guaranteed payments will depend on
the Annuity Option in effect at the time of the Annuitant's death. After the
Annuitant's death, any remaining guaranteed payments will be distributed at
least as rapidly as under the method of distribution in effect at the
Annuitant's death.

CERTAIN EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS. The Contracts offered by this prospectus contain
income payment tables that provide for different payments to men and women of
the same age, except in states that require unisex tables. We reserve the right
to use income payment tables that do not distinguish on the basis of sex to the
extent permitted by applicable law. In certain employment-related situations,
employers are required by law to use the same income payment tables for men and
women. Accordingly, if the Contract is to be used in connection with an
employment-related retirement or benefit plan and we do not offer unisex annuity
tables in your state, you should consult with legal counsel as to whether the
purchase of a Contract is appropriate.

OTHER CONTRACT BENEFITS

DEATH BENEFIT: GENERAL. We will pay a distribution on death, if:

1)   the Contract is in force;

2)   annuity payments have not begun; and

3)   either:

(a)  any Owner dies; or

(b)  any Annuitant dies and the Owner is a non-living person.

DUE PROOF OF DEATH. A complete request for settlement of the Death Proceeds must
be submitted before the Annuity Date. Where there are multiple beneficiaries, we
will value the Death Benefit at the time the first beneficiary submits a
complete request for settlement of the Death Proceeds. A complete request must
include "Due Proof of Death". We will accept the following documentation as Due
Proof of Death:

..    a certified original copy of the Death Certificate;

..    a certified copy of a court decree as to the finding of death; or

..    a written statement of a medical doctor who attended the deceased at the
     time of death.

In addition, in our discretion we may accept other types of proof.

DEATH PROCEEDS. If we receive a complete request for settlement of the Death
Proceeds within 180 days of the date of your death, the Death Proceeds are equal
to the Death Benefit as described below. Otherwise, the Death Proceeds are equal
to the greater of the Contract Value or the Surrender Value. We reserve the
right to waive or extend, on a nondiscriminatory basis, the 180-day period in
which the Death Proceeds will equal the Death Benefit as described below. This
right applies only to the amount payable as Death Proceeds and in no way
restricts when the claim may be filed.

DEATH BENEFIT AMOUNT. The standard Death Benefit under the Contract is the
greatest of the following:

1)   the total Purchase Payments, less a withdrawal adjustment for any prior
     partial withdrawals;

2)   the Contract Value on the date as of which we calculate the Death Benefit;

3)   the Surrender Value;

4)   the Contract Value on the eighth Contract Anniversary and each subsequent
     Contract Anniversary evenly divisible by eight, increased by the total
     Purchase Payments since that anniversary and reduced by a withdrawal
     adjustment for any partial withdrawals since that anniversary.

The withdrawal adjustment for the Death Benefit will equal (a) divided by (b),
with the result multiplied by (c), where:

(a) = the withdrawal amount;

(b) = the Contract Value immediately before the withdrawal; and

(c) = the value of the applicable Death Benefit immediately before the
      withdrawal.

As described in Enhanced Death Benefit Rider on page 28, you may add an optional
rider that in some circumstances may increase the Death Benefit under your
Contract.

DEATH BENEFIT PAYMENTS.

Death of Owner:

1.   If your spouse is the sole beneficiary:

a.   Your spouse may elect to receive the Death Proceeds in a lump sum; or

b.   Your spouse may elect to receive the Death Proceeds paid out under one of
     the annuity options, subject to the following conditions:

The Annuity Date must be within one year of your date of death.

                       Annuity payments must be payable:

i.   over the life of your spouse; or

ii.  for a guaranteed number of payments from 5 to 30 years but not to exceed
     the life expectancy of your spouse; or

                                  26 PROSPECTUS




iii. over the life of your spouse with a guaranteed number of payments from 5 to
     30 years but not to exceed the life expectancy of your spouse.

c.   If your spouse chooses to continue the Contract or does not elect one of
     these options, then the Contract will continue in the Accumulation Period
     as if the death had not occurred. If the Contract is continued in the
     Accumulation Period, the following conditions apply:

Unless otherwise instructed by the continuing spouse, the excess, if any, of the
Death Proceeds over the Contract Value will be allocated to the Subaccounts.
This excess will be allocated in proportion to your Contract Value in those
Subaccounts as of the end of the Valuation Period during which we receive the
complete request for settlement of the Death Proceeds, except that any portion
of this excess attributable to the fixed account options will be allocated to
the Money Market Subaccount. Within 30 days of the date the Contract is
continued, your surviving spouse may choose one of the following transfer
alternatives without incurring a transfer fee:

i.   transfer all or a portion of the excess among the Subaccounts;

ii.  transfer all or a portion of the excess into the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed
     Account and begin a new Guarantee Period; or

iii. transfer all or a portion of the excess into a combination of subaccounts
     and the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account.

Any such transfer does not count as the free transfer allowed each calendar
month and is subject to any minimum allocation amount specified in your
contract.

The surviving spouse may make a single withdrawal of any amount within one year
of the date of your death without incurring a Withdrawal Charge or Market Value
Adjustment.

Prior to the Annuity Date, the death benefit of the continued Contract will be
as defined in the Death Benefit provision.

Only one spousal continuation is allowed under this Contract.

If there is no Annuitant at that time, the new Annuitant will be the surviving
spouse.

2.   If the Beneficiary is not your spouse but is a living person:

a.   The Beneficiary may elect to receive the Death Proceeds in a lump sum; or

b.   The Beneficiary may elect to receive the Death Proceeds paid out under one
     of the annuity options, subject to the following conditions:

The Annuity Date must be within one year of your date of death.

                       Annuity payments must be payable:

i.   over the life of the Beneficiary; or

ii.  for a guaranteed number of payments from 5 to 30 years but not to exceed
     the life expectancy of the Beneficiary; or

iii. over the life of the Beneficiary with a guaranteed number of payments from
     5 to 30 years but not to exceed the life expectancy of the Beneficiary.

c.   If the Beneficiary does not elect one of the options above, then the
     Beneficiary must receive the Contract Value payable within 5 years of your
     date of death. We will determine the Death Proceeds as of the date we
     receive the complete request for settlement of the Death Proceeds. Unless
     otherwise instructed by the Beneficiary, the excess, if any, of the Death
     Proceeds over the Contract Value will be allocated to the Money Market
     Subaccount and the Contract Value will be adjusted accordingly. The
     Beneficiary may exercise all rights as set forth in "Transfer During the
     Accumulation Period" on page 15 and "Transfer Fee" on page 32 during this 5
     year period.

The Beneficiary may not pay additional purchase payments into the contract under
this election. Withdrawal charges will be waived for any withdrawals made during
this 5 year period.

We reserve the right to offer additional options upon Death of Owner.

If the Beneficiary dies before the complete liquidation of the Contract Value,
then the Beneficiary's named Beneficiary(ies) will receive the greater of the
Surrender Value or the remaining Contract Value. This amount must be liquidated
as a lump sum within 5 years of the date of the original Contract Owner's death.

3.   If the Beneficiary is a corporation or other type of non-living person:

a.   The Beneficiary may elect to receive the Death Proceeds in a lump sum; or

b.   If the Beneficiary does not elect to receive the option above, then the
     Beneficiary must receive the Contract Value payable within 5 years of your
     date of death. We will determine the Death Proceeds as of the date we
     receive the complete request for settlement of the Death Proceeds. Unless
     otherwise instructed by the Beneficiary, the excess, if any, of the Death
     Proceeds over the Contract Value will be allocated to the Money Market
     Subaccount and the Contract Value will be adjusted accordingly. The
     Beneficiary may exercise all rights as set forth in "Transfers During the
     Accumulation Period" on page 15 and "Transfer Fee" on page 32 during this
     5-year period.

The Beneficiary may not pay additional purchase payments into the contract under
this election. Withdrawal Charges will be waived during this 5 year period.

We reserve the right to offer additional options upon Death of Owner.

                                  27 PROSPECTUS




If any Beneficiary is a non-living person, all Beneficiaries will be considered
to be non-living persons for the above purposes.

Under any of these options, all contract rights, subject to any restrictions
previously placed upon the Beneficiary, are available to the Beneficiary from
the date of your death to the date on which the Death Proceeds are paid.

Different rules may apply to Contracts issued in connection with Qualified
Plans.

Death of Annuitant:

If the Annuitant who is not also the Owner dies prior to the Annuity Date, the
following apply:

1.   If the Owner is a living person, then the contract will continue with a new
     Annuitant as described in "Annuitant" on page 13.

2.   If the Owner is a non-living person:

a.   The Beneficiary may elect to receive the Death Proceeds in a lump sum; or

b.   If the Beneficiary does not elect the option above, then the Beneficiary
     must receive the Contract Value payable within 5 years of the Annuitant's
     date of death. On the date we receive the complete request for settlement
     of the Death Proceeds, the Contract Value under this option will be the
     Death Proceeds. Unless otherwise instructed by the Beneficiary, the excess,
     if any, of the Death Proceeds over the Contract Value will be allocated to
     the Money Market Subaccount. Henceforth, the Beneficiary may exercise all
     rights as set forth in the "Transfers During Accumulation Period" on page
     15 and "Transfer Fee" on page 32 during this 5 year period.

No additional Purchase Payments may be added to the contract under this
election. Withdrawal charges will be waived during this 5 year period.

We reserve the right to offer additional options under Death of Annuitant.

Under any of these options, all contract rights, subject to any restrictions
previously placed upon the Beneficiary, are available to the Beneficiary from
the date of the Annuitant's death to the date on which the Death Proceeds are
paid.

ENHANCED DEATH BENEFIT RIDER: When you purchase your Contract, you may select
the Enhanced Death Benefit Rider. In certain states, this benefit may be offered
as a benefit of the base contract, rather than as a separate rider. In those
states, the expense charge will remain the same for the benefit. If you are not
an individual, the Enhanced Death Benefit applies only to the Annuitant's death.
If you select this rider, the Death Benefit will be the greater of the value
provided in your Contract or the Enhanced Death Benefit. The Enhanced Death
Benefit will be the greater of the Enhanced Death Benefit A or Enhanced Death
Benefit B. As described below, we will charge a higher mortality and expense
risk charge if you select this Rider. We may discontinue offering the Rider at
any time.

ENHANCED DEATH BENEFIT A. At issue, Enhanced Death Benefit A is equal to the
initial Purchase Payment. After issue, Enhanced Death Benefit A is adjusted
whenever you pay a Purchase Payment or make a withdrawal and on each Contract
Anniversary as follows:

..    When you pay a Purchase Payment, we will increase Enhanced Death Benefit A
     by the amount of the Purchase Payment;

..    When you make a withdrawal, we will decrease Enhanced Death Benefit A by a
     withdrawal adjustment, as described below; and

..    On each Contract Anniversary, we will set Enhanced Death Benefit A equal to
     the greater of the Contract Value on that Contract Anniversary or the most
     recently calculated Enhanced Death Benefit A.

If you do not pay any additional purchase payments or make any withdrawals,
Enhanced Death Benefit A will equal the highest Contract Value on all Contract
Anniversaries prior to the date we calculate the Death Benefit.

We will continuously adjust Enhanced Death Benefit A as described above until
the oldest Contract Owner's 85/TH/ birthday or, if the Contract Owner is not a
living individual, the Annuitant's 85/TH/ birthday. Thereafter, we will adjust
Enhanced Death Benefit A only for Purchase Payments and withdrawals.

ENHANCED DEATH BENEFIT B. Enhanced Death Benefit B is equal to:

(a)  your total Purchase Payments,

(b)  reduced by any withdrawal adjustments and

(c)  accumulated daily at an effective annual rate of 5% per year, until the
     earlier of:

1)   the date we determine the death benefit;

2)   the first day of the month following the oldest Contract owner's 85/TH
     /birthday; or

3)   if the Contract Owner is a company or other legal entity, the first day of
     the month following the Annuitant's 85/TH/ birthday. Thereafter, we will
     only adjust Enhanced Death Benefit B to reflect additional Purchase
     Payments and withdrawals. Enhanced Death Benefit B will never be greater
     than the maximum death benefit allowed by any nonforfeiture laws which
     govern the Contract.

The withdrawal adjustment for both Enhanced Death Benefit A and Enhanced Death
Benefit B will equal (a) divided by (b), with the result multiplied by (c),
where:

(a) = the withdrawal amount;

(b) = the Contract Value immediately before the withdrawal; and

                                  28 PROSPECTUS




(c) = the most recently calculated Enhanced Death Benefit A or B, as
appropriate.

BENEFICIARY. You name the Beneficiary. You may name a Beneficiary in the
application. You may also name one or more contingent Beneficiaries who are
entitled to receive benefits under the contract if all primary Beneficiary(ies)
are deceased at the time a Contract Owner or any Annuitant if the Contract Owner
is not a living person, dies. You may change the Beneficiary or add additional
Beneficiaries at any time before the Annuity Date. We will provide a form to be
signed and filed with us.

Your changes in Beneficiary take effect when we accept them, effective as of the
date you signed the form. Until we accept your change instructions, we are
entitled to rely on your most recent instructions in our files. We are not
liable for making a payment to a Beneficiary shown in our files or treating that
person in any other respect as the Beneficiary, prior to accepting a change.
Accordingly, if you wish to change your beneficiary, you should deliver your
instructions to us promptly.

If you did not name a Beneficiary or if the named Beneficiary is no longer
living, the Beneficiary will be:

..    your spouse if he or she is still alive; or, if he or she is no longer
     alive,

..    your surviving children equally; or if you have no surviving children,

..    your estate.

Unless you have provided directions to the contrary, the Beneficiaries will take
equal shares. If there is more than one Beneficiary in a class and one of the
Beneficiaries predeceases the Contract Owner or Annuitant, as defined above, the
remaining Beneficiaries in that class will divide the deceased Beneficiary's
share in proportion to the original share of the remaining Beneficiaries.

If more than one Beneficiary shares in the Death Proceeds, each Beneficiary will
be treated as a separate and independent owner of his or her respective share.
Each Beneficiary will exercise all rights related to his or her share, including
the sole right to select a payout option, subject to any restrictions previously
placed upon the Beneficiary. Each Beneficiary may designate a Beneficiary(ies)
for his or her respective share, but that designated Beneficiary(ies) will be
restricted to the payout option chosen by the original Beneficiary.

If there is more than one Beneficiary and one of the Beneficiaries is a
corporation or other type of non-living person, all Beneficiaries will be
considered to be non-living persons for the above purposes.

You may specify that the Death Benefit be paid under a specific Income Plan by
submitting a written request to our Service Center. If you so request, your
Beneficiary may not change to a different Income Plan or lump sum. Once we
accept the written request, the change or restriction will take effect as of the
date you signed the request.

Different rules may apply to Contracts issued in connection with Qualified
Plans.

CONTRACT LOANS FOR 403(B) CONTRACTS. Subject to the restrictions described
below, we will make loans to the Owner of a Contract used in connection with a
Tax Sheltered Annuity Plan ("TSA Plan") under Section 403(b) of the Tax Code.
Loans are not available under Non-Qualified Contracts. We will only make loans
after the free look period and before annuitization. All loans are subject to
the terms of the Contract, the relevant Plan, and the Tax Code, which impose
restrictions on loans.

We will not make a loan to you if the total of the requested loan and your
unpaid outstanding loans will be greater than the Surrender Value of your
Contract on the date of the loan. In addition, we will not make a loan to you if
the total of the requested loan and all of the plan participant's Contract loans
under TSA plans is more than the lesser of (a) or (b) where:

(a)  equals $50,000 minus the excess of the highest outstanding loan balance
     during the prior 12 months over the current outstanding loan balance; and

(b)  equals the greater of $10,000 or 1/2 of the Surrender Value.

The minimum loan amount is $1,000.

To request a Contract loan write to us at the address given on the first page of
the prospectus. You alone are responsible for ensuring that your loan and
repayments comply with tax requirements. Loans made before the Annuity Date are
generally treated as distributions under the Contract, and may be subject to
withholding and tax penalties for early distributions. Some of these
requirements are stated in Section 72 of the Tax Code. Please seek advice from
your plan administrator or tax advisor.

When we make a loan, we will transfer an amount equal to the loan amount from
the Separate Account and/or the Fixed Account to the Loan Account as collateral
for the loan. We will transfer to the Loan Account amounts from the Separate
Account in proportion to the assets in each Subaccount. If your loan amount is
greater than your Contract Value in the Subaccounts, we will transfer the
remaining required collateral from the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account
Options. If your loan amount is greater than your contract value in the
Subaccounts and the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Options, we will transfer
the remaining required collateral from the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account
Option.

We will not charge a Withdrawal Charge on the loan or on the transfer from the
Subaccounts or the Fixed Account. We may, however, apply a Market Value
Adjustment to a transfer from the Fixed Account to the Loan Account. If we do,
we will increase or decrease the amount remaining in the Fixed Account by the
amount of the Market Value Adjustment, so that the net amount

                                  29 PROSPECTUS




transferred to the Loan Account will equal the desired loan amount. We will
charge a Withdrawal Charge and apply a Market Value Adjustment, if applicable,
on a distribution to repay the loan in full, in the event of loan default.

We will credit interest to the amounts in the Loan Account. The annual interest
rate credited to the Loan Account will be the greater of: (a) 3%; or (b) the
loan interest rate minus 2.25%. The value of the amounts in the Loan Account are
not affected by the changes in the value of the Subaccounts.

When you take out a loan, we will set the loan interest rate. That rate will
apply to your loan until it is repaid. From time to time, we may change the loan
interest rate applicable to new loans. We also reserve the right to change the
terms of new loans.

We will subtract the outstanding Contract loan balance, including accrued but
unpaid interest, from:

1)   the Death Proceeds;

2)   surrender proceeds;

3)   the amount available for partial withdrawal; and

4)   the amount applied on the Annuity Date to provide annuity payments.

Usually you must repay a Contract loan within five years of the date the loan is
made. Scheduled payments must be level, amortized over the repayment period, and
made at least quarterly. We may permit a repayment period of 15 or 30 years if
the loan proceeds are used to acquire your principal residence. We may also
permit other repayment periods.

You must mark your loan repayments as such. We will assume that any payment
received from you is a Purchase Payment, unless you tell us otherwise.
Generally, loan payments are allocated to the Subaccount(s) in the proportion
that you have selected for Purchase Payments. Allocations of loan payments are
not permitted to the Fixed Accounts (Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account and
Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account Option). If your Purchase Payment allocation
includes any of the Fixed Accounts, the percentages allocated to the Fixed
Accounts will be allocated instead to the PIMCO Money Market Subaccount.

If you do not make a loan payment when due, we will continue to charge interest
on your loan. We also will declare the entire loan in default. We will subtract
the defaulted loan balance plus accrued interest from any future distribution
under the Contract and keep it in payment of your loan. Any defaulted amount
plus interest will be treated as a distribution for tax purposes (as permitted
by law). As a result, you may be required to pay taxes on the defaulted amount,
incur the early withdrawal tax penalty. We will capitalize interest on a loan in
default.

If the total loan balance exceeds the Surrender Value, we will mail written
notice to your last known address. The notice will state the amount needed to
maintain the Contract in force. If we do not receive payment of this amount
within 31 days after we mail this notice, we will terminate your Contract.

We may defer making any loan for 6 months after you ask us for a loan, unless
the loan is to pay a premium to us.

WITHDRAWALS (REDEMPTIONS). Except as explained below, you may redeem a Contract
for all or a portion of its Contract Value before the Annuity Date. We may
impose a Withdrawal Charge, which would reduce the amount paid to you upon
redemption. The Withdrawal Charges are described on page 32. Withdrawals from
the Fixed Account may be increased or decreased by a Market Value Adjustment, as
described in "Market Value Adjustment" on page 23.

In general, you must withdraw at least $50 at a time. You may also withdraw a
lesser amount if you are withdrawing your entire interest in a Subaccount. If
your request for a partial withdrawal would reduce the Contract Value to less
than $500, we may treat it as a request for a withdrawal of your entire Contract
Value, as described in "Minimum Contract Value" on page 31. Your Contract will
terminate if you withdraw all of your Contract Value.

Withdrawals taken prior to annuitization are generally considered to come from
the earnings in the Contract first. If the Contract is tax-qualified, generally
all withdrawals are treated as ordinary income and, if taken prior to age 59
1/2, may be subject to an additional 10% federal tax penalty.

We may be required to withhold 20% of withdrawals and distributions from
Contracts issued in connection with certain Qualified Plans, as described on
Page 39.

To make a withdrawal, you must send us a written withdrawal request or
systematic withdrawal program enrollment form. You may obtain the required forms
from us at the address and phone number given on the first page of this
prospectus.

For partial withdrawals, you may allocate the amount among the Subaccounts and
the Fixed Accounts. If we do not receive allocation instructions from you, we
usually will allocate the partial withdrawal proportionately among the
Subaccounts and the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Options based upon the
balance of the Subaccounts and the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account Options,
with any remainder being distributed from the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed
Account Option. You may not make a partial withdrawal from the Fixed Account in
an amount greater than the total amount of the partial withdrawal multiplied by
the ratio of the value of the Fixed Account to the Contract Value immediately
before the partial withdrawal.

If you request a total withdrawal, you must send us your Contract. The Surrender
value will equal the Contract Value minus any applicable Withdrawal Charge and
adjusted by any applicable Market Value Adjustment. We

                                  30 PROSPECTUS




also will deduct a contract maintenance charge of $35, unless we have waived the
contract maintenance charge on your Contract as described on page 32. We
determine the Surrender Value based on the Contract Value next computed after we
receive a properly completed surrender request. We will usually pay the
Surrender Value within seven days after the day we receive a completed request
form. However, we may suspend the right of withdrawal from the Separate Account
or delay payment for withdrawals for more than seven days in the following
circumstances:

1)   whenever the New York Stock Exchange ("NYSE") is closed (other than
     customary weekend and holiday closings);

2)   when trading on the NYSE is restricted or an emergency exists, as
     determined by the SEC, so that disposal of the Separate Account's
     investments or determination of Accumulation Unit Values is not reasonably
     practicable; or

3)   at any other time permitted by the SEC for your protection.

In addition, we may delay payment of the Surrender Value in the Fixed Account
for up to 6 months or a shorter period if required by law. If we delay payment
from the Fixed Account for more than 30 days, we will pay interest as required
by applicable law.

You may withdraw amounts attributable to contributions made pursuant to a salary
reduction agreement (in accordance with Section 403(b)(11) of the Tax Code) only
in the following circumstances:

1)   when you attain age 59 1/2;

2)   when you terminate your employment with the plan sponsor;

3)   upon your death;

4)   upon your disability as defined in Section 72(m)(7) of the Tax Code; or

5)   in the case of hardship.

If you seek a hardship withdrawal, you may only withdraw amounts attributable to
your Purchase Payments; you may not withdraw any earnings. These limitations on
withdrawals apply to:

1)   salary reduction contributions made after December 31, 1988;

2)   income attributable to such contributions; and

3)   income attributable to amounts held as of December 31, 1988.

The limitations on withdrawals do not affect transfers between certain Qualified
Plans. Additional restrictions and limitations may apply to distributions from
any Qualified Plan. Tax penalties may also apply. You should seek tax advice
regarding any withdrawals or distributions from Qualified Plans.

SYSTEMATIC WITHDRAWAL PROGRAM. If your Contract is a non-Qualified Contract or
IRA, you may participate in our Systematic Withdrawal Program. You must complete
an enrollment form and send it to us. You must complete the withholding election
section of the enrollment form before the systematic withdrawals will begin. You
may choose withdrawal payments of a flat dollar amount, earnings, or a
percentage of Purchase Payments. You may choose to receive systematic withdrawal
payments on a monthly, quarterly, semi-annual, or annual basis. Systematic
withdrawals will be deducted from your Subaccount and Fixed Account balances,
excluding the Dollar Cost Averaging Fixed Account, on a pro rata basis.

Depending on fluctuations in the net asset value of the Subaccounts and the
value of the Fixed Account, systematic withdrawals may reduce or even exhaust
the Contract Value. The minimum amount of each systematic withdrawal is $50.

We will make systematic withdrawal payments to you or your designated payee. We
may modify or suspend the Systematic Withdrawal Program and charge a processing
fee for the service. If we modify or suspend the Systematic Withdrawal Program,
existing systematic withdrawal payments will not be affected.

ERISA PLANS. A married participant may need spousal consent to receive a
distribution from a Contract issued in connection with a Qualified Plan or a
Non-Qualified Plan covered by to Title 1 of ERISA. You should consult an
advisor.

MINIMUM CONTRACT VALUE. If as a result of withdrawals your Contract Value would
be less than $500 and you have not made any Purchase Payments during the
previous three full calendar years, we may terminate your Contract and
distribute its Surrender Value to you. Before we do this, we will give you 60
days notice. We will not terminate your Contract on this ground if the Contract
Value has fallen below $500 due to either a decline in Accumulation Unit Value
or the imposition of fees and charges. In addition, in some states we are not
permitted to terminate Contracts on this ground. Different rules may apply to
Contracts issued in connection with Qualified Plans.

CONTRACT CHARGES

We assess charges under the Contract in three ways:

1)   as deductions from Contract Value for contract maintenance charges and for
     premium taxes, if applicable;

2)   as charges against the assets of the Separate Account for administrative
     expenses and for the assumption of mortality and expense risks; and

                                  31 PROSPECTUS




3)   as Withdrawal Charges (contingent deferred sales charges) subtracted from
     withdrawal and surrender payments.

In addition, certain deductions are made from the assets of the Portfolios for
investment management fees and expenses. Those fees and expenses are summarized
in the Fee Tables on page 6 and described more fully in the Prospectuses and
Statements of Additional Information for the Portfolios.

MORTALITY AND EXPENSE RISK CHARGE. We deduct a mortality and expense risk charge
from each Subaccount during each Valuation Period. The mortality and expense
risk charge is equal, on an annual basis, to 1.30% of the average net asset
value of each Subaccount. The mortality risks arise from our contractual
obligations:

1)   to make annuity payments after the Annuity Date for the life of the
     Annuitant(s);

2)   to waive the Withdrawal Charge upon your death; and

3)   to provide the Death Benefit prior to the Annuity Date. A detailed
     explanation of the Death Benefit may be found beginning on page 26.

The expense risk is that it may cost us more to administer the Contracts and the
Separate Account than we receive from the contract maintenance charge and the
administrative expense charge. We guarantee the mortality and expense risk
charge and we cannot increase it. We assess the mortality and expense risk
charge during both the Accumulation Period and the Annuity Period.

If you select the Enhanced Death Benefit Rider, your mortality and expense risk
charge will be 1.50% of average net asset value of each Subaccount. We charge a
higher mortality and expense risk charge for the Rider to compensate us for the
additional risk that we accept by providing the Rider. We will calculate a
separate Accumulation Unit Value for the base Contract, and for Contracts with
the Rider, in order to reflect the difference in the mortality and expense risk
charges.

ADMINISTRATIVE CHARGES

CONTRACT MAINTENANCE CHARGE. We charge an annual contract maintenance charge of
$35 on your Contract. The amount of this charge is guaranteed not to increase.
This charge reimburses us for our expenses incurred in maintaining your
Contract.

Before the Annuity Date, we assess the contract maintenance charge on each
Contract Anniversary. To obtain payment of this charge, on a pro rata basis we
will allocate this charge among the Subaccounts to which you have allocated your
Contract Value, and redeem Accumulation Units accordingly. We will waive this
charge if you pay $50,000 or more in Purchase Payments or if you allocate all of
your Contract Value to the Fixed Account. If you surrender your Contract, we
will deduct the full $35 charge as of the date of surrender, unless your
Contract qualifies for a waiver.

After the Annuity Date, if allowed in your state, we will subtract this charge
in equal parts from each of your annuity payments. We will waive this charge if
on the Annuity Date your Contract Value is $50,000 or more or if all of your
annuity payments are Fixed Annuity payments.

ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSE CHARGE. We deduct an administrative expense charge from
each Subaccount during each Valuation Period. This charge is equal, on an annual
basis, to 0.10% of the average net asset value of the Subaccounts. This charge
is designed to compensate us for the cost of administering the Contracts and the
Separate Account. The administrative expense charge is assessed during both the
Accumulation Period and the Annuity Period.

TRANSFER FEE. We currently are waiving the transfer fee. The Contract, however,
depending on your state, either permits us to charge you up to $10 per transfer
for each transfer effected between Subaccount(s) and/or the Fixed Account after
the first transfer in each month, or for each transfer in excess of twelve
within a calendar year. The Contract also permits us to impose a minimum size on
transfer amounts although the minimum size may be limited to $25 in some states.
We will notify you if we begin to charge this fee or impose a minimum size on
transfer amounts. We will not charge a transfer fee on transfers that are part
of a Dollar Cost Averaging or Portfolio Rebalancing program.

The transfer fee will be deducted from Contract Value that remains in the
Subaccount(s) or Fixed Account from which the transfer was made. If that amount
is insufficient to pay the transfer fee, we will deduct the fee from the
transferred amount.

SALES CHARGES

WITHDRAWAL CHARGE. We may charge a Withdrawal Charge, which is a contingent
deferred sales charge, upon certain withdrawals. As a general rule, the
Withdrawal Charge equals a percentage of Purchase Payments withdrawn that are:
(a) less than eight years old; and (b) not eligible for a free withdrawal. The
applicable percentage depends on how many years ago you made the Purchase
Payment being withdrawn, as shown in this chart:

                    WITHDRAWAL
                      CHARGE
CONTRIBUTION YEAR   PERCENTAGE
-----------------   ----------
First                   8%
Second and Third        7%
Fourth and Fifth        6%
Sixth                   5%
Seventh                 4%
Eighth                  3%
Ninth and later         0%

When we calculate the Withdrawal Charge, we do not take any applicable Market
Value Adjustment into

                                  32 PROSPECTUS




consideration. If you make a withdrawal before the Annuity Date, we will apply
the withdrawal charge percentage in effect on the date of the withdrawal, or the
withdrawal charge percentage in effect on the following day, whichever is lower.

We subtract the Withdrawal Charge from the Contract Value remaining after your
withdrawal. As a result, the decrease in your Contract Value will be greater
than the withdrawal amount requested and paid.

For purposes of determining the Withdrawal Charge, the Contract Value is deemed
to be withdrawn in the following order:

First. Earnings - the current Contract Value minus all Purchase Payments that
have not previously been withdrawn; Credit Enhancements are treated as
"earnings" for this purpose;

Second. "Old Purchase Payments" - Purchase Payments received by us more than
eight years before the date of withdrawal that have not been previously
withdrawn;

Third. Any additional amounts available as a "Free Withdrawal," as described
below;

Fourth. "New Purchase Payments - Purchase Payments received by us less than
eight years before the date of withdrawal. These Payments are deemed to be
withdrawn on a first-in, first-out basis.

No Withdrawal Charge is applied in the following situations:

..    on annuitization;

..    the payment of a Death Benefit;

..    a free withdrawal amount, as described on page 33;

..    certain withdrawals for Contracts issued under 403(b) plans or 401 plans
     under our prototype as described on page 33;

..    withdrawals taken to satisfy IRS minimum distribution rules;

..    withdrawals that qualify for one of the waiver benefits described on page
     33 below; and

..    withdrawals under Contracts issued to employees of Lincoln Benefit Life
     Company, Surety Life Insurance Company, and Allstate Financial Services,
     L.L.C. or to their spouses or minor children, if these individuals reside
     in the State of Nebraska.

We will never waive or eliminate a Withdrawal Charge where such waiver or
elimination would be unfairly discriminatory to any person or where it is
prohibited by state law.

We use the amounts obtained from the Withdrawal Charge to pay sales commissions
and other promotional or distribution expenses associated with marketing the
Contracts. To the extent that the Withdrawal Charge does not cover all sales
commissions and other promotional or distribution expenses, we may use any of
our corporate assets, including potential profit which may arise from the
mortality and expense risk charge or any other charges or fee described above,
to make up any difference.

Withdrawals of earnings are taxed as ordinary income and, if taken prior to age
59 1/2, may be subject to an additional 10% federal tax penalty. The amount of
your withdrawal may be affected by a Market Value Adjustment. Additional
restrictions may apply to Contracts held in Qualified Plans. We outline the tax
requirements applicable to withdrawals on page 36. You should consult your own
tax counsel or other tax advisors regarding any withdrawals.

FREE WITHDRAWAL. Withdrawals of the following amounts are never subject to the
Withdrawal Charge:

..    In any Contract Year, the greater of: (a) earnings that have not previously
     been withdrawn; or (b) 15 percent of New Purchase Payments; and

..    Any Old Purchase Payments that have not been previously withdrawn.

Credit Enhancements are treated as earnings for purposes of determining the free
withdrawal amount. However, even if you do not owe a Withdrawal Charge on a
particular withdrawal, you may still owe taxes or penalty taxes, or be subject
to a Market Value Adjustment. The tax treatment of withdrawals is summarized on
page 36.

WAIVER BENEFITS

GENERAL. If approved in your state, we will offer the two waiver benefits
described below. In general, if you qualify for one of these benefits, we will
permit you to make one or more partial or full withdrawals without paying any
otherwise applicable Withdrawal Charge or Market Value Adjustment. While we have
summarized those benefits here, you should consult your Contract for the precise
terms of the waiver benefits.

Some Qualified Plans may not permit you to utilize these benefits. Also, even if
you do not need to pay our Withdrawal Charge because of these benefits, you
still may be required to pay taxes or tax penalties on the amount withdrawn. You
should consult your tax advisor to determine the effect of a withdrawal on your
taxes.

CONFINEMENT WAIVER BENEFIT. Under this benefit, we will waive the Withdrawal
Charge and Market Value Adjustment on all withdrawals under your Contract if the
following conditions are satisfied:

1)   Any Contract owner or the Annuitant, if the Contract is owned by a company
     or other legal entity, is confined to a long term care facility or a
     hospital for at least 90 consecutive days. The Owner or Annuitant must
     enter the long term care facility or hospital at least 30 days after the
     Issue Date;

2)   You request the withdrawal no later than 90 days following the end of the
     Owner or Annuitant's stay at the long term care facility or hospital. You
     must

                                  33 PROSPECTUS




     provide written proof of the stay with your withdrawal request; and

3)   A physician must have prescribed the stay and the stay must be medically
     necessary.

You may not claim this benefit if the physician prescribing the Owner or
Annuitant's stay in a long term care facility is the Owner or Annuitant or a
member of the Owner or Annuitant's immediate family.

TERMINAL ILLNESS WAIVER BENEFIT. Under this benefit, we will waive any
Withdrawal Charge and Market Value Adjustment on all withdrawals under your
Contract if, at least 30 days after the Issue Date, you or the Annuitant are
diagnosed with a terminal illness. Due proof of the diagnosis, as provided in
the Contract, must be given to us prior to, or at the time of, any withdrawal
request.

WAIVER OF WITHDRAWAL CHARGE FOR CERTAIN QUALIFIED PLAN WITHDRAWALS. For
Contracts issued under a Section 403(b) plan or a Section 401 plan under our
prototype, we will waive the Withdrawal Charge when:

1)   the Annuitant becomes disabled (as defined in Section 72(m)(7) of the Tax
     Code);

2)   the Annuitant reaches age 59 1/2 and at least 5 Contract Years have passed
     since the Contract was issued;

3)   at least 15 Contract Years have passed since the Contract was issued.

Our prototype is a Section 401 Defined Contribution Qualified Retirement plan.
This plan may be established as a Money Purchase plan, a Profit Sharing plan, or
a paired plan (Money Purchase and Profit Sharing). For more information about
our prototype plan, call us at 1-800-865-5237.

PREMIUM TAXES. We will charge premium taxes or other state or local taxes
against the Contract Value, including Contract Value that results from amounts
transferred from existing policies (Section 1035 exchange) issued by us or other
insurance companies. Some states assess premium taxes when Purchase Payments are
made; others assess premium taxes when annuity payments begin. We will deduct
any applicable premium taxes upon full surrender, death, or annuitization.
Premium taxes generally range from 0% to 3.5%.

DEDUCTION FOR SEPARATE ACCOUNT INCOME TAXES. We are not currently maintaining a
provision for taxes. In the future, however, we may establish a provision for
taxes if we determine, in our sole discretion, that we will incur a tax as a
result of the operation of the Separate Account. We will deduct for any taxes we
incur as a result of the operation of the Separate Account, whether or not we
previously made a provision for taxes and whether or not it was sufficient. Our
status under the Tax Code is briefly described in the Statement of Additional
Information.

OTHER EXPENSES. You indirectly bear the charges and expenses of the Portfolios
whose shares are held by the Subaccounts to which you allocate your Contract
Value. For a summary of current estimates of those charges and expenses, see
page 6. For more detailed information about those charges and expenses, please
refer to the prospectuses for the appropriate Portfolios. We may receive
compensation from the investment advisors or administrators of the Portfolios in
connection with administrative service and cost savings experienced by the
investment advisors or administrators.

                                  34 PROSPECTUS




TAXES

THE FOLLOWING DISCUSSION IS GENERAL AND IS NOT INTENDED AS TAX ADVICE. LINCOLN
BENEFIT MAKES NO GUARANTEE REGARDING THE TAX TREATMENT OF ANY CONTRACT OR
TRANSACTION INVOLVING A CONTRACT.

Federal, state, local and other tax consequences of ownership or receipt of
distributions under an annuity contract depend on your individual circumstances.
If you are concerned about any tax consequences with regard to your individual
circumstances, you should consult a competent tax adviser.

TAXATION OF LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE

COMPANY

Lincoln Benefit is taxed as a life insurance company under Part I of Subchapter
L of the Code. Since the Separate

Account is not an entity separate from Lincoln Benefit, and its operations form
a part of Lincoln Benefit, it will not be taxed separately. Investment income
and realized capital gains of the Separate Account are automatically applied to
increase reserves under the Contract. Under existing federal income tax law,
Lincoln Benefit believes that the Separate Account investment income and capital
gains will not be taxed to the extent that such income and gains are applied to
increase the reserves under the Contract. Accordingly, Lincoln Benefit does not
anticipate that it will incur any federal income tax liability attributable to
the Separate Account, and therefore Lincoln Benefit does not intend to make
provisions for any such taxes. If Lincoln Benefit is taxed on investment income
or capital gains of the Separate Account, then Lincoln Benefit may impose a
charge against the Separate

Account in order to make provision for such taxes.

TAXATION OF VARIABLE ANNUITIES IN GENERAL

TAX DEFERRAL. Generally, you are not taxed on increases in the Contract Value
until a distribution occurs. This rule applies only where:

..    the Contract Owner is a natural person,

..    the investments of the Separate Account are "adequately diversified"
     according to Treasury Department regulations, and

..    Lincoln Benefit is considered the owner of the Separate Account assets for
     federal income tax purposes.

NON-NATURAL OWNERS. Non-natural owners are also referred to as Non Living Owners
in this prospectus. As a general rule, annuity contracts owned by non-natural
persons such as corporations, trusts, or other entities are not treated as
annuity contracts for federal income tax purposes. The income on such contracts
does not enjoy tax deferral and is taxed as ordinary income received or accrued
by the non-natural owner during the taxable year.

EXCEPTIONS TO THE NON-NATURAL OWNER RULE. There are several exceptions to the
general rule that annuity contracts held by a non-natural owner are not treated
as annuity contracts for federal income tax purposes. Contracts will generally
be treated as held by a natural person if the nominal owner is a trust or other
entity which holds the contract as agent for a natural person. However, this
special exception will not apply in the case of an employer who is the nominal
owner of an annuity contract under a non-Qualified deferred compensation
arrangement for its employees. Other exceptions to the non-natural owner rule
are: (1) contracts acquired by an estate of a decedent by reason of the death of
the decedent; (2) certain qualified contracts; (3) contracts purchased by
employers upon the termination of certain qualified plans; (4) certain contracts
used in connection with structured settlement agreements; and (5) immediate
annuity contracts, purchased with a single premium, when the annuity starting
date is no later than a year from purchase of the annuity and substantially
equal periodic payments are made, not less frequently than annually, during the
annuity period.

GRANTOR TRUST OWNED ANNUITY. Contracts owned by a grantor trust are considered
owned by a non-natural owner. Grantor trust owned contracts receive tax deferral
as described in the Exceptions to the Non-Natural Owner Rule section. In
accordance with the Code, upon the death of the annuitant, the death benefit
must be paid. According to your Contract, the Death Benefit is paid to the
beneficiary. A trust named beneficiary, including a grantor trust, has two
options for receiving any death benefits: 1) a lump sum payment, or 2) payment
deferred up to five years from date of death.

DIVERSIFICATION REQUIREMENTS. For a Contract to be treated as an annuity for
federal income tax purposes, the investments in the Separate Account must be
"adequately diversified" consistent with standards under Treasury Department
regulations. If the investments in the Separate Account are not adequately
diversified, the Contract will not be treated as an annuity contract for federal
income tax purposes. As a result, the income on the Contract will be taxed as
ordinary income received or accrued by the Contract owner during the taxable
year. Although Lincoln Benefit does not have control over the Portfolios or
their investments, we expect the Portfolios to meet the diversification
requirements.

OWNERSHIP TREATMENT. The IRS has stated that a contract owner will be considered
the owner of separate account assets if he possesses incidents of ownership in
those assets, such as the ability to exercise investment control over the
assets. At the time the diversification regulations were issued, the Treasury
Department announced that the regulations do not provide guidance concerning
circumstances in which investor control of the separate account investments may
cause a Contract

                                  35 PROSPECTUS




owner to be treated as the owner of the separate account. The Treasury
Department also stated that future guidance would be issued regarding the extent
that owners could direct sub-account investments without being treated as owners
of the underlying assets of the separate account.

Your rights under the Contract are different than those described by the IRS in
private and published rulings in which it found that Contract owners were not
owners of separate account assets. For example, if your contract offers more
than twenty (20) investment alternatives you have the choice to allocate
premiums and contract values among a broader selection of investment
alternatives than described in such rulings. You may be able to transfer among
investment alternatives more frequently than in such rulings. These differences
could result in you being treated as the owner of the Separate Account. If this
occurs, income and gain from the Separate Account assets would be includible in
your gross income. Lincoln

Benefit does not know what standards will be set forth in any regulations or
rulings which the Treasury Department may issue. It is possible that future
standards announced by the Treasury Department could adversely affect the tax
treatment of your Contract. We reserve the right to modify the Contract as
necessary to attempt to prevent you from being considered the federal tax owner
of the assets of the Separate Account. However, we make no guarantee that such
modification to the Contract will be successful.

TAXATION OF PARTIAL AND FULL WITHDRAWALS. If you make a partial withdrawal under
a Non-Qualified Contract, amounts received are taxable to the extent the
Contract Value, without regard to surrender charges, exceeds the investment in
the Contract. The investment in the Contract is the gross premium paid for the
contract minus any amounts previously received from the Contract if such amounts
were properly excluded from your gross income. If you make a full withdrawal
under a Non-Qualified Contract, the amount received will be taxable only to the
extent it exceeds the investment in the Contract.

TAXATION OF ANNUITY PAYMENTS. Generally, the rule for income taxation of annuity
payments received from a Non-Qualified Contract provides for the return of your
investment in the Contract in equal tax-free amounts over the payment period.
The balance of each payment received is taxable. For fixed annuity payments, the
amount excluded from income is determined by multiplying the payment by the
ratio of the investment in the Contract (adjusted for any refund feature or
period certain) to the total expected value of annuity payments for the term of
the Contract. If you elect variable annuity payments, the amount excluded from
taxable income is determined by dividing the investment in the Contract by the
total number of expected payments. The annuity payments will be fully taxable
after the total amount of the investment in the Contract is excluded using these
ratios. If any variable payment is less than the excludable amount you should
contact a competent tax advisor to determine how to report any unrecovered
investment. The federal tax treatment of annuity payments is unclear in some
respects. As a result, if the IRS should provide further guidance, it is
possible that the amount we calculate and report to the IRS as taxable could be
different. If you die, and annuity payments cease before the total amount of the
investment in the Contract is recovered, the unrecovered amount will be allowed
as a deduction for your last taxable year.

TAXATION OF LEVEL MONTHLY VARIABLE ANNUITY PAYMENTS. You may have an option to
elect a variable income payment stream consisting of level monthly payments that
are recalculated annually. Although we will report your levelized payments to
the IRS in the year distributed, it is possible the IRS could determine that
receipt of the first monthly payout of each annual amount is constructive
receipt of the entire annual amount. If the IRS were to take this position, the
taxable amount of your levelized payments would be accelerated to the time of
the first monthly payout and reported in the tax year in which the first monthly
payout is received.

WITHDRAWALS AFTER THE PAYOUT START DATE. Federal tax law is unclear regarding
the taxation of any additional withdrawal received after the Payout Start Date.
It is possible that a greater or lesser portion of such a payment could be
taxable than the amount we determine.

DISTRIBUTION AT DEATH RULES. In order to be considered an annuity contract for
federal income tax purposes, the Contract must provide:

..    if any Contract Owner dies on or after the Payout Start Date but before the
     entire interest in the Contract has been distributed, the remaining portion
     of such interest must be distributed at least as rapidly as under the
     method of distribution being used as of the date of the Contract Owner's
     death;

..    if any Contract Owner dies prior to the Payout Start Date, the entire
     interest in the Contract will be distributed within 5 years after the date
     of the Contract Owner's death. These requirements are satisfied if any
     portion of the Contract Owner's interest that is payable to (or for the
     benefit of) a designated Beneficiary is distributed over the life of such
     Beneficiary (or over a period not extending beyond the life expectancy of
     the Beneficiary) and the distributions begin within 1 year of the Contract
     Owner's death. If the Contract Owner's designated Beneficiary is the
     surviving spouse of the Contract Owner, the Contract may be continued with
     the surviving spouse as the new Contract Owner.

..    if the Contract Owner is a non-natural person, then the Annuitant will be
     treated as the Contract Owner for purposes of applying the distribution at
     death rules. In addition, a change in the Annuitant on a Contract owned by
     a non-natural person will be treated as the death of the Contract Owner.

                                  36 PROSPECTUS




TAXATION OF ANNUITY DEATH BENEFITS. Death Benefit amounts are included in income
as follows:

..    if distributed in a lump sum, the amounts are taxed in the same manner as a
     full withdrawal, or

..    if distributed under an Income Plan, the amounts are taxed in the same
     manner as annuity payments.

PENALTY TAX ON PREMATURE DISTRIBUTIONS. A 10% penalty tax applies to the taxable
amount of any premature distribution from a non-Qualified Contract. The penalty
tax generally applies to any distribution made prior to the date you attain age
59 1/2. However, no penalty tax is incurred on distributions:

..    made on or after the date the Contract Owner attains age 59 1/2,

..    made as a result of the Contract Owner's death or becoming totally
     disabled,

..    made in substantially equal periodic payments over the Contract Owner's
     life or life expectancy, or over the joint lives or joint life expectancies
     of the Contract Owner and the Beneficiary,

..    made under an immediate annuity, or

..    attributable to investment in the Contract before August 14, 1982.

You should consult a competent tax advisor to determine how these exceptions may
apply to your situation.

SUBSTANTIALLY EQUAL PERIODIC PAYMENTS. With respect to non-Qualified Contracts
using substantially equal periodic payments or immediate annuity payments as an
exception to the penalty tax on premature distributions, any additional
withdrawal or other material modification of the payment stream would violate
the requirement that payments must be substantially equal. Failure to meet this
requirement would mean that the income portion of each payment received prior to
the later of 5 years or the Contract Owner's attaining age 59 1/2 would be
subject to a 10% penalty tax unless another exception to the penalty tax
applied. The tax for the year of the modification is increased by the penalty
tax that would have been imposed without the exception, plus interest for the
years in which the exception was used. A material modification does not include
permitted changes described in published IRS rulings. You should consult a
competent tax advisor prior to creating or modifying a substantially equal
periodic payment stream.

TAX FREE EXCHANGES UNDER INTERNAL REVENUE CODE SECTION 1035. A 1035 exchange is
a tax-free exchange of a non-qualified life insurance contract, endowment
contract or annuity contract into a non-Qualified annuity contract. The contract
owner(s) must be the same on the old and new contract. Basis from the old
contract carries over to the new contract so long as we receive that information
from the relinquishing company. If basis information is never received, we will
assume that all exchanged funds represent earnings and will allocate no cost
basis to them.

PARTIAL EXCHANGES. The IRS has issued a ruling that permits partial exchanges of
annuity contracts. Under this ruling, if you take a withdrawal from a receiving
or relinquishing annuity contract within 24 months of the partial exchange, then
special aggregation rules apply for purposes of determining the taxable amount
of a distribution. The IRS has issued limited guidance on how to aggregate and
report these distributions. The IRS is expected to provide further guidance, as
a result, it is possible that the amount we calculate and report to the IRS as
taxable could be different.

TAXATION OF OWNERSHIP CHANGES. If you transfer a non-Qualified Contract without
full and adequate consideration to a person other than your spouse (or to a
former spouse incident to a divorce), you will be taxed on the difference
between the Contract Value and the investment in the Contract at the time of
transfer. Any assignment or pledge (or agreement to assign or pledge) of the
Contract Value is taxed as a withdrawal of such amount or portion and may also
incur the 10% penalty tax.

AGGREGATION OF ANNUITY CONTRACTS. The Code requires that all non-Qualified
deferred annuity contracts issued by Lincoln Benefit (or its affiliates) to the
same Contract Owner during any calendar year be aggregated and treated as one
annuity contract for purposes of determining the taxable amount of a
distribution.

INCOME TAX WITHHOLDING

Generally, Lincoln Benefit is required to withhold federal income tax at a rate
of 10% from all non-annuitized distributions. The customer may elect out of
withholding by completing and signing a withholding election form. If no
election is made, we will automatically withhold the required 10% of the taxable
amount. In certain states, if there is federal withholding, then state
withholding is also mandatory.

Lincoln Benefit is required to withhold federal income tax using the wage
withholding rates for all annuitized distributions. The customer may elect out
of withholding by completing and signing a withholding election form. If no
election is made, we will automatically withhold using married with three
exemptions as the default. If no U.S. taxpayer identification number is
provided, we will automatically withhold using single with zero exemptions as
the default. In certain states, if there is federal withholding, then state
withholding is also mandatory.

Election out of withholding is valid only if the customer provides a U.S.
residence address and taxpayer identification number.

Generally, Section 1441 of the Code provides that Lincoln Benefit as a
withholding agent must withhold 30% of the taxable amounts paid to a
non-resident alien. A non-resident alien is someone other than a U.S. citizen or
resident alien. Withholding may be reduced or eliminated if covered by an income
tax treaty between the U.S. and the non-resident alien's country of residence if

                                  37 PROSPECTUS




the payee provides a U.S. taxpayer identification number on a completed Form
W-8BEN. A U.S. taxpayer identification number is a social security number or an
individual taxpayer identification number ("ITIN"). ITINs are issued by the IRS
to non-resident alien individuals who are not eligible to obtain a social
security number. The U.S. does not have a tax treaty with all countries nor do
all tax treaties provide an exclusion or lower withholding rate for annuities.

TAX QUALIFIED CONTRACTS

The income on tax sheltered annuity (TSA) and IRA investments is tax deferred,
and the income on variable annuities held by such plans does not receive any
additional tax deferral. You should review the annuity features, including all
benefits and expenses, prior to purchasing a variable annuity as a TSA or IRA.
Tax Qualified Contracts are contracts purchased as investments as:

..    Individual Retirement Annuities (IRAs) under Section 408(b) of the Code;

..    Roth IRAs under Section 408A of the Code;

..    Simplified Employee Pension (SEP IRA) under Section 408(k) of the Code;

..    Savings Incentive Match Plans for Employees (SIMPLE IRA) under Section
     408(p) of the Code; and

..    Tax Sheltered Annuities under Section 403(b) of the Code.

Lincoln Benefit reserves the right to limit the availability of the Contract for
use with any of the retirement plans listed above or to modify the Contract to
conform with tax requirements.

The tax rules applicable to participants with tax qualified annuities vary
according to the type of contract and the terms and conditions of the
endorsement. Adverse tax consequences may result from certain transactions such
as excess contributions, premature distributions, and, distributions that do not
conform to specified commencement and minimum distribution rules. Lincoln

Benefit can issue an individual retirement annuity on a rollover or transfer of
proceeds from a decedent's IRA, TSA, or employer sponsored retirement plan under
which the decedent's surviving spouse is the beneficiary. Lincoln Benefit does
not offer an individual retirement annuity that can accept a transfer of funds
for any other, non-spousal, beneficiary of a decedent's IRA, TSA, or employer
sponsored retirement plan.

In the case of certain qualified plans, the terms of the plans may govern the
right to benefits, regardless of the terms of the Contract.

TAXATION OF WITHDRAWALS FROM AN INDIVIDUALLY OWNED TAX QUALIFIED CONTRACT. If
you make a partial withdrawal under a Tax Qualified Contract other than a Roth
IRA, the portion of the payment that bears the same ratio to the total payment
that the investment in the Contract (i.e., nondeductible IRA contributions)
bears to the Contract Value, is excluded from your income. We do not keep track
of nondeductible contributions, and all tax reporting of distributions from Tax
Qualified Contracts other than Roth IRAs will indicate that the distribution is
fully taxable.

"Qualified distributions" from Roth IRAs are not included in gross income.
"Qualified distributions" are any distributions made more than five taxable
years after the taxable year of the first contribution to any Roth IRA and which
are:

..    made on or after the date the Contract Owner attains age 59 1/2,

..    made to a beneficiary after the Contract Owner's death,

..    attributable to the Contract Owner being disabled, or

..    made for a first time home purchase (first time home purchases are subject
     to a lifetime limit of $10,000).

"Nonqualified distributions" from Roth IRAs are treated as made from
contributions first and are included in gross income only to the extent that
distributions exceed contributions. All tax reporting of distributions from Roth
IRAs will indicate that the taxable amount is not determined.

REQUIRED MINIMUM DISTRIBUTIONS. Generally, IRAs (excluding Roth IRAs) and TSAs
require minimum distributions upon reaching age 70 1/2. Failure to withdraw the
required minimum distribution will result in a 50% tax penalty on the shortfall
not withdrawn from the Contract. Not all income plans offered under the Contract
satisfy the requirements for minimum distributions. Because these distributions
are required under the Code and the method of calculation is complex, please see
a competent tax advisor.

THE DEATH BENEFIT AND TAX QUALIFIED CONTRACTS. Pursuant to the Code and IRS
regulations, an IRA (e.g., traditional IRA, Roth IRA, SEP IRA and SIMPLE IRA)
may not invest in life insurance contracts. However, an IRA may provide a death
benefit that equals the greater of the purchase payments or the Contract Value.
The Contract offers a death benefit that in certain circumstances may exceed the
greater of the purchase payments or the Contract Value. We believe that the
Death Benefits offered by your Contract do not constitute life insurance under
these regulations.

It is also possible that certain death benefits that offer enhanced earnings
could be characterized as an incidental death benefit. If the death benefit were
so characterized, this could result in current taxable income to a Contract
Owner. In addition, there are limitations on the amount of incidental death
benefits that may be provided under qualified plans, such as in connection with
a 403(b) plan.

Lincoln Benefit reserves the right to limit the availability of the Contract for
use with any of the qualified plans listed above.

                                  38 PROSPECTUS




PENALTY TAX ON PREMATURE DISTRIBUTIONS FROM TAX QUALIFIED CONTRACTS. A 10%
penalty tax applies to the taxable amount of any premature distribution from a
Tax Qualified Contract. The penalty tax generally applies to any distribution
made prior to the date you attain age 59 1/2. However, no penalty tax is
incurred on distributions:

..    made on or after the date the Contract Owner attains age 59 1/2,

..    made as a result of the Contract Owner's death or total disability,

..    made in substantially equal periodic payments over the Contract Owner's
     life or life expectancy, or over the joint lives or joint life expectancies
     of the Contract Owner and the Beneficiary,

..    made after separation from service after age 55 (applies only for IRAs),

..    made pursuant to an IRS levy,

..    made for certain medical expenses,

..    made to pay for health insurance premiums while unemployed (applies only
     for IRAs),

..    made for qualified higher education expenses (applies only for IRAs), and

..    made for a first time home purchase (up to a $10,000 lifetime limit and
     applies only for IRAs).

During the first 2 years of the individual's participation in a SIMPLE IRA,
distributions that are otherwise subject to the premature distribution penalty,
will be subject to a 25% penalty tax.

You should consult a competent tax advisor to determine how these exceptions may
apply to your situation.

SUBSTANTIALLY EQUAL PERIODIC PAYMENTS ON TAX QUALIFIED CONTRACTS. With respect
to Tax Qualified Contracts using substantially equal periodic payments as an
exception to the penalty tax on premature distributions, any additional
withdrawal or other material modification of the payment stream would violate
the requirement that payments must be substantially equal. Failure to meet this
requirement would mean that the income portion of each payment received prior to
the later of 5 years or the taxpayer's attaining age 59 1/2 would be subject to
a 10% penalty tax unless another exception to the penalty tax applied. The tax
for the year of the modification is increased by the penalty tax that would have
been imposed without the exception, plus interest for the years in which the
exception was used. A material modification does not include permitted changes
described in published IRS rulings. You should consult a competent tax advisor
prior to creating or modifying a substantially equal periodic payment stream.

INCOME TAX WITHHOLDING ON TAX QUALIFIED CONTRACTS. Generally, Lincoln Benefit is
required to withhold federal income tax at a rate of 10% from all non-annuitized
distributions that are not considered "eligible rollover distributions." The
customer may elect out of withholding by completing and signing a withholding
election form. If no election is made, we will automatically withhold the
required 10% from the taxable amount. In certain states, if there is federal
withholding, then state withholding is also mandatory. Lincoln Benefit is
required to withhold federal income tax at a rate of 20% on all "eligible
rollover distributions" unless you elect to make a "direct rollover" of such
amounts to an IRA or eligible retirement plan. Eligible rollover distributions
generally include all distributions from employer sponsored retirement plans,
including TSAs but excluding IRAs, with the exception of:

..    required minimum distributions, or,

..    a series of substantially equal periodic payments made over a period of at
     least 10 years, or,

..    a series of substantially equal periodic payments made over the life (joint
     lives) of the participant (and beneficiary), or,

..    hardship distributions.

For all annuitized distributions that are not subject to the 20% withholding
requirement, Lincoln Benefit is required to withhold federal income tax using
the wage withholding rates. The customer may elect out of withholding by
completing and signing a withholding election form. If no election is made, we
will automatically withhold using married with three exemptions as the default.
If no U.S. taxpayer identification number is provided, we will automatically
withhold using single with zero exemptions as the default. In certain states, if
there is federal withholding, then state withholding is also mandatory.

Election out of withholding is valid only if the customer provides a U.S.
residence address and taxpayer identification number.

Generally, Section 1441 of the Code provides that Lincoln Benefit as a
withholding agent must withhold 30% of the taxable amounts paid to a
non-resident alien. A non-resident alien is someone other than a U.S. citizen or
resident alien. Withholding may be reduced or eliminated if covered by an income
tax treaty between the U.S. and the non-resident alien's country of residence if
the payee provides a U.S. taxpayer identification number on a completed Form
W-8BEN. A U.S. taxpayer identification number is a social security number or an
individual taxpayer identification number ("ITIN"). ITINs are issued by the IRS
to non-resident alien individuals who are not eligible to obtain a social
security number. The U.S. does not have a tax treaty with all countries nor do
all tax treaties provide an exclusion or lower withholding rate for annuities.

INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ANNUITIES. Section 408 of the Code permits eligible
individuals to contribute to an individual retirement program known as an
Individual Retirement Annuity (IRA). Individual Retirement Annuities are subject
to limitations on the amount that

                                  39 PROSPECTUS




can be contributed and on the time when distributions may commence. Certain
distributions from other types of qualified plans may be "rolled over" on a
tax-deferred basis into an Individual Retirement Annuity.

ROTH INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ANNUITIES. Section 408A of the Code permits eligible
individuals to make nondeductible contributions to an individual retirement
program known as a Roth Individual Retirement Annuity. Roth Individual
Retirement Annuities are subject to limitations on the amount that can be
contributed and on the time when distributions may commence.

Subject to certain limitations, a traditional Individual Retirement Account or
Annuity may be converted or "rolled over" to a Roth Individual Retirement
Annuity. The income portion of a conversion or rollover distribution is taxable
currently, but is exempted from the 10% penalty tax on premature distributions.

ANNUITIES HELD BY INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ACCOUNTS (COMMONLY KNOWN AS CUSTODIAL
IRAS)

Internal Revenue Code Section 408 permits a custodian or trustee of an
Individual Retirement Account to purchase an annuity as an investment of the
Individual Retirement Account. If an annuity is purchased inside of an
Individual Retirement Account, then the Annuitant must be the same person as the
beneficial owner of the Individual Retirement Account.

Generally, the death benefit of an annuity held in an Individual Retirement
Account must be paid upon the death of the Annuitant. However, in most states,
the Contract permits the custodian or trustee of the Individual Retirement
Account to continue the Contract in the accumulation phase, with the Annuitant's
surviving spouse as the new Annuitant, if the following conditions are met:

1)   The custodian or trustee of the Individual Retirement Account is the owner
     of the annuity and has the right to the death proceeds otherwise payable
     under the annuity contract;

2)   The deceased Annuitant was the beneficial owner of the Individual
     Retirement Account;

3)   We receive a complete request for settlement for the death of the
     Annuitant; and

4)   The custodian or trustee of the Individual Retirement Account provides us
     with a signed certification of the following:

(a)  The Annuitant's surviving spouse is the sole beneficiary of the Individual
     Retirement Account;

(b)  The Annuitant's surviving spouse has elected to continue the Individual
     Retirement Account as his or her own Individual Retirement Account; and

(c)  The custodian or trustee of the Individual Retirement Account has continued
     the Individual Retirement Account pursuant to the surviving spouse's
     election.

SIMPLIFIED EMPLOYEE PENSION IRA. Section 408(k) of the Code allows eligible
employers to establish simplified employee pension plans for their employees
using individual retirement annuities. These employers may, within specified
limits, make deductible contributions on behalf of the employees to the
individual retirement annuities. Employers intending to use the Contract in
connection with such plans should seek competent tax advice.

SAVINGS INCENTIVE MATCH PLANS FOR EMPLOYEES (SIMPLE IRA). Section 408(p) of the
Code allow eligible employers with 100 or fewer employees to establish SIMPLE
retirement plans for their employees using individual retirement annuities. In
general, a SIMPLE IRA consists of a salary deferral program for eligible
employees and matching or nonelective contributions made by employers. Employers
intending to purchase the Contract as a SIMPLE IRA should seek competent tax and
legal advice.

TO DETERMINE IF YOU ARE ELIGIBLE TO CONTRIBUTE TO ANY OF THE ABOVE LISTED IRAS
(TRADITIONAL, ROTH, SEP, OR SIMPLE), PLEASE REFER TO IRS PUBLICATION 590 AND
YOUR COMPETENT TAX ADVISOR.

TAX SHELTERED ANNUITIES. Section 403(b) of the Code provides tax-deferred
retirement savings plans for employees of certain non-profit and educational
organizations. Under Section 403(b), any contract used for a 403(b) plan must
provide that distributions attributable to salary reduction contributions made
after 12/31/88, and all earnings on salary reduction contributions, may be made
only on or after the date the employee:

..    attains age 59 1/2,

..    severs employment,

..    dies,

..    becomes disabled, or

..    incurs a hardship (earnings on salary reduction contributions may not be
     distributed on account of hardship).

These limitations do not apply to withdrawals where Lincoln Benefit is directed
to transfer some or all of the Contract Value to another 403(b) plan. Generally,
we do not accept Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 (ERISA) funds
in 403(b) contracts.

                                  40 PROSPECTUS




DESCRIPTION OF LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY AND THE SEPARATE ACCOUNT

LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY. Lincoln Benefit Life Company is a stock life
insurance company organized under the laws of the state of Nebraska in 1938. Our
legal domicile and principal business address is 2940 South 84th Street,
Lincoln, Nebraska, 68506-4142. Lincoln Benefit is a wholly owned subsidiary of
Allstate Life Insurance Company ("Allstate Life"), a stock life insurance
company incorporated under the laws of the State of Illinois. Allstate Life is a
wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate Insurance Company ("AIC"), a stock
property-liability insurance company incorporated under the laws of Illinois.
All outstanding capital stock of AIC is owned by The Allstate Corporation
("Allstate").

We are authorized to conduct life insurance and annuity business in the District
of Columbia, Guam, U.S. Virgin Islands and all states except New York. We intend
to market the Contract everywhere we conduct variable annuity business. The
Contracts offered by this prospectus are issued by us and will be funded in the
Separate Account and/or the Fixed Account.

Under our reinsurance agreements with Allstate Life, substantially all contract
related transactions are transferred to Allstate Life and substantially all of
the assets backing our reinsured liabilities are owned by Allstate Life. These
assets represent our general account and are invested and managed by Allstate
Life. Accordingly, the results of operations with respect to applications
received and contracts issued by Lincoln Benefit are not reflected in our
financial statements. The amounts reflected in our financial statements relate
only to the investment of those assets of Lincoln Benefit that are not
transferred to Allstate Life under the reinsurance agreements. While the
reinsurance agreements provide us with financial backing from Allstate Life, it
does not create a direct contractual relationship between Allstate Life and you.

Under the Company's reinsurance agreements with Allstate Life, the Company
reinsures all reserve liabilities with Allstate Life except for variable
contracts. The Company's variable contract assets and liabilities are held in
legally-segregated, unitized Separate Accounts and are retained by the Company.
However, Lincoln Benefit's economic risks and returns related to such variable
contracts are transferred to Allstate Life.

SEPARATE ACCOUNT. Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account was originally
established in 1992, as a segregated asset account of Lincoln Benefit. The
Separate Account meets the definition of a "separate account" under the federal
securities laws and is registered with the SEC as a unit investment trust under
the Investment Company Act of 1940. The SEC does not supervise the management of
the Separate Account or Lincoln Benefit.

We own the assets of the Separate Account, but we hold them separate from our
other assets. To the extent that these assets are attributable to the Contract
Value of the Contracts offered by this prospectus, these assets are not
chargeable with liabilities arising out of any other business we may conduct.
Income, gains, and losses, whether or not realized, from assets allocated to the
Separate Account are credited to or charged against the Separate Account without
regard to our other income, gains, or losses. Our obligations arising under the
Contracts are general corporate obligations of Lincoln Benefit.

The Separate Account is divided into Subaccounts. The assets of each Subaccount
are invested in the shares of one of the Portfolios. We do not guarantee the
investment performance of the Separate Account, its Subaccounts or the
Portfolios. Values allocated to the Separate Account and the amount of Variable
Annuity payments will rise and fall with the values of shares of the Portfolios
and are also reduced by Contract charges. We may also use the Separate Account
to fund our other annuity contracts. We will account separately for each type of
annuity contract funded by the Separate Account.

We have included additional information about the Separate Account in the
Statement of Additional Information. You may obtain a copy of the Statement of
Additional Information by writing to us or calling us at 1-800-865-5237. We have
reproduced the Table of Contents of the Statement of Additional Information on
44.

STATE REGULATION OF LINCOLN BENEFIT. We are subject to the laws of Nebraska and
regulated by the Nebraska Department of Insurance. Every year we file an annual
statement with the Department of Insurance covering our operations for the
previous year and our financial condition as of the end of the year. We are
inspected periodically by the Department of Insurance to verify our contract
liabilities and reserves. Our books and records are subject to review by the
Department of Insurance at all times. We are also subject to regulation under
the insurance laws of every jurisdiction in which we operate.

ADMINISTRATION

We have primary responsibility for all administration of the Contracts and the
Separate Account. Our mailing address is P.O. Box 80469, Lincoln, Nebraska
68501-0469.

                                  41 PROSPECTUS




We provide the following administrative services, among others: issuance of the
Contracts; maintenance of Contract Owner records; Contract Owner services;
calculation of unit values; maintenance of the Separate Account; and preparation
of Contract Owner reports.

We will send you Contract statements and transaction confirmations at least
quarterly. You should notify us promptly in writing of any address change. You
should read your statements and confirmations carefully and verify their
accuracy. You should contact us promptly if you have a question about a periodic
statement. We will investigate all complaints and make any necessary adjustments
retroactively, but you must notify us of a potential error within a reasonable
time after the date of the questioned statement. If you wait too long, we will
make the adjustment as of the date that we receive notice of the potential
error.

We will also provide you with additional periodic and other reports, information
and prospectuses as may be required by federal securities laws.

DISTRIBUTION OF CONTRACTS

The Contracts described in this prospectus are sold by registered
representatives of broker-dealers who are our licensed insurance agents, either
individually or through an incorporated insurance agency. Commissions paid to
broker-dealers may vary, but we estimate that the total commissions paid on all
Contract sales will not exceed 5.5% of all Purchase Payments (on a present value
basis). From time to time, we may offer additional sales incentives of up to 1%
of Purchase Payments and other cash bonuses to broker-dealers who maintain
certain sales volume levels. ALFS, Inc. ("ALFS") located at 3100 Sanders Road,
Northbrook, IL 60062-7154 serves as distributor of the Contracts. ALFS, an
affiliate of Lincoln Benefit, is a wholly owned subsidiary of Allstate Life
Insurance Company. ALFS is a registered broker dealer under the Securities and
Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and is a member of the National Association of
Securities Dealers, Inc. Lincoln Benefit does not pay ALFS a commission for
distribution of the Contracts. The underwriting agreement with ALFS provides
that we will reimburse ALFS for expenses incurred in distributing the Contracts,
including liability arising out of services we provide on the Contracts.

LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

There are no pending legal proceedings affecting the Separate Account. Lincoln
Benefit is engaged in routine lawsuits which, in our management's judgment, are
not of material importance to their respective total assets or material with
respect to the Separate Account.

LEGAL MATTERS

All matters of Nebraska law pertaining to the Contract, including the validity
of the Contract and our right to issue the Contract under Nebraska law, have
been passed upon by William F. Emmons, Vice President, Assistant General
Counsel, and Assistant Secretary of Lincoln Benefit.

ANNUAL REPORTS AND OTHER DOCUMENTS

Lincoln Benefit's annual report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31,
2003, is incorporated herein by reference, which means that it is legally a part
of this prospectus.

After the date of this prospectus and before we terminate the offering of the
securities under this prospectus, all documents or reports we file with the SEC
under the Exchange Act of 1934 are also incorporated herein by reference, which
means that they also legally become a part of this prospectus.

Statements in this prospectus, or in documents that we file later with the SEC
and that legally become a part of this prospectus, may change or supersede
statement in other documents that are legally part of this prospectus.

We file our Exchange Act documents and reports, including our annual and
quarterly reports on Form 10-K and Form 10-Q electronically on the SEC's "EDGAR"
system using the identifying number CIK No. 0000910739. The SEC maintains a Web
site that contains reports, proxy and information statements and other
information regarding registrants that file electronically with the SEC. The
address of the site is http:// www.sec.gov. You also can view these materials at
the SEC's Public Reference Room at 450 Fifth Street, N.W., Washington, D.C.
20549. For more information on the operations of SEC's Public Reference Room,
call 1-800-SEC-0330.

If you have received a copy of this prospectus, and would like a free copy of
any document incorporated herein by

                                  42 PROSPECTUS




reference (other than exhibits not specifically incorporated by reference into
the text of such documents), please write or call us at Lincoln Benefit Life
Company, P.O. Box 80469, Lincoln, Nebraska 68501-0469 or 1-800-865-5237.

REGISTRATION STATEMENT

We have filed a registration statement with the SEC, under the Securities Act of
1933 as amended, with respect to the Contracts offered by this prospectus. This
prospectus does not contain all the information set forth in the registration
statement and the exhibits filed as part of the registration statement. You
should refer to the registration statement and the exhibits for further
information concerning the Separate Account, Lincoln Benefit, and the Contracts.
The descriptions in this prospectus of the Contracts and other legal instruments
are summaries. You should refer to those instruments as filed for the precise
terms of those instruments. You may inspect and obtain copies of the
registration statement as described on the cover page of this prospectus.

                                  43 PROSPECTUS




STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                      PAGE

THE CONTRACT

                                Annuity Payments

                         Initial Monthly Annuity Payment

                           Subsequent Monthly Payments

                          Transfers After Annuity Date

                               Annuity Unit Value

                                      PAGE

             Illustrative Example of Annuity Unit Value Calculation

                Illustrative Example of Variable Annuity Payments

EXPERTS

FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

                                  44 PROSPECTUS




APPENDIX A

                         ACCUMULATION UNIT VALUES /(1)/

                                  BASIC POLICY

                                       Year ending December 31,
                          ---------------------------------------------------
FUND                       1999      2000      2001       2002        2003
-----------------------------------------------------------------------------
AIM V.I. Basic Value
Fund (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --          --
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --          --
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --          --
 Year
Alger American Growth
Portfolio (5)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --  $    10.00
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --  $   12.358
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --      54,381
 Year
Fidelity VIP Growth
Portfolio (5)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --  $    10.00
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --  $   12.458
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --     111,685
 Year
Fidelity VIP Investment
Grade Bond (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $   10.721
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $   10.721  $   11.094
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --     178,620     645,218
 Year
Fidelity VIP Overseas
(4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.724
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.724  $   10.895
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --       3,650      40,658
 Year
Goldman Sachs VIT
International Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  12.29  $  10.52  $     8.07  $    6.495
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 12.29  $  10.52  $   8.07  $    6.495  $    8.678
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     22,152   159,917   114,948     254,616     287,318
 Year
Goldman Sachs VIT CORE
Small Cap Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  12.19  $  12.23  $    12.61  $   10.573
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 12.19  $  12.23  $  12.61  $   10.573  $   15.223
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     32,499    94,926   230,893     127,061     199,375
 Year
Janus Aspen Series
Capital Appreciation (7)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --          --
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --          --
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --          --
 Year
Janus Aspen Series
Foreign Stock (4) (8)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.755
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.755  $   10.200
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      10,251      32,987
 Year
Janus Aspen Series
Worldwide Growth (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.806
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.806  $    9.520
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      13,094      51,204
 Year
JPMorgan Small Company
(2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  14.01  $  12.25  $    11.11  $    8.582
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 14.01  $  12.25  $  11.11  $    8.582  $   11.508
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     42,567   135,018   148,118     229,162     235,165
 Year
Lazard Emerging Markets
(2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  13.27  $   9.41  $     8.81  $    8.555
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 13.27  $   9.41  $   8.81  $    8.555  $   12.903
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     11,803    34,832    51,868      78,720     112,391
 Year
Lazard International
Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  11.25  $  10.02  $     7.50  $    6.607
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 11.25  $  10.02  $   7.50  $    6.607  $    8.374
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     27,207    79,805   118,331     162,113     148,319
 Year
LSA Aggressive Growth
(4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.299
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.299  $    9.982
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      10,154      73,878
 Year
LSA Balanced (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.40  $  11.17  $    11.26  $    9.073
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.40  $  11.17  $  11.26  $    9.073  $   11.561
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of        386   124,389   266,745     514,929     685,220
 Year
LSA Basic Value (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.638
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.638  $   10.049
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      63,427     353,241
 Year
LSA Blue Chip (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.975
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.975  $    9.848
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      24,337     260,606
 Year
LSA Capital Appreciation
(4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    8.163
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    8.163  $   10.491
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      14,015      73,575
 Year
LSA Capital Growth (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  12.22  $  11.03  $     9.33  $    6.910
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 12.22  $  11.03  $   9.33  $    6.910  $    8.472
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of      3,394   142,502   226,920     226,041     330,980
 Year
LSA Diversified Mid Cap
(4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.783
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.783  $   10.192
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      26,268     172,288
 Year
LSA Emerging Growth
Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  17.48  $  12.04  $     9.75  $    5.589
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 17.48  $  12.04  $   9.75  $    5.589  $    8.098
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     16,191   131,445   150,128     161,610     207,970
 Year
LSA Equity Growth (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  12.49  $  10.86  $     9.05  $    6.224
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 12.49  $  10.86  $   9.05  $    6.224  $    7.627
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     34,228   160,257   240,525      85,390     619,195
 Year
LSA Mid Cap Value (10)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                                                         $    8.437
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                                                            $   11.629
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of                                                165,206
 Year
LSA Value Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  11.03  $  12.55  $    11.77  $    9.035
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 11.03  $  12.55  $  11.77  $    9.035  $   11.622
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         32   122,654   235,535     428,181     484,234
 Year
MFS New Discovery (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.473
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.473  $    9.833
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      20,998     103,156
 Year
MFS Utilities (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    8.370
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    8.370  $   11.189
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      13,969      71,175
 Year
Oppenheimer Main Street
Small Cap (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    7.839
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    7.839  $   11.151
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      28,379     251,859
 Year
PAVIT OpCap Balanced (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --          --
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --          --
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --          --
 Year
PAVIT OpCap Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.62  $  11.51  $    10.56  $    8.180
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.62  $  11.51  $  10.56  $    8.180  $   10.371
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of          0    58,987   110,288     195,029     295,226
 Year
PAVIT OpCap Small Cap
(2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.65  $  15.15  $    16.18  $   12.502
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.65  $  15.15  $  16.18  $   12.502  $   17.586
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of          0    49,685    75,521     140,778     232,549
 Year
PAVIT PEA Science and
Technology (3)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --  $  10.00  $     3.36  $    1.803
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --  $   3.36  $    1.803  $    2.903
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --    59,395     160,966   1,167,164
 Year
PIMCO VIT Foreign Bond
(U.S. Dollar-Hedged) (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.29  $  10.99  $    11.66  $   12.443
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.29  $  10.99  $  11.66  $   12.443  $   12.547
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     17,747    30,068    49,293      93,732     218,507
 Year
PIMCO VIT Money Market
(2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.07  $  10.54  $    10.79  $   10.786
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.07  $  10.54  $  10.79  $   10.786  $   10.713
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     45,777   307,495   918,122   1,311,411   1,069,740
 Year
PIMCO VIT StocksPLUS
Growth and Income (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  11.64  $  10.39  $     9.07  $    7.139
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 11.64  $  10.39  $   9.07  $    7.139  $    9.179
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         21    97,992   171,296     335,810     444,281
 Year
PIMCO VIT Total Return
Bond (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.13  $  11.01  $    11.77  $   12.656
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.13  $  11.01  $  11.77  $   12.656  $   13.109
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     54,509   181,857   356,786     916,788   1,387,841
 Year
Putnam VT High Yield (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    9.568
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    9.568  $   11.939
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      14,843     151,285
 Year
Rydex VT OTC (3)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --  $  10.00  $     5.75  $    3.470
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --  $   5.75  $    3.470  $    4.976
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --     7,617      73,139     169,077
 Year
Salomon Brothers
Variable All Cap (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  11.54  $  13.45  $    13.51  $    9.987
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 11.54  $  13.45  $  13.51  $    9.987  $   13.693
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     49,256   141,167   260,699     321,536     374,930
 Year
Salomon Brothers
Variable Investors (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --          --
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --          --
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --          --
 Year
Van Kampen UIF Equity
Growth (2) (9)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --          --
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --          --
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --          --
 Year
Van Kampen UIF High
Yield (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  10.37  $   9.14  $     8.61  $    7.872
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 10.37  $   9.14  $   8.61  $    7.872  $    9.759
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of     17,868    68,958    94,964     148,434     259,819
 Year
Van Kampen UIF. Mid Cap
Growth (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  13.80  $  12.61  $     8.79  $    5.967
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 13.80  $  12.61  $   8.79  $    5.967  $    8.341
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of        409   170,775   213,956     302,409     426,417
 Year
Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid
Cap Value (10)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                $ 10.00  $  12.06  $  13.17  $    12.57  $    8.924
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                   $ 12.06  $  13.17  $  12.57  $    8.924  $   12.453
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of          0    85,226   189,874     301,924     324,553
 Year
Van Kampen LIT
Aggressive Growth (11)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --          --          --
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --          --          --
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --          --          --
 Year
Van Kampen LIT Growth
and Income (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Beginning                     --        --        --  $    10.00  $    8.155
 Accumulation Unit Value
 Ending                        --        --        --  $    8.155  $   10.267
 Number of Units
 Outstanding at End of         --        --        --      58,636     266,307
 Year

(1)  Accumulation Unit Value: unit of measure used to calculate the value of a
     Contract Owner's interest in a Subaccount for any Valuation Period. An
     Accumulation Unit Value does not reflect deduction of certain charges under
     the Contract that are deducted from your Contract Value, such as the
     Administrative Expense Charge. The beginning value reflects the
     Accumulation Unit Value as of October 18, 1999, the date Lincoln Benefit
     started to offer the Contract.

(2)  First offered 10/18/1999.

(3)  First offered 1/17/2001.

(4)  First offered 5/1/2002.

(5)  First offered 5/1/03.(6) Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Balance Fund, LSA Basic
     Value Fund and LSA Value Equity Fund were merged into the PAVIT OpCap
     Balanced Portfolio, AIM V.I. Basic Value Fund - Series I and Salomon
     Brothers Variable Investors Fund - Class I, respectively. Accordingly, on
     4/30/04, we transferred the value of the LSA Balanced Variable Sub-Account
     and the LSA Value Equity Variable Sub-Account to the PAVIT OpCap Balanced
     Variable Sub-Account, AIM V.I. Basic Value Variable Sub-Account and the
     Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Variable Sub-Account, respectively.

(6)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Balance Fund, LSA Basic Value Fund and LSA Value
     Equity Fund were merged into the PAVIT OpCap Balanced Portfolio, AIM V.I.
     Basic Value Fund - Series I and Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Fund -
     Class I, respectively. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of
     the LSA Balanced Variable Sub-Account and the LSA Value Equity Variable
     Sub-Account to the PAVIT OpCap Balanced Variable Sub-Account, AIM V.I.
     Basic Value Variable Sub-Account and the Salomon Brothers Variable
     Investors Variable Sub-Account, respectively.

(7)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Capital Appreciation Fund was merged into the
     Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation Portfolio - Institutional Shares.
     Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of the LSA Capital
     Appreciation Variable Sub-Account to the Janus Aspen Serioed Capital
     Appreciation Variable Sub-Account.

(8)  Effective 5/1/04 the Janus Aspen Series International Portfolio - Service
     Shares changed its name to the Janus Aspen Foreign Stock Portfolio -
     Service Shares. We have made a corresponding change in the name of the
     Variable Sub-Account that invests in this Portfolio.

(9)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Blue Chip Fund, LSA Equity Growth Fund and LSA
     Capital Growth Fund were merged into the Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth
     Portfolio, Class I. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of
     the LSA Blue Chip Variable Sub-Account, LSA Equity Growth Variable
     Sub-Account and LSA Capital Growth Variable Sub-Account to the Van Kampen
     UIF Equity Growth Variable Sub-Account.

(10) Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Diversified Mid-Cap Growth Fund and LSA MidCap
     Value Fund were merged into the Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value
     Portfolio, Class I. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of
     the LSA Diversified Mid-Cap Growth Variable Sub-Account and the LSA MidCap
     Value Variable Sub-Account to the Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value
     Variable Sub-Account.

(11) Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Aggressive Growth Fund and LSA Emerging Growth
     Fund were merged into the Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Portfolio, Class
     II. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of the LSA Aggressive
     Growth Variable Sub-Account and the LSA Emerging Growth Variable
     Sub-Account to the Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Variable Sub-Account.

A brief explanation of how performance of the Subaccounts is calculated may be
found in the Statement of Additional Information.

                                  48 PROSPECTUS




                            ACCUMULATION UNIT VALUES

                 BASIC POLICY PLUS ENHANCED DEATH BENEFIT RIDER



                                                            Year ending December 31,
                                              ---------------------------------------------------
FUND                                           1999       2000       2001       2002       2003
------------------------------------------------------ ------------------------------------------
                                                                          
AIM Basic Value (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --         --
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --         --
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --         --
Alger American Growth (5)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --   $  10.00
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --   $ 12.341
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --     30,627
Fidelity VIP Growth Portfolio (5)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --   $  10.00
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --   $ 12.441
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --     71,284
Fidelity VIP Investment Grade Bond (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $ 10.706
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $ 10.706   $ 11.057
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     84,421    275,877
Fidelity VIP Overseas (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.714
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.714   $ 10.858
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      8,812     22,038
Goldman Sachs VIT International Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  12.29   $  10.50   $   8.03   $  6.453
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 12.29   $  10.50   $   8.03   $  6.453   $  8.605
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     5,621     78,931    112,245    114,893    135,685
Goldman Sachs VIT CORE Small Cap Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  12.19   $  12.20   $  12.55   $ 10.505
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 12.19   $  12.20   $  12.55   $ 10.505   $ 15.095
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     3,604     24,178     35,125     59,592    108,325
Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation (7)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --         --
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --         --
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --         --
Janus Aspen Series Foreign Stock (4) (8)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.744
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.744   $ 10.166
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      6,035     20,593
Janus Aspen Series Worldwide Growth (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.795
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.795   $  9.488
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     13,160     39,364
JPMorgan Small Company (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  14.00   $  12.22   $  11.06   $  8.527
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 14.00   $  12.22   $  11.06   $  8.527   $ 11.412
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year         0     53,597     58,437     83,459    115,268
Lazard Emerging Markets (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  13.26   $   9.39   $   8.77   $  8.501
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 13.26   $   9.39   $   8.77   $  8.501   $ 12.795
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     2,809     25,988     32,552     51,013     81,410
Lazard International Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  11.24   $  10.00   $   7.47   $  6.565
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 11.24   $  10.00   $   7.47   $  6.565   $  8.304
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     4,064     50,850     71,754     73,992     82,929
LSA Aggressive Growth (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.289
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.289   $  9.949
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      5,753     41,947
LSA Balanced (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  10.40   $  11.14   $  11.21   $  9.015
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 10.40   $  11.14   $  11.21   $  9.015   $ 11.464
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     7,126     69,393    144,623    221,913    419,279
LSA Basic Value (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.627
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.627   $ 10.015
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     30,010    144,113
LSA Blue Chip (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.964
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.964   $  9.816
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      9,727    122,223
LSA Capital Appreciation (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  8.152
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  8.152   $ 10.456
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      4,462     52,459
LSA Diversified Mid Cap (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.772
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.772   $ 10.158
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      7,362     76,253
LSA Emerging Growth Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  17.47   $  12.01   $   9.71   $  5.553
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 17.47   $  12.01   $   9.71   $  5.553   $  8.030
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     5,259     86,819     94,558     98,810    110,592
LSA Equity Growth (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  12.48   $  10.83   $   9.01   $  6.224
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 12.48   $  10.83   $   9.01   $  6.224   $  7.563
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     8,359     54,291     90,631     85,390   $243,908
LSA Capital Growth(2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  12.21   $  11.00   $   9.28   $  6.910
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 12.21   $  11.00   $   9.28   $  6.910   $  8.401
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year    24,902    123,406    172,729    226,041    268,165
LSA Mid Cap Value (10)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                                                       $  8.246
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                                                          $ 11.591
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year                                               107,129
LSA Value Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  8.978
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  8.426   $ 11.525
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     25,180    234,745
MFS New Discovery (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  11.03   $  12.52   $  11.72   $  8.978
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 11.03   $  12.52   $  11.72   $  8.978   $  9.800
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year    17,183     62,043    130,669    179,820     46,541
MFS Utilities (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.463
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.463   $ 11.152
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     10,193     37,809
PAVIT OpCap Balanced (2) (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --         --
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --         --
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --         --
PAVIT OpCap Equity (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  8.359
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  8.359   $ 10.284
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      6,880    158,681
PAVIT PEA Science and Technology (3)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  10.62   $  11.49   $  10.51   $  8.128
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 10.62   $  11.49   $  10.51   $  8.128   $ 10.284
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     5,784     61,655     97,863    115,950    158,681
PAVIT OpCap Small Cap (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --   $  10.00   $   3.62   $  1.796
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --   $   3.62   $  1.796   $ 17.439
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --     14,533     63,153    137,092
Oppenheimer Main Street Small Cap (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  10.65   $  15.11   $  16.11   $ 12.422
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 10.65   $  15.11   $  16.11   $ 12.422   $ 11.113
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year         0     16,703     43,783     74,972    108,430
PIMCO VIT Foreign Bond (U.S. Dollar-Hedged)
(2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  7.829
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  7.829
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     27,890
PIMCO VIT Money Market (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  10.28   $  10.97   $  11.61   $ 12.364
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 10.28   $  10.97   $  11.61   $ 12.364
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year         0      1,231      3,605     27,152
PIMCO VIT StocksPLUS Growth and Income (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  10.07   $  10.51   $  10.74   $ 10.717
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 10.07   $  10.51   $  10.74   $ 10.717
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year    10,350    104,093    239,107    467,548
PIMCO VIT Total Return Bond (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  11.64   $  10.37   $   9.03   $  7.094
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 11.64   $  10.37   $   9.03   $  7.094
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year    12,776     82,128    112,333    161,698
Putnam VT High Yield (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  10.13   $  10.98   $  11.71   $ 12.575
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 10.13   $  10.98   $  11.71   $ 12.575
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year       224     57,774    148,500    491,013
Rydex VT OTC (3)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  9.555
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  9.555
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --      6,438
Salomon Brothers Variable All Cap (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --   $  10.00   $   5.74      3.457
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --   $   5.74      3.457
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --     14,044     83,805
Salomon Brothers Variable Investors (6)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --         --
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --         --
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --         --
Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth (2) (9)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --         --
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --         --
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --         --
Van Kampen UIF High Yield (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  11.53   $  13.42   $  13.46   $  7.822
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 11.53   $  13.42   $  13.46   $  7.822
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year         0     64,958    121,931     60,785
Van Kampen UIF Mid Cap Growth (2)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  13.80   $  12.58   $   8.75   $  5.929
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 13.80   $  12.58   $   8.75   $  5.929
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     6,216     87,781    123,258    135,098
Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value (2) (10)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning            $ 10.00   $  12.05   $  13.14   $  12.52   $  8.867
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending               $ 12.05   $  13.14   $  12.52   $  8.867
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year     6,021     44,148     95,312    151,383
Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth (11)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --         --         --
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --         --         --
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --         --         --
Van Kampen LIT Growth and Income (4)
 Accumulation Unit Value Beginning                 --         --         --   $  10.00   $  8.144
 Accumulation Unit Value Ending                    --         --         --   $  8.144
 Number of Units Outstanding at End of Year        --         --         --     26,840


(1)  Accumulation Unit Value: unit of measure used to calculate the value of a
     Contract Owner's interest in a Subaccount for any Valuation Period. An
     Accumulation Unit Value does not reflect deduction of certain charges under
     the Contract that are deducted from your Contract Value, such as the
     Administrative Expense Charge.

(2)  First offered 10/18/1999.

(3)  First offered 1/17/2001.

(4)  First offered 5/1/2002.

(5)  First offered 5/1/03.(6) Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Balance Fund, LSA Basic
     Value Fund and LSA Value Equity Fund were merged into the PAVIT OpCap
     Balanced Portfolio, AIM V.I. Basic Value Fund - Series I and Salomon
     Brothers Variable Investors Fund - Class I, respectively. Accordingly, on
     4/30/04, we transferred the value of the LSA Balanced Variable Sub-Account
     and the LSA Value Equity Variable Sub-Account to the PAVIT OpCap Balanced
     Variable Sub-Account, AIM V.I. Basic Value Variable Sub-Account and the
     Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Variable Sub-Account, respectively.

(6)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Balance Fund, LSA Basic Value Fund and LSA Value
     Equity Fund were merged into the PAVIT OpCap Balanced Portfolio, AIM V.I.
     Basic Value Fund - Series I and Salomon Brothers Variable Investors Fund -
     Class I, respectively. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of
     the LSA Balanced Variable Sub-Account and the LSA Value Equity Variable
     Sub-Account to the PAVIT OpCap Balanced Variable Sub-Account, AIM V.I.
     Basic Value Variable Sub-Account and the Salomon Brothers Variable
     Investors Variable Sub-Account, respectively.

(7)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Capital Appreciation Fund was merged into the
     Janus Aspen Series Capital Appreciation Portfolio - Institutional Shares.
     Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of the LSA Capital
     Appreciation Variable Sub-Account to the Janus Aspen Serioed Capital
     Appreciation Variable Sub-Account.

(8)  Effective 5/1/04 the Janus Aspen Series International Portfolio - Service
     Shares changed its name to the Janus Aspen Foreign Stock Portfolio -
     Service Shares. We have made a corresponding change in the name of the
     Variable Sub-Account that invests in this Portfolio.

(9)  Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Blue Chip Fund, LSA Equity Growth Fund and LSA
     Capital Growth Fund were merged into the Van Kampen UIF Equity Growth
     Portfolio, Class I. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of
     the LSA Blue Chip Variable Sub-Account, LSA Equity Growth Variable
     Sub-Account and LSA Capital Growth Variable Sub-Account to the Van Kampen
     UIF Equity Growth Variable Sub-Account.

(10) Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Diversified Mid-Cap Growth Fund and LSA MidCap
     Value Fund were merged into the Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value
     Portfolio, Class I. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of
     the LSA Diversified Mid-Cap Growth Variable Sub-Account and the LSA MidCap
     Value Variable Sub-Account to the Van Kampen UIF U.S. Mid Cap Value
     Variable Sub-Account.

(11) Effective 4/30/04, the LSA Aggressive Growth Fund and LSA Emerging Growth
     Fund were merged into the Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Portfolio, Class
     II. Accordingly, on 4/30/04, we transferred the value of the LSA Aggressive
     Growth Variable Sub-Account and the LSA Emerging Growth Variable
     Sub-Account to the Van Kampen LIT Aggressive Growth Variable Sub-Account.

A brief explanation of how performance of the Subaccounts is calculated may be
found in the Statement of Additional Information.

                                  52 PROSPECTUS




APPENDIX B

                    ILLUSTRATION OF A MARKET VALUE ADJUSTMENT

Purchase Payment:                          $ 40,000.00
Credit Enhancement:                        1,600.00
Guarantee Period:                          5 Years
Guaranteed Interest Rate:                  5% Annual Effective Rate
5-year Treasury Rate at Time of Purchase
Payment:                                   6%

The following examples illustrate how the Market Value Adjustment and the
Withdrawal Charge may affect the values of a Contract upon a withdrawal. The 5%
assumed Guaranteed Interest Rate is the rate required to be used in the "Summary
of Expenses." In these examples, the withdrawal occurs one year after (in the
second Contract Year) the Issue Date. The Market Value Adjustment operates in a
similar manner for transfers, except that there is no free amount for transfers.
No Withdrawal Charge applies to transfers.

Assuming that the entire $40,000.00 Purchase Payment and $1,600.00 Credit
Enhancement are allocated to the Guaranteed Maturity Fixed Account for the
Guarantee Period specified above, at the end of the five-year Guarantee Period
the Contract Value would be $53,093.31. After one year, when the withdrawals
occur in these examples, the Contract Value would be $43,680.00. We have assumed
that no prior partial withdrawals or transfers have occurred.

The Market Value Adjustment and the Withdrawal Charge only apply to the portion
of a withdrawal that is greater than the Free Withdrawal Amount. Accordingly,
the first step is to calculate the Free Withdrawal Amount.

The Free Withdrawal Amount is equal to:

(a)  the greater of:

..    earnings not previously withdrawn; or

..    15% of your total Purchase Payments in the most recent eight years; plus

(b)  an amount equal to your total Purchase Payments made more than eight years
     ago, to the extent not previously withdrawn.

Here, (a) equals $6,000.00, because 15% of the total Purchase Payments in the
most recent eight years ($6,000.00 = 15% x $40,000.00) is greater than the
earnings not previously withdrawn ($3,680.00). (B) equals $0, because all of the
Purchase Payments were made less than eight years age. Accordingly, the Free
Withdrawal Amount is $6,000.00.

The formula that we use to determine the amount of the Market Value Adjustment
is:

..9 x (I - J) x N,

where: I = the Treasury Rate for a maturity equal to the relevant Guarantee
Period for the week preceding the beginning of the Guarantee Period;

J = the Treasury Rate for a maturity equal to the relevant Guarantee Period for
the week preceding our receipt of your withdrawal request, death benefit
request, transfer request, or annuity option request; and

N = the number of whole and partial years from the date we receive your request
until the end of the relevant Guarantee Period.

We will base the Market Value Adjustment on the current Treasury Rate for a
maturity corresponding in length to the relevant Guarantee Period. These
examples also show the Withdrawal Charge (if any), which would be calculated
separately from the Market Value Adjustment.

EXAMPLE OF A DOWNWARD MARKET VALUE ADJUSTMENT

A downward Market Value Adjustment results from a full or partial withdrawal
that occurs when interest rates have increased. Assume interest rates have
increased one year after the Purchase Payment, such that the five-year Treasury
Rate is now 6.5%. Upon a withdrawal, the market value adjustment factor would
be:

..9 x (.06 - .065) x 4 = -.0180

The Market Value Adjustment is a reduction of $678.24 from the amount withdrawn:

$-678.24 = -.0180 x ($43,680 - $6,000.00)

A Withdrawal Charge of 7% (assuming the Withdrawal occurs at the start of the
second Contract year) would be assessed against the Purchase Payments withdrawn
that are less than eight years old and are not eligible for free withdrawal.
Under the Contract, earnings are deemed to be withdrawn before Purchase
Payments. Accordingly, in this example, the amount of the Purchase Payment
eligible for free withdrawal would equal the Free Withdrawal Amount less the
interest credited or $2,320.00 ($6,000.00 - $3,680.00).

Therefore, the Withdrawal Charge would be:

$2,637.60 = 7% x (40,000.00 - $2,320.00)

As a result, the net amount payable to you would be:

$40,364.16 = $43,680.00 - $678.24 - $2,637.60

EXAMPLE OF AN UPWARD MARKET VALUE ADJUSTMENT

An upward Market Value Adjustment results from a withdrawal that occurs when
interest rates have decreased. Assume interest rates have decreased one year

                                  53 PROSPECTUS




after the Purchase Payment, such that the five-year Treasury Rate is now 5.5%.
Upon a withdrawal, the market value adjustment factor would be:

..9 x (.06 - .055) x 4 = .0180

The Market Value Adjustment would increase the amount withdrawn by $648.00, as
follows:

$678.24 = .0180 x ($43,680 - $6,000.00)

As above, in this example, the amount of the Purchase Payment eligible for free
withdrawal would equal the Free Withdrawal Amount less the interest credited or
$2,320.00 ($6,000.00 - $3,680.00). Therefore, the Withdrawal Charge would be:

$2,637.60 = 7% x ($40,000.00 - $2,320.00)

As a result, the net amount payable to you would be:

$41,720.64 = $43,680.00 + $678.24 - $2,637.60

EXAMPLE OF A PARTIAL WITHDRAWAL

If you request a partial withdrawal from a Guarantee Period, we can either (1)
withdraw the specified amount of Contract Value and pay you that amount as
adjusted by any applicable Market Value Adjustment or (2) pay you the amount
requested, and subtract an amount from your Contract Value that equals the
requested amount after application of the Market Value Adjustment and Withdrawal
Charge. Unless you instruct us otherwise, when you request a partial withdrawal
we will assume that you wish to receive the amount requested. We will make the
necessary calculations and on your request provide you with a statement showing
our calculations.

For example, if in the first example you wished to receive $20,000.00 as a
partial withdrawal, the Market Value Adjustment and Withdrawal Charge would be
calculated as follows:

let: AW = the total amount to be withdrawn from your Contract Value

                          MVA = Market Value Adjustment

                             WC = Withdrawal Charge

AW' = amount subject to Market Value Adjustment and Withdrawal Charge

                         Then AW - $20,000.00 = WC - MVA

Since neither the Market Value Adjustment nor the Withdrawal Charge apply to the
free withdrawal amount, we can solve directly for the amount subject to the
Market Value Adjustment and the Withdrawal Charge (i.e., AW'), which equals AW ?
$6,000.00. Then, AW = AW' + $6,000, and AW' + $6,000.00 - $20,000.00 = WC - MVA.

MVA = -.018 x AW'

WC = .07 x AW'

WC - MVA = .088AW'

AW' - $14,000.00 = .088AW'

AW' = $14,000.00 / (1 - .088) = $15,350.88

MVA = -.018 x $15,350.88 = - $276.32

WC = .07 x $15,350.88 = $1,074.56

AW = Total amount withdrawn = $15,350.88 + $6,000.00 = $21,350.88

You receive $20,000.00; the total amount subtracted from your contract is
$21,350.88; the Market Value Adjustment is $276.32; and the Withdrawal Charge is
$1,074.56. Your remaining Contract Value is $20,649.12.

If, however, in the same example, you wished to withdraw $20,000.00 from your
Contract Value and receive the adjusted amount, the calculations would be as
follows:

By definition, AW = total amount withdrawn from your Contract Value = $20,000.00

AW' = amount that MVA & WC are applied to

= amount withdrawn in excess of Free Amount = $20,000.00 - $6,000.00 =
$14,000.00

MVA = -.018 x $14,000.00 = $-252.00

WC = .07 x $14,000.00 = $980.00

You would receive $20,000.00 - $252.00 - $980.00 = $18,768.00; the total amount
subtracted from your Contract Value is $20,000.00. Your remaining Contract Value
would be $22,000.00.

EXAMPLE OF FREE WITHDRAWAL AMOUNT

Assume that in the foregoing example, after four years $10,565.06 in earnings;
including the Credit Enhancement had been credited and that the Contract Value
in the Fixed Account equaled $50,565.06. In this example, if no prior
withdrawals have been made, you could withdraw up to $10,565.06 without
incurring a Market Value Adjustment or a Withdrawal Charge. The Free Withdrawal
Amount would be $10,565.06, because the interest credited ($10,565.06) is
greater than 15% of the Total Purchase Payments in the most recent eight years
($40,000.00 x .15 = $6,000.00).

                 (THIS PAGE HAS BEEN LEFT BLANK INTENTIONALLY.)

                                  54 PROSPECTUS




                                     PART II

                     INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS

Item 13. OTHER EXPENSES OF ISSUANCE AND DISTRIBUTION.

Registrant anticipates that it will incur the following approximate expenses in
connection with the issuance and distribution of the securities to be
registered:

Registration fees.................  $    0.00
Cost of printing and engraving....  $4,000.00
Legal fees........................  $    0.00
Accounting fees...................  $3,000.00
Mailing fees......................  $6,500.00

Item 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers

The Articles of Incorporation of Lincoln Benefit Life Company (Registrant)
provide for the indemnification of its directors and officers against expenses,
judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement as incurred by such person, so
long as such person shall not have been adjudged to be liable for negligence or
misconduct in the performance of a duty to the Company. This right of indemnity
is not exclusive of other rights to which a director or officer may otherwise be
entitled.

The By-Laws of Allstate Distributors, LLC (Distributor) provide that the
corporation will indemnify a director, officer, employee or agent of the
corporation to the full extent of Delaware law. In general, Delaware law
provides that a corporation may indemnify a director, officer, employee or agent
against expenses, judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement if that
individual acted in good faith and in a manner he or she reasonably believed to
be in or not opposed to the best interests of the corporation, and with respect
to any criminal action or proceeding, had no reasonable cause to believe his or
her conduct was unlawful. No indemnification shall be made for expenses,
including attorney's fees, if the person shall have been judged to be liable to
the corporation unless a court determines such person is entitled to such
indemnity. Expenses incurred by such individual in defending any action or
proceeding may be advanced by the corporation so long as the individual agrees
to repay the corporation if it is later determined that he or she is not
entitled to such indemnification.

Under the terms of the form of Underwriting Agreement, the Registrant agrees to
indemnify the Distributor for any liability that the latter may incur to a
Contract owner or party-in-interest under a Contract, (a) arising out of any act
or omission in the course of or in connection with rendering services under such
Agreement, or (b) arising out of the purchase, retention or surrender of a
Contract; provided that the Registrant will not indemnify the Distributor for
any such liability that results from the latter's willful misfeasance, bad faith
or gross negligence, or from the reckless disregard by the latter of its duties
and obligations under the Underwriting Agreement.

Insofar as indemnification for liability arising under the Securities Act of
1933 may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the
registrant pursuant to the forgoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has
been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such
indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suite or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public
policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of
such issue.

Item 15. RECENT SALES OF UNREGISTERED SECURITIES

During the period beginning on December 1, 2008 and ending on March 26, 2009,
the Registrant inadvertently sold participating interests in existing deferred
annuity contracts pursuant to registration statements on Form S-3 that were not
in compliance with Rule 415(a)(5) under the Securities Act of 1933. The
aggregate amount of securities sold was $13,933,172. Purchasers, however, did
receive all material information relating to the security prior to sale,
including the prospectus from the existing registration statement. When the
technical violation was discovered, the Registrant filed new registration
statements on Form S-3 with the Commission to comply with the requirements of
Rule 415(a)(5) for continuous offering. These registration statements were
declared effective on March 27, 2009 (SEC File Nos. 333-158172, 333-158176,
333-158180, 333-158181, 333-158192). Although the legal effect of a violation of
Rule 415(a)(5) is not entirely clear, the Registrant may have been deemed to
have inadvertently sold unregistered securities during the time period noted
above. New procedures have been implemented to ensure timely submission of
future registration statement filings.

Item 16. EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

16(a)

Exh. No. Description

1     Form of Principal Underwriting Agreement. Incorporated herein by reference
      to Post-Effective Amendment to Form N-4 for Lincoln Benefit Life Variable
      Annuity Account (File No. 333-50545, 811-07924) filed January 28, 1999

3(i)  Amended and Restated Articles of Incorporation of Lincoln Benefit Life
      Company dated September 26, 2000. Incorporated herein by reference to
      Exhibit 3(i) to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's Quarterly Report on Form
      10-Q for quarter ended March 31, 2002. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

3(ii) Amended and Restated By-Laws of Lincoln Benefit Life Company effective
      March 10, 2006. Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended
      March 31, 2006. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

4(a)  Form of Variable Annuity Contract. Incorporated herein by reference to
      Registration Statement on Form N-4 for Lincoln Benefit Life Variable
      Annuity Account (File No. 333-82427, 811-07924) filed July 8, 1999

4(b)  Form of Application. Incorporated herein by reference to Registration
      Statement on Form N-4 for Lincoln Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account
      (File No. 333-82427, 811-07924) filed July 8, 1999

5(a)  Opinion and Consent of Counsel regarding legality. Incorporated herein by
      reference to Post-Effective Amendment to Form S-3 on Form S-1 for Lincoln
      Benefit Life Variable Annuity Account (File No. 333-88045) filed April 6,
      2000.

5(b)  Opinion and Consent of Counsel regarding legality. Opinion of General
      Counsel Re: Legality (Incorporated herein by reference to Registrant's
      Form S-3 Registration Statement (File No. 333-158176) dated March 24,
      2009)

8     None

9     None

10    Material Contracts

10.1  Form of Investment Management Agreement among Allstate Investments, LLC,
      Allstate Insurance Company, The Allstate Corporation and certain
      affiliates effective January 1, 2007. Incorporated herein by reference to
      Exhibit 10.12 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's Annual Report on Form
      10-K for 2007. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.2  Form of Tax Sharing Agreement among The Allstate Corporation and certain
      affiliates dated as of November 12, 1996. Incorporated herein by reference
      to Exhibit 10.24 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's Annual Report on
      Form 10-K for 2007. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.3  Supplemental Intercompany Tax Sharing Agreement between Allstate Life
      Insurance Company and Lincoln Benefit Life Company effective December 21,
      2000. Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended
      December 31, 2009. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

10.4  Cash Management Services Master Agreement between Allstate Insurance
      Company and Allstate Bank (aka Allstate Federal Savings Bank) dated March
      16, 1999. Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.4 to Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for quarter ended
      March 31, 2002. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

10.5  Amendment No.1 to Cash Management Services Master Agreement effective
      January 5, 2001. Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.5 to
      Lincoln Benefit Life Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for quarter
      ended March 31, 2002. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

10.6  Amendment No. 2 entered into November 8, 2002 to the Cash Management
      Services Master Agreement between Allstate Insurance Company, Allstate
      Bank and Allstate Motor Club, Inc. dated March 16, 1999. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's
      Annual Report on Form 10-K filed for 2007. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.7  Premium Depository Service Supplement dated as of September 30, 2005
      to Cash Management Services Master Agreement between Allstate Insurance
      Company, Allstate Bank, Allstate Motor Club, Inc. and certain other
      parties. Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to Allstate
      Life Insurance Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K filed for 2007. (SEC
      File No. 000-31248)

10.8  Variable Annuity Service Supplement dated November 10, 2005 to Cash
      Management Services Agreement between Allstate Bank, Allstate Life
      Insurance Company of New York and certain other parties. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.21 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's
      Annual Report on Form 10-K filed for 2007. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.9  Sweep Agreement Service Supplement dated as of October 11, 2006 to
      Cash Management Services Master Agreement between Allstate Life Insurance
      Company, Allstate Bank, Allstate Motor Club, Inc. and certain other
      companies. Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.22 to Allstate
      Life Insurance Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K filed for 2007. (SEC
      File No. 000-31248)

10.10 Form of Amended and Restated Service and Expense Agreement between
      Allstate Insurance Company, The Allstate Corporation and certain
      affiliates effective January 1, 2004. Incorporated herein by reference to
      Exhibit 10.1 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's Annual Report on Form
      10-K for 2007. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.11 Form of Amendment No. 1 to Amended and Restated Service and Expense
      Agreement between Allstate Insurance Company, The Allstate Corporation and
      certain affiliates effective January 1, 2009.   Incorporated herein by
      reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's Current
      Report on Form 8-K filed February 17, 2010. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.12 Administrative Services Agreement between Lincoln Benefit Life Company and
      Allstate Life Insurance Company effective June 1, 2006. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's
      Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2006. (SEC
      File No. 333-111553)

10.13 Principal Underwriting Agreement between Lincoln Benefit Life Company and
      ALFS, Inc., effective November 25, 1998. (Variable Universal Life
      Account). Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company's Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for quarter ended
      June 30, 2002. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

10.14 Amended and Restated Principal Underwriting Agreement between Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company and ALFS, Inc. effective June 1, 2006. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's
      Current Report on Form 8-K filed December 20, 2007. (SEC File No. 333-
      111553)

10.15 Selling Agreement between Lincoln Benefit Life Company, ALFS, Inc. (f/k/a
      Allstate Financial Services, Inc.) and Allstate Financial Services, LLC
      (f/k/a LSA Securities, Inc.) effective August 2, 1999. Incorporated herein
      by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to Allstate Life Insurance Company's Annual
      Report on Form 10-K for 2003. (SEC File No. 000-31248)

10.16 Coinsurance Agreement between Allstate Life Insurance Company and Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company, effective December 31, 2001. Incorporated herein by
      reference to Exhibit 10.11 to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's Quarterly
      Report on Form 10-Q for quarter ended June 30, 2002. (SEC File No. 333-
      111553)

10.17 Modified Coinsurance Agreement between Allstate Life Insurance Company and
      Lincoln Benefit Life Company, effective December 31, 2001. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.12 to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's
      Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for quarter ended June 30, 2002. (SEC File
      No. 333-111553)

10.18 Modified Coinsurance Agreement between Allstate Life Insurance Company and
      Lincoln Benefit Life Company, effective December 31, 2001. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's
      Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for quarter ended June 30, 2002. (SEC File
      No. 333-111553)

10.19 Intercompany Loan Agreement among The Allstate Corporation, Allstate Life
      Insurance Company, Lincoln Benefit Life Company and other certain
      subsidiaries of The Allstate Corporation dated February 1, 1996.
      Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of Allstate Life
      Insurance Company's Annual Report on Form 10-K for 2006. (SEC File No.
      000-31248)

10.20 Form of Service Agreement between Lincoln Benefit Life Company and
      Allstate Assignment Company effective June 25, 2001. Incorporated herein
      by reference to Exhibit 10.22 of Lincoln Benefit Life Company's Annual
      Report on Form 10-K for 2007. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

10.21 First Amendment to Service Agreement between Lincoln Benefit Life Company
      and Allstate Assignment Company effective December 1, 2007. Incorporated
      herein by reference to Exhibit 10.23 of Lincoln Benefit Life Company's
      Annual Report on Form 10-K for 2007. (SEC File No. 333-111553)

10.22 Agreement for the Settlement of State and Local Tax Credits among Allstate
      Insurance Company and certain affiliates effective January 1, 2007.
      Incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Lincoln Benefit Life
      Company's Current Report on Form 8-K filed February 21, 2008. (SEC File
      No. 333-111553)

10.23 Administrative Services Agreement between ALFS, Inc., Allstate Life
      Insurance Company, Lincoln Benefit Life Company and Charter National Life
      Insurance Company effective January 1, 2000. Incorporated herein by
      reference to Exhibit 10.22 to Lincoln Benefit Life Company's Annual Report
      on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008. (SEC File No. 333-
      111553)

10.24 Form of Assignment & Delegation of Administrative Services Agreements,
      Underwriting Agreements, and Selling Agreements between ALFS, Inc. and
      Allstate Life Insurance Company, Allstate Life Insurance Company of
      New York, Charter National Life Insurance Company, Intramerica Life
      Insurance Company, Allstate Distributors, LLC & Lincoln Benefit Life
      Company. Filed herewith.

11    None

12    None

15    Not applicable

16    Letter re change in certifying accountant. Not applicable.

21    Subsidiaries of the registrant. Not applicable.

23    Consent of Independent Public Accounting Firm. Filed herewith.

24(a) Powers of Attorney for Lawrence W. Dahl, Matthew S. Easley, Samuel H.
      Pilch, and John Pintozzi. Incorporated herein by reference to the
      Registration Statement on Form S-3 File No. 333-158181 dated March 24,
      2009.

24(b) Power of Attorney for Matthew E. Winter. Incorporated herein by reference
      to Exhibit 24(b) to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 for Lincoln
      Benefit Life Company (File No. 333-158181) filed on April 8, 2010.

24(c) Power of Attorney for Anurag Chandra. Filed herewith.




16(b)

Financial statement schedules required by Regulation S-X (17 CFR Part 210) and
Item 11(e) of Form S-1 are included in Part I.

Item 17. Undertakings.

(a) The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes:

(1) To file, during any period in which offers or sales are being made, a
post-effective amendment to this registration statement:

(i) To include any prospectus required by section 10(a)(3) of the Securities Act
of 1933;

(ii) To reflect in the Prospectus any facts or events arising after the
effective date of the registration statement (or the most recent post-effective
amendment thereof) which, individually or in the aggregate, represent a
fundamental change in the information set forth in the registration statement;

(iii) To include any material information with respect to the plan of
distribution not previously disclosed in the registration statement or any
material change to such information in the registration statement.

(2) That, for the determining of any liability under the Securities Act of 1933,
each such post-effective amendment shall be deemed to be a new registration
statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such
securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering
thereof.

(3) To remove from registration by means of a post-effective amendment any of
the securities being registered which remain unsold at the termination of the
offering.

(4) That, for the purpose of determining liability under the Securities Act of
1933 to any purchaser, each prospectus filed pursuant to Rule 424(b) as part of
a registration statement relating to an offering, other than registration
statements relying on Rule 430B or other than prospectuses filed in reliance on
Rule 430A, shall be deemed to be part of and included in the registration
statement as of the date it is first used after effectiveness. Provided,
however, that no statement made in a registration statement or prospectus that
is part of the registration statement or made in a document incorporated or
deemed incorporated by reference into the registration statement or prospectus
that is part of the registration statement will, as to a purchaser with a time
of contract of sale prior to such first use, supersede or modify any statement
that was made in the registration statement or prospectus that was part of the
registration statement or made in any such document immediately prior to such
date of first use.

(5) That, for the purpose of determining liability of the registrant under the
Securities Act of 1933 to any purchaser in the initial distribution of the
securities:

The undersigned registrant undertakes that in a primary offering of securities
of the undersigned registrant pursuant to this registration statement,
regardless of the underwriting method used to sell the securities to the
purchaser, if the securities are offered or sold to such purchaser by means of
any of the following communications, the undersigned registrant will be a seller
to the purchaser and will be considered to offer or sell such securities to such
purchaser:

(i) Any preliminary prospectus or prospectus of the undersigned registrant
relating to the offering required to be filed pursuant to Rule 424;

(ii) Any free writing prospectus relating to the offering prepared by or on
behalf of the undersigned registrant or used or referred to by the undersigned
registrant;

(iii) The portion of any other free writing prospectus relating to the offering
containing material information about the undersigned registrant or its
securities provided by or on behalf of the undersigned registrant; and

(iv) Any other communication that is an offer in the offering made by the
undersigned registrant to the purchaser.

Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of
1933 may be permitted in directors, officers and controlling persons of the
registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant
has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission
such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Act and is,
therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against
such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred
or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the
successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such
director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being
registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate
jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public
policy as expressed in the Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of
such issue.




                                   SIGNATURES

As required by the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant has duly caused this
Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto
duly authorized, in the City of Lincoln and State of Nebraska on the 12th day of
April, 2011.

                                       LINCOLN BENEFIT LIFE COMPANY (Registrant)


                                       By: /s/ Susan L. Lees
                                           -------------------------------------
                                           Susan L. Lees
                                           Director, Senior Vice President,
                                           General Counsel and Secretary

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration
Statement has been signed below by the following directors and principal
officers of Lincoln Benefit Life Company in the capacities indicated on the 12th
day of April, 2011.

(Signature)                            (Title)
------------------------------------   -----------------------------------


*/ Lawrence W. Dahl                    Director, President, and Chief Operating
------------------------------------   Officer
Lawrence W. Dahl


*/ Matthew S. Easley                   Director and Senior Vice President
------------------------------------
Matthew S. Easley


/s/ Susan L. Lees                      Director, Senior Vice President,
------------------------------------   General Counsel and Secretary
Susan L. Lees


*/ Samuel H. Pilch                     Group Vice President and Controller
------------------------------------
Samuel H. Pilch


*/ John C. Pintozzi                    Director, Senior Vice President and
------------------------------------   Chief Financial Officer
John C. Pintozzi


*/ Matthew E. Winter                   Director, Chairman of the Board and
------------------------------------   Chief Executive Officer
Matthew E. Winter


*/ Anurag Chandra                      Director and Senior Vice President
------------------------------------
Anurag Chandra

*    By Susan L. Lees, pursuant to Power of Attorney.




                                    EXHIBITS

Exhibit No.   Description
-----------   -------------------------------------------------------------
10.24         Form of Assignment & Delegation of Administrative Services
              Agreements, Underwriting Agreements, and Selling Agreements
              between ALFS, Inc. and Allstate Life Insurance Company, Allstate
              Life Insurance Company of New York, Charter National Life
              Insurance Company, Intramerica Life Insurance Company, Allstate
              Distributors, LLC & Lincoln Benefit Life Company

23            Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

24(c)         Power of Attorney for Anurag Chandra